X-Git-Url: http://nsz.repo.hu/git/?a=blobdiff_plain;ds=sidebyside;f=n1548.html;h=ff9b0a9aaa09d72e585cabecfa934823cf1f4e62;hb=6fa09ff7f9eb20582513c80f0fa883b056bde241;hp=5f12277f0650c889160f0ef8ee7ed6a5c9746153;hpb=c8552f228e75429c8c11edb869899f05b70ea1e5;p=c-standard diff --git a/n1548.html b/n1548.html index 5f12277..ff9b0a9 100644 --- a/n1548.html +++ b/n1548.html @@ -762,7 +762,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -
footnotes
+

Footnotes

1) This International Standard is designed to promote the portability of C programs among a variety of data-processing systems. It is intended for use by implementors and programmers. @@ -995,7 +995,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. char a; int b:5, c:11, :0, d:8; struct { int ee:8; } e; - } + } + contains four separate memory locations: The member a, and bit-fields d and e.ee are each separate memory locations, and can be modified concurrently without interfering with each other. The bit-fields b and c together constitute the fourth memory location. The bit-fields b and c cannot be concurrently @@ -1077,7 +1078,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. ''representation'', this is the intended usage.2) -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

2) For example, ''Trapping or stopping (if supported) is disabled...'' (F.8.2). Note that fetching a trap representation might perform a trap but is not required to (see 6.2.6.1). @@ -1155,7 +1156,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

3) A strictly conforming program can use conditional features (see 6.10.8.3) provided the use is guarded by an appropriate conditional inclusion preprocessing directive using the related macro. For example: @@ -1164,7 +1165,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /* ... */ fesetround(FE_UPWARD); /* ... */ - #endif + #endif +

4) This implies that a conforming implementation reserves no identifiers other than those explicitly @@ -1255,7 +1257,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

6) Implementations shall behave as if these separate phases occur, even though many are typically folded together in practice. Source files, translation units, and translated translation units need not necessarily be stored as files, nor need there be any one-to-one correspondence between these entities @@ -1280,12 +1282,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE An implementation shall issue a diagnostic for the translation unit:

           char i;
-          int i;
+ int i; + because in those cases where wording in this International Standard describes the behavior for a construct as being both a constraint error and resulting in undefined behavior, the constraint error shall be diagnosed. -
footnotes
+

Footnotes

9) The intent is that an implementation should identify the nature of, and where possible localize, each violation. Of course, an implementation is free to produce any number of diagnostics as long as a valid program is still correctly translated. It may also successfully translate an invalid program. @@ -1327,11 +1330,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. prototype for this function. It shall be defined with a return type of int and with no parameters:

-         int main(void) { /* ... */ }
+ int main(void) { /* ... */ } + or with two parameters (referred to here as argc and argv, though any names may be used, as they are local to the function in which they are declared):
-         int main(int argc, char *argv[]) { /* ... */ }
+ int main(int argc, char *argv[]) { /* ... */ } + or equivalent;10) or in some other implementation-defined manner.

If they are declared, the parameters to the main function shall obey the following @@ -1356,7 +1361,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. startup and program termination. -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

10) Thus, int can be replaced by a typedef name defined as int, or the type of argv can be written as char ** argv, and so on. @@ -1380,7 +1385,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. termination status returned to the host environment is unspecified.

Forward references: definition of terms (7.1.1), the exit function (7.22.4.4). -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

11) In accordance with 6.2.4, the lifetimes of objects with automatic storage duration declared in main will have ended in the former case, even where they would not have in the latter. @@ -1458,7 +1463,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

           char c1, c2;
           /* ... */
-          c1 = c1 + c2;
+ c1 = c1 + c2; + the ''integer promotions'' require that the abstract machine promote the value of each variable to int size and then add the two ints and truncate the sum. Provided the addition of two chars can be done without overflow, or with overflow wrapping silently to produce the correct result, the actual execution need only @@ -1470,7 +1476,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. float f1, f2; double d; /* ... */ - f1 = f2 * d; + f1 = f2 * d; + the multiplication may be executed using single-precision arithmetic if the implementation can ascertain that the result would be the same as if it were executed using double-precision arithmetic (for example, if d were replaced by the constant 2.0, which has type double). @@ -1485,7 +1492,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. double d1, d2; float f; d1 = f = expression; - d2 = (float) expression; + d2 = (float) expression; + the values assigned to d1 and d2 are required to have been converted to float.

@@ -1501,31 +1509,37 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. x = (x * y) * z; // not equivalent to x *= y * z; z = (x - y) + y ; // not equivalent to z = x; z = x + x * y; // not equivalent to z = x * (1.0 + y); - y = x / 5.0; // not equivalent to y = x * 0.2; + y = x / 5.0; // not equivalent to y = x * 0.2; +

EXAMPLE 6 To illustrate the grouping behavior of expressions, in the following fragment

           int a, b;
           /* ... */
-          a = a + 32760 + b + 5;
+ a = a + 32760 + b + 5; + the expression statement behaves exactly the same as
-          a = (((a + 32760) + b) + 5);
+ a = (((a + 32760) + b) + 5); + due to the associativity and precedence of these operators. Thus, the result of the sum (a + 32760) is next added to b, and that result is then added to 5 which results in the value assigned to a. On a machine in which overflows produce an explicit trap and in which the range of values representable by an int is [-32768, +32767], the implementation cannot rewrite this expression as
-          a = ((a + b) + 32765);
+ a = ((a + b) + 32765); + since if the values for a and b were, respectively, -32754 and -15, the sum a + b would produce a trap while the original expression would not; nor can the expression be rewritten either as
-          a = ((a + 32765) + b);
+ a = ((a + 32765) + b); + or
-          a = (a + (b + 32765));
+ a = (a + (b + 32765)); + since the values for a and b might have been, respectively, 4 and -8 or -17 and 12. However, on a machine in which overflow silently generates some value and where positive and negative overflows cancel, the above expression statement can be rewritten by the implementation in any of the above ways because the @@ -1539,10 +1553,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int sum; char *p; /* ... */ - sum = sum * 10 - '0' + (*p++ = getchar()); + sum = sum * 10 - '0' + (*p++ = getchar()); + the expression statement is grouped as if it were written as
-          sum = (((sum * 10) - '0') + ((*(p++)) = (getchar())));
+ sum = (((sum * 10) - '0') + ((*(p++)) = (getchar()))); + but the actual increment of p can occur at any time between the previous sequence point and the next sequence point (the ;), and the call to getchar can occur at any point prior to the need of its returned value. @@ -1550,7 +1566,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

Forward references: expressions (6.5), type qualifiers (6.7.3), statements (6.8), the signal function (7.14), files (7.21.3). -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

12) The IEC 60559 standard for binary floating-point arithmetic requires certain user-accessible status flags and control modes. Floating-point operations implicitly set the status flags; modes affect result values of floating-point operations. Implementations that support such floating-point state are @@ -1768,7 +1784,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. is not tolerant of races or provides hardware race detection. -

footnotes
+

Footnotes

14) The execution can usually be viewed as an interleaving of all of the threads. However, some kinds of atomic operations, for example, allow executions inconsistent with a simple interleaving as described below. @@ -1802,18 +1818,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. members: the 26 uppercase letters of the Latin alphabet

          A    B   C      D   E   F    G    H    I    J    K    L   M
-         N    O   P      Q   R   S    T    U    V    W    X    Y   Z
+ N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z + the 26 lowercase letters of the Latin alphabet
          a    b   c      d   e   f    g    h    i    j    k    l   m
-         n    o   p      q   r   s    t    u    v    w    x    y   z
+ n o p q r s t u v w x y z + the 10 decimal digits
-         0    1   2      3   4   5    6    7    8    9
+ 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 + the following 29 graphic characters
          !    "   #      %   &   '    (    )    *    +    ,    -   .    /    :
-         ;    <   =      >   ?   [    \    ]    ^    _    {    |   }    ~
+ ; < = > ? [ \ ] ^ _ { | } ~ + the space character, and control characters representing horizontal tab, vertical tab, and form feed. The representation of each member of the source and execution basic character sets shall fit in a byte. In both the source and execution basic character sets, the @@ -1842,27 +1862,32 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
         ??=      #                       ??)      ]                       ??!     |
         ??(      [                       ??'      ^                       ??>     }
-        ??/      \                       ??<      {                       ??-     ~
+ ??/ \ ??< { ??- ~ + No other trigraph sequences exist. Each ? that does not begin one of the trigraphs listed above is not changed.

EXAMPLE 1

-           ??=define arraycheck(a, b) a??(b??) ??!??! b??(a??)
+ ??=define arraycheck(a, b) a??(b??) ??!??! b??(a??) + becomes
-           #define arraycheck(a, b) a[b] || b[a]
+ #define arraycheck(a, b) a[b] || b[a] +

EXAMPLE 2 The following source line

-           printf("Eh???/n");
+ printf("Eh???/n"); + becomes (after replacement of the trigraph sequence ??/)
-           printf("Eh?\n");
+ printf("Eh?\n"); + -
footnotes
+

Footnotes

17) The trigraph sequences enable the input of characters that are not defined in the Invariant Code Set as described in ISO/IEC 646, which is a subset of the seven-bit US ASCII code set. @@ -1914,22 +1939,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. \b (backspace) Moves the active position to the previous position on the current line. If

     the active position is at the initial position of a line, the behavior of the display
-    device is unspecified.
+ device is unspecified. + \f ( form feed) Moves the active position to the initial position at the start of the next
-    logical page.
+ logical page. + \n (new line) Moves the active position to the initial position of the next line. \r (carriage return) Moves the active position to the initial position of the current line. \t (horizontal tab) Moves the active position to the next horizontal tabulation position
     on the current line. If the active position is at or past the last defined horizontal
-    tabulation position, the behavior of the display device is unspecified.
+ tabulation position, the behavior of the display device is unspecified. + \v (vertical tab) Moves the active position to the initial position of the next vertical -

     tabulation position. If the active position is at or past the last defined vertical
-      tabulation position, the behavior of the display device is unspecified.
+ tabulation position, the behavior of the display device is unspecified. + +

Each of these escape sequences shall produce a unique implementation-defined value which can be stored in a single char object. The external representations in a text file need not be identical to the internal representations, and are outside the scope of this @@ -1974,7 +2003,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

     universal character name specifying a short identifier of 00010000 or more is
     considered 10 characters, and each extended source character is considered the same
-    number of characters as the corresponding universal character name, if any)19)
+ number of characters as the corresponding universal character name, if any)19) +
  • 4095 external identifiers in one translation unit
  • 511 identifiers with block scope declared in one block
  • 4095 macro identifiers simultaneously defined in one preprocessing translation unit @@ -1993,7 +2023,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
  • 63 levels of nested structure or union definitions in a single struct-declaration-list -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    18) Implementations should avoid imposing fixed translation limits whenever possible.

    19) See ''future language directions'' (6.11.3). @@ -2066,7 +2096,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. UCHAR_MAX.20) The value UCHAR_MAX shall equal 2CHAR_BIT - 1.

    Forward references: representations of types (6.2.6), conditional inclusion (6.10.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    20) See 6.2.5. @@ -2076,19 +2106,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. representation of floating-point numbers and values that provide information about an implementation's floating-point arithmetic.21) The following parameters are used to define the model for each floating-point type: -

             s          sign ((+-)1)
             b          base or radix of exponent representation (an integer > 1)
             e          exponent (an integer between a minimum emin and a maximum emax )
             p          precision (the number of base-b digits in the significand)
    -         fk        nonnegative integers less than b (the significand digits)
    + fk nonnegative integers less than b (the significand digits) + +

    A floating-point number (x) is defined by the following model:

                         p
             x = sb e   (Sum) f k b-k ,
                        k=1
    -                                 emin <= e <= emax
    + emin <= e <= emax +

    In addition to normalized floating-point numbers ( f 1 > 0 if x != 0), floating types may be @@ -2136,7 +2168,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. 0 toward zero 1 to nearest 2 toward positive infinity - 3 toward negative infinity + 3 toward negative infinity + All other values for FLT_ROUNDS characterize implementation-defined rounding behavior. @@ -2157,18 +2190,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. operations and constants to the range and precision of the long double type; 2 evaluate all operations and constants to the range and precision of the - long double type. + long double type. + All other negative values for FLT_EVAL_METHOD characterize implementation-defined behavior.

    The presence or absence of subnormal numbers is characterized by the implementation- defined values of FLT_HAS_SUBNORM, DBL_HAS_SUBNORM, and LDBL_HAS_SUBNORM: -

             -1       indeterminable25)
              0       absent26) (type does not support subnormal numbers)
    -         1       present (type does support subnormal numbers)
    + 1 present (type does support subnormal numbers) + +

    The values given in the following list shall be replaced by constant expressions with implementation-defined values that are greater or equal in magnitude (absolute value) to those shown, with the same sign: @@ -2190,7 +2225,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

           { p log10 b        if b is a power of 10
           {
    -      { [^1 + p log10 b^] otherwise
    + { [^1 + p log10 b^] otherwise + FLT_DECIMAL_DIG 6 DBL_DECIMAL_DIG 10 LDBL_DECIMAL_DIG 10 @@ -2200,7 +2236,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
           { pmax log10 b       if b is a power of 10
           {
    -      { [^1 + pmax log10 b^] otherwise
    + { [^1 + pmax log10 b^] otherwise + DECIMAL_DIG 10
  • number of decimal digits, q, such that any floating-point number with q decimal digits can be rounded into a floating-point number with p radix b digits and back again @@ -2208,7 +2245,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
           { p log10 b          if b is a power of 10
           {
    -      { [_( p - 1) log10 b_] otherwise
    + { [_( p - 1) log10 b_] otherwise + FLT_DIG 6 DBL_DIG 10 LDBL_DIG 10 @@ -2221,7 +2259,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
  • minimum negative integer such that 10 raised to that power is in the range of normalized floating-point numbers, [^log10 b emin -1 ^]
    -                                   [                  ]
    + [ ] + FLT_MIN_10_EXP -37 DBL_MIN_10_EXP -37 LDBL_MIN_10_EXP -37 @@ -2230,25 +2269,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
         FLT_MAX_EXP
         DBL_MAX_EXP
    -    LDBL_MAX_EXP
    + LDBL_MAX_EXP +
  • maximum integer such that 10 raised to that power is in the range of representable finite floating-point numbers, [_log10 ((1 - b- p )b emax )_] - -

         FLT_MAX_10_EXP                               +37
         DBL_MAX_10_EXP                               +37
    -    LDBL_MAX_10_EXP                              +37
    + LDBL_MAX_10_EXP +37 + + +

    The values given in the following list shall be replaced by constant expressions with implementation-defined values that are greater than or equal to those shown:

    • maximum representable finite floating-point number, (1 - b- p )b emax -
    -

         FLT_MAX                                   1E+37
         DBL_MAX                                   1E+37
    -    LDBL_MAX                                  1E+37
    + LDBL_MAX 1E+37 + + +

    The values given in the following list shall be replaced by constant expressions with implementation-defined (positive) values that are less than or equal to those shown:

      @@ -2257,19 +2299,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
           FLT_EPSILON                                1E-5
           DBL_EPSILON                                1E-9
      -    LDBL_EPSILON                               1E-9
      + LDBL_EPSILON 1E-9 +
    • minimum normalized positive floating-point number, b emin -1
           FLT_MIN                                   1E-37
           DBL_MIN                                   1E-37
      -    LDBL_MIN                                  1E-37
      + LDBL_MIN 1E-37 +
    • minimum positive floating-point number27) FLT_TRUE_MIN 1E-37 DBL_TRUE_MIN 1E-37 LDBL_TRUE_MIN 1E-37
    -
    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    Conversion from (at least) double to decimal with DECIMAL_DIG digits and back should be the identity function. @@ -2281,7 +2325,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. 6 x = s16e (Sum) f k 16-k , k=1 - -31 <= e <= +32 + -31 <= e <= +32 +

              FLT_RADIX                                    16
    @@ -2294,7 +2339,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              FLT_MIN_10_EXP                              -38
              FLT_MAX_EXP                                 +32
              FLT_MAX                         3.40282347E+38F
    -         FLT_MAX_10_EXP                              +38
    + FLT_MAX_10_EXP +38 +

    EXAMPLE 2 The following describes floating-point representations that also meet the requirements for @@ -2304,13 +2350,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. 24 x f = s2e (Sum) f k 2-k , k=1 - -125 <= e <= +128 + -125 <= e <= +128 +

                        53
            x d = s2e   (Sum) f k 2-k ,
                        k=1
    -                                  -1021 <= e <= +1024
    + -1021 <= e <= +1024 +
              FLT_RADIX                                     2
    @@ -2318,7 +2366,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              FLT_MANT_DIG                                 24
              FLT_EPSILON                     1.19209290E-07F // decimal constant
              FLT_EPSILON                            0X1P-23F // hex constant
    -         FLT_DECIMAL_DIG                               9
    + FLT_DECIMAL_DIG 9 + @@ -2350,7 +2399,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. DBL_MAX_EXP +1024 DBL_MAX 1.7976931348623157E+308 // decimal constant DBL_MAX 0X1.fffffffffffffP1023 // hex constant - DBL_MAX_10_EXP +308 + DBL_MAX_10_EXP +308 + If a type wider than double were supported, then DECIMAL_DIG would be greater than 17. For example, if the widest type were to use the minimal-width IEC 60559 double-extended format (64 bits of precision), then DECIMAL_DIG would be 21. @@ -2361,7 +2411,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (7.22), input/output <stdio.h> (7.21), mathematics <math.h> (7.12). -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    21) The floating-point model is intended to clarify the description of each floating-point characteristic and does not require the floating-point arithmetic of the implementation to be identical. @@ -2400,7 +2450,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. definitions are listed on separate lines, except when prefaced by the words ''one of''. An optional symbol is indicated by the subscript ''opt'', so that

    -          { expressionopt }
    + { expressionopt } + indicates an optional expression enclosed in braces.

    When syntactic categories are referred to in the main text, they are not italicized and @@ -2505,7 +2556,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: declarations (6.7), expressions (6.5), external definitions (6.9), statements (6.8). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    29) There is no linkage between different identifiers.

    30) A function declaration can contain the storage-class specifier static only if it is at file scope; see @@ -2535,7 +2586,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    32) There is only one name space for tags even though three are possible. @@ -2597,7 +2648,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: array declarators (6.7.6.2), compound literals (6.5.2.5), declarators (6.7.6), function calls (6.5.2.2), initialization (6.7.9), statements (6.8). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    33) The term ''constant address'' means that two pointers to the object constructed at possibly different times will compare equal. The address may be different during two different executions of the same program. @@ -2808,7 +2859,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: compatible type and composite type (6.2.7), declarations (6.7). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    37) A type may be incomplete or complete throughout an entire translation unit, or it may change states at different points within a translation unit. @@ -2899,7 +2950,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: declarations (6.7), expressions (6.5), lvalues, arrays, and function designators (6.3.2.1), order and consistency (7.17.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    49) A positional representation for integers that uses the binary digits 0 and 1, in which the values represented by successive bits are additive, begin with 1, and are multiplied by successive integral powers of 2, except perhaps the bit with the highest position. (Adapted from the American National @@ -2908,7 +2959,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                                                CHAR_BIT
    -                                                     - 1.
    + - 1. +

    50) Thus, an automatic variable can be initialized to a trap representation without causing undefined behavior, but the value of the variable cannot be used until a proper value is stored in it. @@ -2981,7 +3033,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    53) Some combinations of padding bits might generate trap representations, for example, if one padding bit is a parity bit. Regardless, no arithmetic operation on valid values can generate a trap representation other than as part of an exceptional condition such as an overflow, and this cannot occur @@ -3053,13 +3105,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE Given the following two file scope declarations:

               int f(int (*)(), double (*)[3]);
    -          int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[]);
    + int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[]); + The resulting composite type for the function is:
    -          int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[3]);
    + int f(int (*)(char *), double (*)[3]); + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    55) Two types need not be identical to be compatible.

    56) As specified in 6.2.1, the later declaration might hide the prior declaration. @@ -3107,7 +3161,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    57) Every over-aligned type is, or contains, a structure or union type with a member to which an extended alignment has been applied. @@ -3171,7 +3225,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: enumeration specifiers (6.7.2.2), structure and union specifiers (6.7.2.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    58) The integer promotions are applied only: as part of the usual arithmetic conversions, to certain argument expressions, to the operands of the unary +, -, and ~ operators, and to both operands of the shift operators, as specified by their respective subclauses. @@ -3182,7 +3236,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. When any scalar value is converted to _Bool, the result is 0 if the value compares equal to 0; otherwise, the result is 1.59) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    59) NaNs do not compare equal to 0 and thus convert to 1. @@ -3198,7 +3252,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Otherwise, the new type is signed and the value cannot be represented in it; either the result is implementation-defined or an implementation-defined signal is raised. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    60) The rules describe arithmetic on the mathematical value, not the value of a given type of expression. @@ -3220,7 +3274,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversions (6.3.1.8, 6.8.6.4) may be represented in greater precision and range than that required by the new type. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    61) The remaindering operation performed when a value of integer type is converted to unsigned type need not be performed when a value of real floating type is converted to unsigned type. Thus, the range of portable real floating values is (-1, Utype_MAX+1). @@ -3262,7 +3316,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the result, whose type domain is the type domain of the operands if they are the same, and complex otherwise. This pattern is called the usual arithmetic conversions: -

            First, if the corresponding real type of either operand is long double, the other
            operand is converted, without change of type domain, to a type whose
    @@ -3288,7 +3341,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    the operand with unsigned integer type is converted to the type of the
                    operand with signed integer type.
                    Otherwise, both operands are converted to the unsigned integer type
    -               corresponding to the type of the operand with signed integer type.
    + corresponding to the type of the operand with signed integer type. + +

    The values of floating operands and of the results of floating expressions may be represented in greater precision and range than that required by the type; the types are not changed thereby.63) @@ -3298,7 +3353,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    62) For example, addition of a double _Complex and a float entails just the conversion of the float operand to double (and yields a double _Complex result). @@ -3349,7 +3404,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. increment and decrement operators (6.5.2.4), prefix increment and decrement operators (6.5.3.1), the sizeof operator (6.5.3.4), structure and union members (6.5.2.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    64) The name ''lvalue'' comes originally from the assignment expression E1 = E2, in which the left operand E1 is required to be a (modifiable) lvalue. It is perhaps better considered as representing an object ''locator value''. What is sometimes called ''rvalue'' is in this International Standard described @@ -3420,7 +3475,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    66) The macro NULL is defined in <stddef.h> (and other headers) as a null pointer constant; see 7.19.

    67) The mapping functions for converting a pointer to an integer or an integer to a pointer are intended to @@ -3432,7 +3487,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.4 Lexical elements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               token:
    @@ -3448,12 +3503,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      character-constant
                      string-literal
                      punctuator
    -                 each non-white-space character that cannot be one of the above
    -
    Constraints
    + each non-white-space character that cannot be one of the above + +

    Constraints

    Each preprocessing token that is converted to a token shall have the lexical form of a keyword, an identifier, a constant, a string literal, or a punctuator. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A token is the minimal lexical element of the language in translation phases 7 and 8. The categories of tokens are: keywords, identifiers, constants, string literals, and punctuators. @@ -3498,13 +3554,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (6.5.3.1), preprocessing directives (6.10), preprocessing numbers (6.4.8), string literals (6.4.5). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    69) An additional category, placemarkers, is used internally in translation phase 4 (see 6.10.3.3); it cannot occur in source files.

    6.4.1 Keywords

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               keyword: one of
    @@ -3522,22 +3578,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     enum                            static                       _Noreturn
                     extern                          struct                       _Static_assert
                     float                           switch                       _Thread_local
    -                for                             typedef
    -
    Semantics
    + for typedef + +

    Semantics

    The above tokens (case sensitive) are reserved (in translation phases 7 and 8) for use as keywords, and shall not be used otherwise. The keyword _Imaginary is reserved for specifying imaginary types.70) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    70) One possible specification for imaginary types appears in annex G.

    6.4.2 Identifiers

    6.4.2.1 General
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               identifier:
    @@ -3554,8 +3611,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          A B          C    D    E    F     G    H    I    J     K    L    M
                          N O          P    Q    R    S     T    U    V    W     X    Y    Z
               digit: one of
    -                 0 1        2     3    4    5    6     7    8    9
    -
    Semantics
    + 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 + +

    Semantics

    An identifier is a sequence of nondigit characters (including the underscore _, the lowercase and uppercase Latin letters, and other characters) and digits, which designates @@ -3576,7 +3634,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. When preprocessing tokens are converted to tokens during translation phase 7, if a preprocessing token could be converted to either a keyword or an identifier, it is converted to a keyword. -

    Implementation limits
    +

    Implementation limits

    As discussed in 5.2.4.1, an implementation may limit the number of significant initial characters in an identifier; the limit for an external name (an identifier that has external @@ -3588,7 +3646,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. identifiers differ only in nonsignificant characters, the behavior is undefined.

    Forward references: universal character names (6.4.3), macro replacement (6.10.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    71) On systems in which linkers cannot accept extended characters, an encoding of the universal character name may be used in forming valid external identifiers. For example, some otherwise unused character or sequence of characters may be used to encode the \u in a universal character name. @@ -3596,12 +3654,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.4.2.2 Predefined identifiers
    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The identifier __func__ shall be implicitly declared by the translator as if, immediately following the opening brace of each function definition, the declaration

    -          static const char __func__[] = "function-name";
    + static const char __func__[] = "function-name"; + appeared, where function-name is the name of the lexically-enclosing function.72)

    This name is encoded as if the implicit declaration had been written in the source @@ -3615,10 +3674,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { printf("%s\n", __func__); /* ... */ - } + } + Each time the function is called, it will print to the standard output stream:

    -          myfunc
    + myfunc +

    Forward references: function definitions (6.9.1). @@ -3627,13 +3688,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    72) Since the name __func__ is reserved for any use by the implementation (7.1.3), if any other identifier is explicitly declared using the name __func__, the behavior is undefined.

    6.4.3 Universal character names

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               universal-character-name:
    @@ -3641,17 +3702,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      \U hex-quad hex-quad
               hex-quad:
                      hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit
    -                              hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit
    -
    Constraints
    + hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit + +

    Constraints

    A universal character name shall not specify a character whose short identifier is less than 00A0 other than 0024 ($), 0040 (@), or 0060 ('), nor one in the range D800 through DFFF inclusive.73) -

    Description
    +

    Description

    Universal character names may be used in identifiers, character constants, and string literals to designate characters that are not in the basic character set. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The universal character name \Unnnnnnnn designates the character whose eight-digit short identifier (as specified by ISO/IEC 10646) is nnnnnnnn.74) Similarly, the universal @@ -3663,7 +3725,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    73) The disallowed characters are the characters in the basic character set and the code positions reserved by ISO/IEC 10646 for control characters, the character DELETE, and the S-zone (reserved for use by UTF-16). @@ -3673,24 +3735,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.4.4 Constants

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               constant:
                      integer-constant
                      floating-constant
                      enumeration-constant
    -                 character-constant
    -
    Constraints
    + character-constant + +

    Constraints

    Each constant shall have a type and the value of a constant shall be in the range of representable values for its type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    Each constant has a type, determined by its form and value, as detailed later.

    6.4.4.1 Integer constants
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

    @@ -3727,8 +3790,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              long-suffix: one of
                     l L
              long-long-suffix: one of
    -                ll LL
    -
    Description
    + ll LL + +

    Description

    An integer constant begins with a digit, but has no period or exponent part. It may have a prefix that specifies its base and a suffix that specifies its type. @@ -3738,7 +3802,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. digits 0 through 7 only. A hexadecimal constant consists of the prefix 0x or 0X followed by a sequence of the decimal digits and the letters a (or A) through f (or F) with values 10 through 15 respectively. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The value of a decimal constant is computed base 10; that of an octal constant, base 8; that of a hexadecimal constant, base 16. The lexically first digit is the most significant. @@ -3747,7 +3811,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. be represented.

    -                                                                  Octal or Hexadecimal
    + Octal or Hexadecimal + Suffix Decimal Constant Constant none int int @@ -3756,25 +3821,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. long long int long int unsigned long int long long int - unsigned long long int + unsigned long long int + u or U unsigned int unsigned int
                          unsigned long int                      unsigned long int
    -                     unsigned long long int                 unsigned long long int
    + unsigned long long int unsigned long long int + l or L long int long int
                          long long int                          unsigned long int
                                                                 long long int
    -                                                            unsigned long long int
    + unsigned long long int + Both u or U unsigned long int unsigned long int and l or L unsigned long long int unsigned long long int ll or LL long long int long long int
    -                                                            unsigned long long int
    + unsigned long long int + Both u or U unsigned long long int unsigned long long int and ll or LL @@ -3789,7 +3858,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
    6.4.4.2 Floating constants
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

    @@ -3826,8 +3895,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     hexadecimal-digit
                     hexadecimal-digit-sequence hexadecimal-digit
               floating-suffix: one of
    -                 f l F L
    -
    Description
    + f l F L + +

    Description

    A floating constant has a significand part that may be followed by an exponent part and a suffix that specifies its type. The components of the significand part may include a digit @@ -3836,7 +3906,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. e, E, p, or P followed by an exponent consisting of an optionally signed digit sequence. Either the whole-number part or the fraction part has to be present; for decimal floating constants, either the period or the exponent part has to be present. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The significand part is interpreted as a (decimal or hexadecimal) rational number; the digit sequence in the exponent part is interpreted as a decimal integer. For decimal @@ -3856,7 +3926,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversion of a floating constant shall not raise an exceptional condition or a floating- point exception at execution time. All floating constants of the same source form75) shall convert to the same internal format with the same value. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    The implementation should produce a diagnostic message if a hexadecimal constant cannot be represented exactly in its evaluation format; the implementation should then @@ -3869,7 +3939,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    75) 1.23, 1.230, 123e-2, 123e-02, and 1.23L are all different source forms and thus need not convert to the same internal format and value. @@ -3878,18 +3948,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.4.4.3 Enumeration constants
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               enumeration-constant:
    -                identifier
    -
    Semantics
    + identifier + +

    Semantics

    An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int.

    Forward references: enumeration specifiers (6.7.2.2).

    6.4.4.4 Character constants
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

    @@ -3919,8 +3990,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       \ octal-digit octal-digit octal-digit
             hexadecimal-escape-sequence:
                   \x hexadecimal-digit
    -              hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit
    -
    Description
    + hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit + +

    Description

    An integer character constant is a sequence of one or more multibyte characters enclosed in single-quotes, as in 'x'. A wide character constant is the same, except prefixed by the @@ -3931,14 +4003,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The single-quote ', the double-quote ", the question-mark ?, the backslash \, and arbitrary integer values are representable according to the following table of escape sequences: -

            single quote '            \'
            double quote "            \"
            question mark ?           \?
            backslash \               \\
            octal character           \octal digits
    -       hexadecimal character     \x hexadecimal digits
    + hexadecimal character \x hexadecimal digits + +

    The double-quote " and question-mark ? are representable either by themselves or by the escape sequences \" and \?, respectively, but the single-quote ' and the backslash \ shall be represented, respectively, by the escape sequences \' and \\. @@ -3962,7 +4035,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. consisting of the backslash \ followed by a lowercase letter: \a, \b, \f, \n, \r, \t, and \v.77) -

    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The value of an octal or hexadecimal escape sequence shall be in the range of representable values for the corresponding type: @@ -3971,8 +4044,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. none unsigned char L the unsigned type corresponding to wchar_t u char16_t - U char32_t -

    Semantics
    + U char32_t + +

    Semantics

    An integer character constant has type int. The value of an integer character constant containing a single character that maps to a single-byte execution character is the @@ -4025,13 +4099,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> (7.19), the mbtowc function (7.22.7.2), Unicode utilities <uchar.h> (7.27). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    77) The semantics of these characters were discussed in 5.2.2. If any other character follows a backslash, the result is not a token and a diagnostic is required. See ''future language directions'' (6.11.4).

    6.4.5 String literals

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               string-literal:
    @@ -4047,12 +4121,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               s-char:
                         any member of the source character set except
                                      the double-quote ", backslash \, or new-line character
    -                    escape-sequence
    -
    Constraints
    + escape-sequence + +

    Constraints

    A sequence of adjacent string literal tokens shall not include both a wide string literal and a UTF-8 string literal. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    A character string literal is a sequence of zero or more multibyte characters enclosed in double-quotes, as in "xyz". A UTF-8 string literal is the same, except prefixed by u8. @@ -4064,7 +4139,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. representable either by itself or by the escape sequence \', but the double-quote " shall be represented by the escape sequence \". -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    In translation phase 6, the multibyte character sequences specified by any sequence of adjacent character and identically-prefixed string literal tokens are concatenated into a @@ -4098,7 +4173,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 1 This pair of adjacent character string literals

    -          "\x12" "3"
    + "\x12" "3" + produces a single character string literal containing the two characters whose values are '\x12' and '3', because escape sequences are converted into single members of the execution character set just prior to adjacent string literal concatenation. @@ -4113,30 +4189,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. "a" "b" L"c" "a" L"b" "c" L"a" "b" L"c" - L"a" L"b" L"c" + L"a" L"b" L"c" + is equivalent to the string literal
    -          L"abc"
    + L"abc" + Likewise, each of the sequences
               "a" "b" u"c"
               "a" u"b" "c"
               u"a" "b" u"c"
    -          u"a" u"b" u"c"
    + u"a" u"b" u"c" + is equivalent to
    -          u"abc"
    + u"abc" +

    Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> (7.19), the mbstowcs function (7.22.8.1), Unicode utilities <uchar.h> (7.27). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    78) A string literal need not be a string (see 7.1.1), because a null character may be embedded in it by a \0 escape sequence.

    6.4.6 Punctuators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               punctuator: one of
    @@ -4146,8 +4226,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      ? : ; ...
                      = *= /= %= += -= <<=                        >>=    &=       ^=   |=
                      , # ##
    -                 <: :> <% %> %: %:%:
    -
    Semantics
    + <: :> <% %> %: %:%: + +

    Semantics

    A punctuator is a symbol that has independent syntactic and semantic significance. Depending on context, it may specify an operation to be performed (which in turn may @@ -4158,15 +4239,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    In all aspects of the language, the six tokens79)

    -          <:    :>      <%    %>     %:     %:%:
    + <: :> <% %> %: %:%: + behave, respectively, the same as the six tokens
    -          [     ]       {     }      #      ##
    + [ ] { } # ## + except for their spelling.80)

    Forward references: expressions (6.5), declarations (6.7), preprocessing directives (6.10), statements (6.8). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    79) These tokens are sometimes called ''digraphs''.

    80) Thus [ and <: behave differently when ''stringized'' (see 6.10.3.2), but can otherwise be freely @@ -4174,7 +4257,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.4.7 Header names

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               header-name:
    @@ -4191,8 +4274,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      q-char-sequence q-char
               q-char:
                         any member of the source character set except
    -                                 the new-line character and "
    -
    Semantics
    + the new-line character and " + +

    Semantics

    The sequences in both forms of header names are mapped in an implementation-defined manner to headers or external source file names as specified in 6.10.2. @@ -4212,24 +4296,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               0x3<1/a.h>1e2
               #include <1/a.h>
    -          #define const.member@$
    + #define const.member@$ + forms the following sequence of preprocessing tokens (with each individual preprocessing token delimited by a { on the left and a } on the right).
               {0x3}{<}{1}{/}{a}{.}{h}{>}{1e2}
               {#}{include} {<1/a.h>}
    -          {#}{define} {const}{.}{member}{@}{$}
    + {#}{define} {const}{.}{member}{@}{$} +

    Forward references: source file inclusion (6.10.2). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    81) Thus, sequences of characters that resemble escape sequences cause undefined behavior.

    82) For an example of a header name preprocessing token used in a #pragma directive, see 6.10.9.

    6.4.8 Preprocessing numbers

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               pp-number:
    @@ -4241,15 +4327,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     pp-number       E sign
                     pp-number       p sign
                     pp-number       P sign
    -                pp-number       .
    -
    Description
    + pp-number . + +

    Description

    A preprocessing number begins with a digit optionally preceded by a period (.) and may be followed by valid identifier characters and the character sequences e+, e-, E+, E-, p+, p-, P+, or P-.

    Preprocessing number tokens lexically include all floating and integer constant tokens. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A preprocessing number does not have type or a value; it acquires both after a successful conversion (as part of translation phase 7) to a floating constant token or an integer @@ -4283,14 +4370,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. glue(/,/) k(); // syntax error, not comment /*//*/ l(); // equivalent to l(); m = n//**/o - + p; // equivalent to m = n + p; + + p; // equivalent to m = n + p; + -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    83) Thus, /* ... */ comments do not nest. @@ -4358,17 +4446,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    84) This paragraph renders undefined statement expressions such as

                i = ++i + 1;
    -           a[i++] = i;
    + a[i++] = i; + while allowing
                i = i + 1;
    -           a[i] = i;
    + a[i] = i; +

    85) The syntax specifies the precedence of operators in the evaluation of an expression, which is the same @@ -4400,7 +4490,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.1 Primary expressions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               primary-expression:
    @@ -4408,8 +4498,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      constant
                      string-literal
                      ( expression )
    -                 generic-selection
    -
    Semantics
    + generic-selection + +

    Semantics

    An identifier is a primary expression, provided it has been declared as designating an object (in which case it is an lvalue) or a function (in which case it is a function @@ -4426,12 +4517,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. designator, or a void expression.

    Forward references: declarations (6.7). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    91) Thus, an undeclared identifier is a violation of the syntax.

    6.5.1.1 Generic selection
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               generic-selection:
    @@ -4441,8 +4532,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      generic-assoc-list , generic-association
               generic-association:
                      type-name : assignment-expression
    -                 default : assignment-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + default : assignment-expression + +

    Constraints

    A generic selection shall have no more than one default generic association. The type name in a generic association shall specify a complete object type other than a variably @@ -4453,7 +4545,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic association list. If a generic selection has no default generic association, its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of the types named in its generic association list. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The controlling expression of a generic selection is not evaluated. If a generic selection has a generic association with a type name that is compatible with the type of the @@ -4472,11 +4564,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. long double: cbrtl, \ default: cbrt, \ float: cbrtf \ - )(X) + )(X) +

    6.5.2 Postfix operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

    @@ -4492,14 +4585,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      ( type-name ) { initializer-list , }
               argument-expression-list:
                     assignment-expression
    -                argument-expression-list , assignment-expression
    + argument-expression-list , assignment-expression +
    6.5.2.1 Array subscripting
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    One of the expressions shall have type ''pointer to complete object type'', the other expression shall have integer type, and the result has type ''type''. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A postfix expression followed by an expression in square brackets [] is a subscripted designation of an element of an array object. The definition of the subscript operator [] @@ -4518,7 +4612,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE Consider the array object defined by the declaration

    -          int x[3][5];
    + int x[3][5]; + Here x is a 3 x 5 array of ints; more precisely, x is an array of three element objects, each of which is an array of five ints. In the expression x[i], which is equivalent to (*((x)+(i))), x is first converted to a pointer to the initial array of five ints. Then i is adjusted according to the type of x, which conceptually @@ -4531,7 +4626,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (6.5.3.2), array declarators (6.7.6.2).
    6.5.2.2 Function calls
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The expression that denotes the called function92) shall have type pointer to function returning void or returning a complete object type other than an array type. @@ -4543,7 +4638,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. have a type such that its value may be assigned to an object with the unqualified version of the type of its corresponding parameter. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A postfix expression followed by parentheses () containing a possibly empty, comma- separated list of expressions is a function call. The postfix expression denotes the called @@ -4604,14 +4699,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE In the function call

    -          (*pf[f1()]) (f2(), f3() + f4())
    + (*pf[f1()]) (f2(), f3() + f4()) + the functions f1, f2, f3, and f4 may be called in any order. All side effects have to be completed before the function pointed to by pf[f1()] is called.

    Forward references: function declarators (including prototypes) (6.7.6.3), function definitions (6.9.1), the return statement (6.8.6.4), simple assignment (6.5.16.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    92) Most often, this is the result of converting an identifier that is a function designator.

    93) A function may change the values of its parameters, but these changes cannot affect the values of the @@ -4623,7 +4719,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.2.3 Structure and union members
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The first operand of the . operator shall have an atomic, qualified, or unqualified structure or union type, and the second operand shall name a member of that type. @@ -4631,7 +4727,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The first operand of the -> operator shall have type ''pointer to atomic, qualified, or unqualified structure'' or ''pointer to atomic, qualified, or unqualified union'', and the second operand shall name a member of the type pointed to. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A postfix expression followed by the . operator and an identifier designates a member of a structure or union object. The value is that of the named member,95) and is an lvalue if @@ -4666,7 +4762,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. struct s { int i; const int ci; }; struct s s; const struct s cs; - volatile struct s vs; + volatile struct s vs; + the various members have the types:

               s.i          int
    @@ -4674,7 +4771,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               cs.i         const int
               cs.ci        const int
               vs.i         volatile int
    -          vs.ci        volatile const int
    + vs.ci volatile const int + @@ -4701,7 +4799,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /* ... */ if (u.n.alltypes == 1) if (sin(u.nf.doublenode) == 0.0) - /* ... */ + /* ... */ + The following is not a valid fragment (because the union type is not visible within function f):
               struct t1 { int m; };
    @@ -4720,13 +4819,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     } u;
                     /* ... */
                     return f(&u.s1, &u.s2);
    -          }
    + } +

    Forward references: address and indirection operators (6.5.3.2), structure and union specifiers (6.7.2.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    95) If the member used to read the contents of a union object is not the same as the member last used to store a value in the object, the appropriate part of the object representation of the value is reinterpreted as an object representation in the new type as described in 6.2.6 (a process sometimes called ''type @@ -4741,11 +4841,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.2.4 Postfix increment and decrement operators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The operand of the postfix increment or decrement operator shall have atomic, qualified, or unqualified real or pointer type, and shall be a modifiable lvalue. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The result of the postfix ++ operator is the value of the operand. As a side effect, the value of the operand object is incremented (that is, the value 1 of the appropriate type is @@ -4762,7 +4862,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. it).

    Forward references: additive operators (6.5.6), compound assignment (6.5.16.2). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    98) Where a pointer to an atomic object can be formed, this is equivalent to the following code sequence where T is the type of E: @@ -4771,18 +4871,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. T result = E; do { tmp = result + 1; - } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_strong(&E, &result, tmp)); + } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_strong(&E, &result, tmp)); + with result being the result of the operation.

    6.5.2.5 Compound literals
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The type name shall specify a complete object type or an array of unknown size, but not a variable length array type.

    All the constraints for initializer lists in 6.7.9 also apply to compound literals. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A postfix expression that consists of a parenthesized type name followed by a brace- enclosed list of initializers is a compound literal. It provides an unnamed object whose @@ -4809,7 +4910,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 1 The file scope definition

    -          int *p = (int []){2, 4};
    + int *p = (int []){2, 4}; + initializes p to point to the first element of an array of two ints, the first having the value two and the second, four. The expressions in this compound literal are required to be constant. The unnamed object has static storage duration. @@ -4823,7 +4925,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /*...*/ p = (int [2]){*p}; /*...*/ - } + } + p is assigned the address of the first element of an array of two ints, the first having the value previously pointed to by p and the second, zero. The expressions in this compound literal need not be constant. The unnamed object has automatic storage duration. @@ -4833,7 +4936,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. created using compound literals can be passed to functions without depending on member order:
               drawline((struct point){.x=1, .y=1},
    -                (struct point){.x=3, .y=4});
    + (struct point){.x=3, .y=4}); + Or, if drawline instead expected pointers to struct point: @@ -4841,19 +4945,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               drawline(&(struct point){.x=1, .y=1},
    -                &(struct point){.x=3, .y=4});
    + &(struct point){.x=3, .y=4}); +

    EXAMPLE 4 A read-only compound literal can be specified through constructions like:

    -          (const float []){1e0, 1e1, 1e2, 1e3, 1e4, 1e5, 1e6}
    + (const float []){1e0, 1e1, 1e2, 1e3, 1e4, 1e5, 1e6} +

    EXAMPLE 5 The following three expressions have different meanings:

               "/tmp/fileXXXXXX"
               (char []){"/tmp/fileXXXXXX"}
    -          (const char []){"/tmp/fileXXXXXX"}
    + (const char []){"/tmp/fileXXXXXX"} + The first always has static storage duration and has type array of char, but need not be modifiable; the last two have automatic storage duration when they occur within the body of a function, and the first of these two is modifiable. @@ -4862,7 +4969,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 6 Like string literals, const-qualified compound literals can be placed into read-only memory and can even be shared. For example,
    -          (const char []){"abc"} == "abc"
    + (const char []){"abc"} == "abc" + might yield 1 if the literals' storage is shared.

    @@ -4872,7 +4980,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               struct int_list { int car; struct int_list *cdr; };
               struct int_list endless_zeros = {0, &endless_zeros};
    -          eval(endless_zeros);
    + eval(endless_zeros); +

    EXAMPLE 8 Each compound literal creates only a single object in a given scope: @@ -4886,7 +4995,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. q = p, p = &((struct s){ j++ }); if (j < 2) goto again; return p == q && q->i == 1; - } + } + The function f() always returns the value 1.

    Note that if an iteration statement were used instead of an explicit goto and a labeled statement, the @@ -4896,7 +5006,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: type names (6.7.7), initialization (6.7.9). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    99) Note that this differs from a cast expression. For example, a cast specifies a conversion to scalar types or void only, and the result of a cast expression is not an lvalue. @@ -4907,7 +5017,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.3 Unary operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               unary-expression:
    @@ -4919,14 +5029,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      sizeof ( type-name )
                      alignof ( type-name )
               unary-operator: one of
    -                 & * + - ~             !
    + & * + - ~ ! +
    6.5.3.1 Prefix increment and decrement operators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The operand of the prefix increment or decrement operator shall have atomic, qualified, or unqualified real or pointer type, and shall be a modifiable lvalue. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The value of the operand of the prefix ++ operator is incremented. The result is the new value of the operand after incrementation. The expression ++E is equivalent to (E+=1). @@ -4938,14 +5049,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: additive operators (6.5.6), compound assignment (6.5.16.2).

    6.5.3.2 Address and indirection operators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The operand of the unary & operator shall be either a function designator, the result of a [] or unary * operator, or an lvalue that designates an object that is not a bit-field and is not declared with the register storage-class specifier.

    The operand of the unary * operator shall have pointer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The unary & operator yields the address of its operand. If the operand has type ''type'', the result has type ''pointer to type''. If the operand is the result of a unary * operator, @@ -4965,7 +5076,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: storage-class specifiers (6.7.1), structure and union specifiers (6.7.2.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    102) Thus, &*E is equivalent to E (even if E is a null pointer), and &(E1[E2]) to ((E1)+(E2)). It is always true that if E is a function designator or an lvalue that is a valid operand of the unary & operator, *&E is a function designator or an lvalue equal to E. If *P is an lvalue and T is the name of @@ -4976,11 +5087,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.3.3 Unary arithmetic operators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The operand of the unary + or - operator shall have arithmetic type; of the ~ operator, integer type; of the ! operator, scalar type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The result of the unary + operator is the value of its (promoted) operand. The integer promotions are performed on the operand, and the result has the promoted type. @@ -5003,13 +5114,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.3.4 The sizeof and alignof operators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The sizeof operator shall not be applied to an expression that has function type or an incomplete type, to the parenthesized name of such a type, or to an expression that designates a bit-field member. The alignof operator shall not be applied to a function type or an incomplete type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The sizeof operator yields the size (in bytes) of its operand, which may be an expression or the parenthesized name of a type. The size is determined from the type of @@ -5035,20 +5146,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. allocate and return a pointer to void. For example:

              extern void *alloc(size_t);
    -         double *dp = alloc(sizeof *dp);
    + double *dp = alloc(sizeof *dp); + The implementation of the alloc function should ensure that its return value is aligned suitably for conversion to a pointer to double.

    EXAMPLE 2 Another use of the sizeof operator is to compute the number of elements in an array:

    -         sizeof array / sizeof array[0]
    + sizeof array / sizeof array[0] +

    EXAMPLE 3 In this example, the size of a variable length array is computed and returned from a function:

    -         #include <stddef.h>
    + #include <stddef.h> + @@ -5064,24 +5178,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. size_t size; size = fsize3(10); // fsize3 returns 13 return 0; - } + } +

    Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> (7.19), declarations (6.7), structure and union specifiers (6.7.2.1), type names (6.7.7), array declarators (6.7.6.2). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    103) When applied to a parameter declared to have array or function type, the sizeof operator yields the size of the adjusted (pointer) type (see 6.9.1).

    6.5.4 Cast operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               cast-expression:
                      unary-expression
    -                 ( type-name ) cast-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + ( type-name ) cast-expression + +

    Constraints

    Unless the type name specifies a void type, the type name shall specify atomic, qualified, or unqualified scalar type, and the operand shall have scalar type. @@ -5091,7 +5207,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A pointer type shall not be converted to any floating type. A floating type shall not be converted to any pointer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    Preceding an expression by a parenthesized type name converts the value of the expression to the named type. This construction is called a cast.104) A cast that specifies @@ -5106,25 +5222,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    104) A cast does not yield an lvalue. Thus, a cast to a qualified type has the same effect as a cast to the unqualified version of the type.

    6.5.5 Multiplicative operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               multiplicative-expression:
                       cast-expression
                       multiplicative-expression * cast-expression
                       multiplicative-expression / cast-expression
    -                  multiplicative-expression % cast-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + multiplicative-expression % cast-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have arithmetic type. The operands of the % operator shall have integer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.

    @@ -5139,19 +5256,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (a/b)*b + a%b shall equal a; otherwise, the behavior of both a/b and a%b is undefined. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    105) This is often called ''truncation toward zero''.

    6.5.6 Additive operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               additive-expression:
                      multiplicative-expression
                      additive-expression + multiplicative-expression
    -                 additive-expression - multiplicative-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + additive-expression - multiplicative-expression + +

    Constraints

    For addition, either both operands shall have arithmetic type, or one operand shall be a pointer to a complete object type and the other shall have integer type. (Incrementing is @@ -5171,7 +5289,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. integer type. (Decrementing is equivalent to subtracting 1.) -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If both operands have arithmetic type, the usual arithmetic conversions are performed on them. @@ -5217,7 +5335,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. expression (Q)+1 does not point to an element of the array object.106)

    EXAMPLE Pointer arithmetic is well defined with pointers to variable length array types. -

               {
                        int n = 4, m = 3;
    @@ -5226,7 +5343,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                        p += 1;                     //   p == &a[1]
                        (*p)[2] = 99;               //   a[1][2] == 99
                        n = p - a;                  //   n == 1
    -          }
    + } + +

    If array a in the above example were declared to be an array of known constant size, and pointer p were declared to be a pointer to an array of the same known constant size (pointing to a), the results would be the same. @@ -5234,7 +5353,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: array declarators (6.7.6.2), common definitions <stddef.h> (7.19). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    106) Another way to approach pointer arithmetic is first to convert the pointer(s) to character pointer(s): In this scheme the integer expression added to or subtracted from the converted pointer is first multiplied by the size of the object originally pointed to, and the resulting pointer is converted back to the @@ -5246,17 +5365,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.7 Bitwise shift operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               shift-expression:
                       additive-expression
                       shift-expression << additive-expression
    -                  shift-expression >> additive-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + shift-expression >> additive-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have integer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The integer promotions are performed on each of the operands. The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand. If the value of the right operand is negative or is @@ -5276,7 +5396,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. resulting value is implementation-defined.

    6.5.8 Relational operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               relational-expression:
    @@ -5284,8 +5404,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       relational-expression   <    shift-expression
                       relational-expression   >    shift-expression
                       relational-expression   <=   shift-expression
    -                  relational-expression   >=   shift-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + relational-expression >= shift-expression + +

    Constraints

    One of the following shall hold:

      @@ -5293,7 +5414,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
    • both operands are pointers to qualified or unqualified versions of compatible object types.
    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If both of the operands have arithmetic type, the usual arithmetic conversions are performed. @@ -5319,20 +5440,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (greater than or equal to) shall yield 1 if the specified relation is true and 0 if it is false.107) The result has type int. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    107) The expression a<b<c is not interpreted as in ordinary mathematics. As the syntax indicates, it means (a<b)<c; in other words, ''if a is less than b, compare 1 to c; otherwise, compare 0 to c''.

    6.5.9 Equality operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               equality-expression:
                      relational-expression
                      equality-expression == relational-expression
    -                 equality-expression != relational-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + equality-expression != relational-expression + +

    Constraints

    One of the following shall hold:

      @@ -5342,7 +5464,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. unqualified version of void; or
    • one operand is a pointer and the other is a null pointer constant.
    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The == (equal to) and != (not equal to) operators are analogous to the relational operators except for their lower precedence.108) Each of the operators yields 1 if the @@ -5375,7 +5497,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array behaves the same as a pointer to the first element of an array of length one with the type of the object as its element type. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    108) Because of the precedences, a<b == c<d is 1 whenever a<b and c<d have the same truth-value.

    109) Two objects may be adjacent in memory because they are adjacent elements of a larger array or @@ -5386,16 +5508,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.10 Bitwise AND operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               AND-expression:
                     equality-expression
    -                AND-expression & equality-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + AND-expression & equality-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have integer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.

    @@ -5409,16 +5532,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.11 Bitwise exclusive OR operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               exclusive-OR-expression:
                       AND-expression
    -                  exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have integer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.

    @@ -5427,16 +5551,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. operands is set).

    6.5.12 Bitwise inclusive OR operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               inclusive-OR-expression:
                       exclusive-OR-expression
    -                  inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have integer type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The usual arithmetic conversions are performed on the operands.

    @@ -5446,16 +5571,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.13 Logical AND operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               logical-AND-expression:
                       inclusive-OR-expression
    -                  logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have scalar type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The && operator shall yield 1 if both of its operands compare unequal to 0; otherwise, it yields 0. The result has type int. @@ -5466,16 +5592,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. operand is not evaluated.

    6.5.14 Logical OR operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               logical-OR-expression:
                       logical-AND-expression
    -                  logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression + +

    Constraints

    Each of the operands shall have scalar type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The || operator shall yield 1 if either of its operands compare unequal to 0; otherwise, it yields 0. The result has type int. @@ -5487,13 +5614,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.15 Conditional operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               conditional-expression:
                      logical-OR-expression
    -                 logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression + +

    Constraints

    The first operand shall have scalar type.

    @@ -5507,7 +5635,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

  • one operand is a pointer to an object type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified version of void. -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The first operand is evaluated; there is a sequence point between its evaluation and the evaluation of the second or third operand (whichever is evaluated). The second operand @@ -5542,7 +5670,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. const int *c_ip; volatile int *v_ip; int *ip; - const char *c_cp; + const char *c_cp; + the third column in the following table is the common type that is the result of a conditional expression in which the first two columns are the second and third operands (in either order):

    @@ -5551,26 +5680,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                c_ip    v_ip      const volatile int *
                vp      c_cp      const void *
                ip      c_ip      const int *
    -           vp      ip        void *
    + vp ip void * + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    110) A conditional expression does not yield an lvalue.

    6.5.16 Assignment operators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               assignment-expression:
                      conditional-expression
                      unary-expression assignment-operator assignment-expression
               assignment-operator: one of
    -                 = *= /= %= +=                       -=     <<=      >>=      &=     ^=     |=
    -
    Constraints
    + = *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |= + +

    Constraints

    An assignment operator shall have a modifiable lvalue as its left operand. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    An assignment operator stores a value in the object designated by the left operand. An assignment expression has the value of the left operand after the assignment,111) but is not @@ -5584,13 +5715,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    111) The implementation is permitted to read the object to determine the value but is not required to, even when the object has volatile-qualified type.

    6.5.16.1 Simple assignment
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    One of the following shall hold:112)

      @@ -5612,7 +5743,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
    • the left operand has type atomic, qualified, or unqualified _Bool, and the right is a pointer.
    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    In simple assignment (=), the value of the right operand is converted to the type of the assignment expression and replaces the value stored in the object designated by the left @@ -5634,7 +5765,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. char c; /* ... */ if ((c = f()) == -1) - /* ... */ + /* ... */ + the int value returned by the function may be truncated when stored in the char, and then converted back to int width prior to the comparison. In an implementation in which ''plain'' char has the same range of values as unsigned char (and char is narrower than int), the result of the conversion cannot be @@ -5647,7 +5779,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. char c; int i; long l; - l = (c = i); + l = (c = i); + the value of i is converted to the type of the assignment expression c = i, that is, char type. The value of the expression enclosed in parentheses is then converted to the type of the outer assignment expression, that is, long int type. @@ -5660,12 +5793,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. const char c = 'A'; cpp = &p; // constraint violation *cpp = &c; // valid - *p = 0; // valid + *p = 0; // valid + The first assignment is unsafe because it would allow the following valid code to attempt to change the value of the const object c. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    112) The asymmetric appearance of these constraints with respect to type qualifiers is due to the conversion (specified in 6.3.2.1) that changes lvalues to ''the value of the expression'' and thus removes any type qualifiers that were applied to the type category of the expression (for example, it removes const but @@ -5673,7 +5807,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.5.16.2 Compound assignment
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    For the operators += and -= only, either the left operand shall be an atomic, qualified, or unqualified pointer to a complete object type, and the right shall have integer type; or the @@ -5684,7 +5818,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. arithmetic type, and (considering the type the left operand would have after lvalue conversion) each operand shall have arithmetic type consistent with those allowed by the corresponding binary operator. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A compound assignment of the form E1 op = E2 is equivalent to the simple assignment expression E1 = E1 op (E2), except that the lvalue E1 is evaluated only once, and with @@ -5694,7 +5828,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. read-modify-write operation with memory_order_seq_cst memory order semantics.113) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    113) Where a pointer to an atomic object can be formed, this is equivalent to the following code sequence where T is the type of E1: @@ -5703,18 +5837,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. T result; do { result = tmp op (E2); - } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_strong(&E1, &tmp, result)); + } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_strong(&E1, &tmp, result)); + with result being the result of the operation.

    6.5.17 Comma operator

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               expression:
                      assignment-expression
    -                 expression , assignment-expression
    -
    Semantics
    + expression , assignment-expression + +

    Semantics

    The left operand of a comma operator is evaluated as a void expression; there is a sequence point between its evaluation and that of the right operand. Then the right @@ -5725,7 +5861,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. of initializers). On the other hand, it can be used within a parenthesized expression or within the second expression of a conditional operator in such contexts. In the function call

    -          f(a, (t=3, t+2), c)
    + f(a, (t=3, t+2), c) + the function has three arguments, the second of which has the value 5.

    Forward references: initialization (6.7.9). @@ -5735,21 +5872,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    114) A comma operator does not yield an lvalue.

    6.6 Constant expressions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               constant-expression:
    -                 conditional-expression
    -
    Description
    + conditional-expression + +

    Description

    A constant expression can be evaluated during translation rather than runtime, and accordingly may be used in any place that a constant may be. -

    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    Constant expressions shall not contain assignment, increment, decrement, function-call, or comma operators, except when they are contained within a subexpression that is not @@ -5757,7 +5895,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Each constant expression shall evaluate to a constant that is in the range of representable values for its type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    An expression that evaluates to a constant is required in several contexts. If a floating expression is evaluated in the translation environment, the arithmetic precision and range @@ -5810,7 +5948,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    115) The operand of a sizeof operator is usually not evaluated (6.5.3.4).

    116) The use of evaluation formats as characterized by FLT_EVAL_METHOD also applies to evaluation in @@ -5824,12 +5962,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    118) Thus, in the following initialization,

    -           static int i = 2 || 1 / 0;
    + static int i = 2 || 1 / 0; + the expression is a valid integer constant expression with value one.

    6.7 Declarations

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               declaration:
    @@ -5846,8 +5985,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       init-declarator-list , init-declarator
               init-declarator:
                       declarator
    -                  declarator = initializer
    -
    Constraints
    + declarator = initializer + +

    Constraints

    A declaration other than a static_assert declaration shall declare at least a declarator (other than the parameters of a function or the members of a structure or union), a tag, or @@ -5860,7 +6000,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    All declarations in the same scope that refer to the same object or function shall specify compatible types. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A declaration specifies the interpretation and attributes of a set of identifiers. A definition of an identifier is a declaration for that identifier that: @@ -5888,12 +6028,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: declarators (6.7.6), enumeration specifiers (6.7.2.2), initialization (6.7.9), type names (6.7.7), type qualifiers (6.7.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    119) Function definitions have a different syntax, described in 6.9.1.

    6.7.1 Storage-class specifiers

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               storage-class-specifier:
    @@ -5902,8 +6042,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      static
                      _Thread_local
                      auto
    -                 register
    -
    Constraints
    + register + +

    Constraints

    At most, one storage-class specifier may be given in the declaration specifiers in a declaration, except that _Thread_local may appear with static or extern.120) @@ -5912,7 +6053,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. _Thread_local, they shall also include either static or extern. If _Thread_local appears in any declaration of an object, it shall be present in every declaration of that object. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The typedef specifier is called a ''storage-class specifier'' for syntactic convenience only; it is discussed in 6.7.8. The meanings of the various linkages and storage durations @@ -5935,7 +6076,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. or union member objects.

    Forward references: type definitions (6.7.8). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    120) See ''future language directions'' (6.11.5).

    121) The implementation may treat any register declaration simply as an auto declaration. However, @@ -5947,7 +6088,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.2 Type specifiers

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               type-specifier:
    @@ -5965,8 +6106,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      atomic-type-specifier
                      struct-or-union-specifier
                      enum-specifier
    -                 typedef-name
    -
    Constraints
    + typedef-name + +

    Constraints

    At least one type specifier shall be given in the declaration specifiers in each declaration, and in the specifier-qualifier list in each struct declaration and type name. Each list of @@ -6006,7 +6148,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The type specifier _Complex shall not be used if the implementation does not support complex types (see 6.10.8.3). -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    Specifiers for structures, unions, enumerations, and atomic types are discussed in 6.7.2.1 through 6.7.2.4. Declarations of typedef names are discussed in 6.7.8. The @@ -6019,7 +6161,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. structure and union specifiers (6.7.2.1), tags (6.7.2.3), type definitions (6.7.8).

    6.7.2.1 Structure and union specifiers
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               struct-or-union-specifier:
    @@ -6042,8 +6184,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       struct-declarator-list , struct-declarator
               struct-declarator:
                       declarator
    -                  declaratoropt : constant-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + declaratoropt : constant-expression + +

    Constraints

    A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. @@ -6064,7 +6207,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. A bit-field shall have a type that is a qualified or unqualified version of _Bool, signed int, unsigned int, or some other implementation-defined type. It is implementation-defined whether atomic types are permitted. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    As discussed in 6.2.5, a structure is a type consisting of a sequence of members, whose storage is allocated in an ordered sequence, and a union is a type consisting of a sequence @@ -6154,20 +6297,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. } v1; v1.i = 2; // valid v1.k = 3; // invalid: inner structure is not anonymous - v1.w.k = 5; // valid + v1.w.k = 5; // valid +

    EXAMPLE 2 After the declaration:

    -          struct s { int n; double d[]; };
    + struct s { int n; double d[]; }; + the structure struct s has a flexible array member d. A typical way to use this is:
               int m = /* some value */;
    -          struct s *p = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + sizeof (double [m]));
    + struct s *p = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + sizeof (double [m])); + and assuming that the call to malloc succeeds, the object pointed to by p behaves, for most purposes, as if p had been declared as:
    -          struct { int n; double d[m]; } *p;
    + struct { int n; double d[m]; } *p; + (there are circumstances in which this equivalence is broken; in particular, the offsets of member d might not be the same).

    @@ -6176,22 +6323,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. struct s t1 = { 0 }; // valid struct s t2 = { 1, { 4.2 }}; // invalid t1.n = 4; // valid - t1.d[0] = 4.2; // might be undefined behavior + t1.d[0] = 4.2; // might be undefined behavior + The initialization of t2 is invalid (and violates a constraint) because struct s is treated as if it did not contain member d. The assignment to t1.d[0] is probably undefined behavior, but it is possible that

    -          sizeof (struct s) >= offsetof(struct s, d) + sizeof (double)
    + sizeof (struct s) >= offsetof(struct s, d) + sizeof (double) + in which case the assignment would be legitimate. Nevertheless, it cannot appear in strictly conforming code.

    After the further declaration:

    -          struct ss { int n; };
    + struct ss { int n; }; + the expressions:
               sizeof (struct s) >= sizeof (struct ss)
    -          sizeof (struct s) >= offsetof(struct s, d)
    + sizeof (struct s) >= offsetof(struct s, d) + are always equal to 1.

    If sizeof (double) is 8, then after the following code is executed: @@ -6199,38 +6350,44 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. struct s *s1; struct s *s2; s1 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 64); - s2 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 46); + s2 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 46); + and assuming that the calls to malloc succeed, the objects pointed to by s1 and s2 behave, for most purposes, as if the identifiers had been declared as: -

               struct { int n; double d[8]; } *s1;
    -          struct { int n; double d[5]; } *s2;
    + struct { int n; double d[5]; } *s2; + +

    Following the further successful assignments:

               s1 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 10);
    -          s2 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 6);
    + s2 = malloc(sizeof (struct s) + 6); + they then behave as if the declarations were:
    -          struct { int n; double d[1]; } *s1, *s2;
    + struct { int n; double d[1]; } *s1, *s2; + and: -

               double *dp;
               dp = &(s1->d[0]);          //   valid
               *dp = 42;                  //   valid
               dp = &(s2->d[0]);          //   valid
    -          *dp = 42;                  //   undefined behavior
    + *dp = 42; // undefined behavior + +

    The assignment:

    -          *s1 = *s2;
    + *s1 = *s2; + only copies the member n; if any of the array elements are within the first sizeof (struct s) bytes of the structure, they might be copied or simply overwritten with indeterminate values.

    Forward references: declarators (6.7.6), tags (6.7.2.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    122) While the number of bits in a _Bool object is at least CHAR_BIT, the width (number of sign and value bits) of a _Bool may be just 1 bit. @@ -6248,7 +6405,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.2.2 Enumeration specifiers
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               enum-specifier:
    @@ -6260,12 +6417,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     enumerator-list , enumerator
               enumerator:
                     enumeration-constant
    -                enumeration-constant = constant-expression
    -
    Constraints
    + enumeration-constant = constant-expression + +

    Constraints

    The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant shall be an integer constant expression that has a value representable as an int. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The identifiers in an enumerator list are declared as constants that have type int and may appear wherever such are permitted.127) An enumerator with = defines its @@ -6294,13 +6452,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. col = claret; cp = &col; if (*cp != burgundy) - /* ... */ + /* ... */ + makes hue the tag of an enumeration, and then declares col as an object that has that type and cp as a pointer to an object that has that type. The enumerated values are in the set { 0, 1, 20, 21 }.

    Forward references: tags (6.7.2.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    127) Thus, the identifiers of enumeration constants declared in the same scope shall all be distinct from each other and from other identifiers declared in ordinary declarators. @@ -6309,7 +6468,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.2.3 Tags
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A specific type shall have its content defined at most once.

    @@ -6318,9 +6477,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A type specifier of the form

    -         enum identifier
    + enum identifier + without an enumerator list shall only appear after the type it specifies is complete. -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    All declarations of structure, union, or enumerated types that have the same scope and use the same tag declare the same type. Irrespective of whether there is a tag or what @@ -6339,35 +6499,42 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    -          struct-or-union identifieropt { struct-declaration-list }
    + struct-or-union identifieropt { struct-declaration-list } + or
    -          enum identifieropt { enumerator-list }
    + enum identifieropt { enumerator-list } + or
    -          enum identifieropt { enumerator-list , }
    + enum identifieropt { enumerator-list , } + declares a structure, union, or enumerated type. The list defines the structure content, union content, or enumeration content. If an identifier is provided,130) the type specifier also declares the identifier to be the tag of that type.

    A declaration of the form

    -          struct-or-union identifier ;
    + struct-or-union identifier ; + specifies a structure or union type and declares the identifier as a tag of that type.131)

    If a type specifier of the form

    -          struct-or-union identifier
    + struct-or-union identifier + occurs other than as part of one of the above forms, and no other declaration of the identifier as a tag is visible, then it declares an incomplete structure or union type, and declares the identifier as the tag of that type.131)

    If a type specifier of the form

    -          struct-or-union identifier
    + struct-or-union identifier + or
    -          enum identifier
    + enum identifier + occurs other than as part of one of the above forms, and a declaration of the identifier as a tag is visible, then it specifies the same type as that other declaration, and does not redeclare the tag. @@ -6377,7 +6544,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. struct tnode { int count; struct tnode *left, *right; - }; + }; + specifies a structure that contains an integer and two pointers to objects of the same type. Once this declaration has been given, the declaration @@ -6386,7 +6554,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
    -          struct tnode s, *sp;
    + struct tnode s, *sp; + declares s to be an object of the given type and sp to be a pointer to an object of the given type. With these declarations, the expression sp->left refers to the left struct tnode pointer of the object to which sp points; the expression s.right->count designates the count member of the right struct @@ -6399,25 +6568,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int count; TNODE *left, *right; }; - TNODE s, *sp; + TNODE s, *sp; +

    EXAMPLE 2 To illustrate the use of prior declaration of a tag to specify a pair of mutually referential structures, the declarations

               struct s1 { struct s2 *s2p; /* ... */ }; // D1
    -          struct s2 { struct s1 *s1p; /* ... */ }; // D2
    + struct s2 { struct s1 *s1p; /* ... */ }; // D2 + specify a pair of structures that contain pointers to each other. Note, however, that if s2 were already declared as a tag in an enclosing scope, the declaration D1 would refer to it, not to the tag s2 declared in D2. To eliminate this context sensitivity, the declaration
    -          struct s2;
    + struct s2; + may be inserted ahead of D1. This declares a new tag s2 in the inner scope; the declaration D2 then completes the specification of the new type.

    Forward references: declarators (6.7.6), type definitions (6.7.8). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    129) An incomplete type may only by used when the size of an object of that type is not needed. It is not needed, for example, when a typedef name is declared to be a specifier for a structure or union, or when a pointer to or a function returning a structure or union is being declared. (See incomplete types @@ -6432,19 +6604,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.2.4 Atomic type specifiers
    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               atomic-type-specifier:
    -                 _Atomic ( type-name )
    -
    Constraints
    + _Atomic ( type-name ) + +

    Constraints

    Atomic type specifiers shall not be used if the implementation does not support atomic types (see 6.10.8.3).

    The type name in an atomic type specifier shall not refer to an array type, a function type, an atomic type, or a qualified type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The properties associated with atomic types are meaningful only for expressions that are lvalues. If the _Atomic keyword is immediately followed by a left parenthesis, it is @@ -6452,22 +6625,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.3 Type qualifiers

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               type-qualifier:
                      const
                      restrict
                      volatile
    -                 _Atomic
    -
    Constraints
    + _Atomic + +

    Constraints

    Types other than pointer types whose referenced type is an object type shall not be restrict-qualified.

    The type modified by the _Atomic qualifier shall not be an array type or a function type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The properties associated with qualified types are meaningful only for expressions that are lvalues.132) @@ -6513,7 +6687,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 1 An object declared

    -          extern const volatile int real_time_clock;
    + extern const volatile int real_time_clock; + may be modifiable by hardware, but cannot be assigned to, incremented, or decremented.

    @@ -6531,7 +6706,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pi = &ncs.mem; // valid pi = &cs.mem; // violates type constraints for = pci = &cs.mem; // valid - pi = a[0]; // invalid: a[0] has type ''const int *'' + pi = a[0]; // invalid: a[0] has type ''const int *'' + @@ -6539,11 +6715,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 3 The declaration

    -          _Atomic volatile int *p;
    + _Atomic volatile int *p; + specifies that p has the type ''pointer to volatile atomic int'', a pointer to a volatile-qualified atomic type. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    132) The implementation may place a const object that is not volatile in a read-only region of storage. Moreover, the implementation need not allocate storage for such an object if its address is never used. @@ -6598,7 +6775,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               int * restrict a;
               int * restrict b;
    -          extern int c[];
    + extern int c[]; + assert that if an object is accessed using one of a, b, or c, and that object is modified anywhere in the program, then it is never accessed using either of the other two. @@ -6611,7 +6789,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { while (n-- > 0) *p++ = *q++; - } + } + assert that, during each execution of the function, if an object is accessed through one of the pointer parameters, then it is not also accessed through the other.

    @@ -6626,7 +6805,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. extern int d[100]; f(50, d + 50, d); // valid f(50, d + 1, d); // undefined behavior - } + } +

    EXAMPLE 3 The function parameter declarations @@ -6636,7 +6816,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int i; for (i = 0; i < n; i++) p[i] = q[i] + r[i]; - } + } + illustrate how an unmodified object can be aliased through two restricted pointers. In particular, if a and b are disjoint arrays, a call of the form h(100, a, b, b) has defined behavior, because array b is not modified within function h. @@ -6646,7 +6827,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function call and an equivalent nested block. With one exception, only ''outer-to-inner'' assignments between restricted pointers declared in nested blocks have defined behavior. -

              {
                       int * restrict p1;
    @@ -6658,7 +6838,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                             p1 = q2;                // undefined behavior
                             p2 = q2;                // undefined behavior
                       }
    -         }
    + } + +

    The one exception allows the value of a restricted pointer to be carried out of the block in which it (or, more precisely, the ordinary identifier used to designate it) is declared when that block finishes execution. For example, this permits new_vector to return a vector. @@ -6670,10 +6852,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. t.n = n; t.v = malloc(n * sizeof (float)); return t; - } + } + -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    137) In other words, E depends on the value of P itself rather than on the value of an object referenced indirectly through P. For example, if identifier p has type (int **restrict), then the pointer expressions p and p+1 are based on the restricted pointer object designated by p, but the pointer @@ -6681,13 +6864,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.4 Function specifiers

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               function-specifier:
                      inline
    -                 _Noreturn
    -
    Constraints
    + _Noreturn + +

    Constraints

    Function specifiers shall be used only in the declaration of an identifier for a function.

    @@ -6696,7 +6880,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. to an identifier with internal linkage.

    In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall appear in a declaration of main. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A function specifier may appear more than once; the behavior is the same as if it appeared only once. @@ -6722,7 +6906,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function uses the inline definition or the external definition.140)

    A function declared with a _Noreturn function specifier shall not return to its caller. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    The implementation should produce a diagnostic message for a function declared with a _Noreturn function specifier that appears to be capable of returning to its caller. @@ -6730,7 +6914,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 The declaration of an inline function with external linkage can result in either an external definition, or a definition available for use only within the translation unit. A file scope declaration with extern creates an external definition. The following example shows an entire translation unit. -

               inline double fahr(double t)
               {
    @@ -6745,7 +6928,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               {
                     /* A translator may perform inline substitutions */
                     return is_fahr ? cels(temp) : fahr(temp);
    -          }
    + } + +

    Note that the definition of fahr is an external definition because fahr is also declared with extern, but the definition of cels is an inline definition. Because cels has external linkage and is referenced, an external definition has to appear in another translation unit (see 6.9); the inline definition and the external @@ -6764,11 +6949,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. } _Noreturn void g (int i) { // causes undefined behavior if i <= 0 if (i > 0) abort(); - } + } +

    Forward references: function definitions (6.9.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    138) By using, for example, an alternative to the usual function call mechanism, such as ''inline substitution''. Inline substitution is not textual substitution, nor does it create a new function. Therefore, for example, the expansion of a macro used within the body of the function uses the @@ -6786,13 +6972,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.5 Alignment specifier

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               alignment-specifier:
                     _Alignas ( type-name )
    -                _Alignas ( constant-expression )
    -
    Constraints
    + _Alignas ( constant-expression ) + +

    Constraints

    An alignment attribute shall not be specified in a declaration of a typedef, or a bit-field, or a function, or a parameter, or an object declared with the register storage-class @@ -6805,7 +6992,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The combined effect of all alignment attributes in a declaration shall not specify an alignment that is less strict than the alignment that would otherwise be required for the type of the object or member being declared. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The first form is equivalent to _Alignas(alignof(type-name)).

    @@ -6824,13 +7011,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    141) An alignment specification of zero also does not affect other alignment specifications in the same declaration.

    6.7.6 Declarators

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               declarator:
    @@ -6861,8 +7048,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     declaration-specifiers abstract-declaratoropt
               identifier-list:
                      identifier
    -                 identifier-list , identifier
    -
    Semantics
    + identifier-list , identifier + +

    Semantics

    Each declarator declares one identifier, and asserts that when an operand of the same form as the declarator appears in an expression, it designates a function or object with the @@ -6877,23 +7065,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    In the following subclauses, consider a declaration

    -         T D1
    + T D1 + where T contains the declaration specifiers that specify a type T (such as int) and D1 is a declarator that contains an identifier ident. The type specified for the identifier ident in the various forms of declarator is described inductively using this notation.

    If, in the declaration ''T D1'', D1 has the form

    -         identifier
    + identifier + then the type specified for ident is T .

    If, in the declaration ''T D1'', D1 has the form

    -         ( D )
    + ( D ) + then ident has the type specified by the declaration ''T D''. Thus, a declarator in parentheses is identical to the unparenthesized declarator, but the binding of complicated declarators may be altered by parentheses. -
    Implementation limits
    +

    Implementation limits

    As discussed in 5.2.4.1, an implementation may limit the number of pointer, array, and function declarators that modify an arithmetic, structure, union, or void type, either @@ -6901,11 +7092,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: array declarators (6.7.6.2), type definitions (6.7.8).

    6.7.6.1 Pointer declarators
    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If, in the declaration ''T D1'', D1 has the form

    -         * type-qualifier-listopt D
    + * type-qualifier-listopt D + and the type specified for ident in the declaration ''T D'' is ''derived-declarator-type-list T '', then the type specified for ident is ''derived-declarator-type-list type-qualifier-list pointer to T ''. For each type qualifier in the list, ident is a so-qualified pointer. @@ -6918,7 +7110,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               const int *ptr_to_constant;
    -          int *const constant_ptr;
    + int *const constant_ptr; + The contents of any object pointed to by ptr_to_constant shall not be modified through that pointer, but ptr_to_constant itself may be changed to point to another object. Similarly, the contents of the int pointed to by constant_ptr may be modified, but constant_ptr itself shall always point to the @@ -6928,12 +7121,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. type ''pointer to int''.
               typedef int *int_ptr;
    -          const int_ptr constant_ptr;
    + const int_ptr constant_ptr; + declares constant_ptr as an object that has type ''const-qualified pointer to int''.
    6.7.6.2 Array declarators
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    In addition to optional type qualifiers and the keyword static, the [ and ] may delimit an expression or *. If they delimit an expression (which specifies the size of an array), the @@ -6947,14 +7141,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. identifier (as defined in 6.2.3), have no linkage, and have either block scope or function prototype scope. If an identifier is declared to be an object with static or thread storage duration, it shall not have a variable length array type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If, in the declaration ''T D1'', D1 has one of the forms:

               D[ type-qualifier-listopt assignment-expressionopt ]
               D[ static type-qualifier-listopt assignment-expression ]
               D[ type-qualifier-list static assignment-expression ]
    -          D[ type-qualifier-listopt * ]
    + D[ type-qualifier-listopt * ] + and the type specified for ident in the declaration ''T D'' is ''derived-declarator-type-list T '', then the type specified for ident is ''derived-declarator-type-list array of T ''.142) (See 6.7.6.3 for the meaning of the optional type qualifiers and the keyword static.) @@ -6985,14 +7180,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 1

    -          float fa[11], *afp[17];
    + float fa[11], *afp[17]; + declares an array of float numbers and an array of pointers to float numbers.

    EXAMPLE 2 Note the distinction between the declarations

               extern int *x;
    -          extern int y[];
    + extern int y[]; + The first declares x to be a pointer to int; the second declares y to be an array of int of unspecified size (an incomplete type), the storage for which is defined elsewhere. @@ -7010,7 +7207,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. p = a; // invalid: not compatible because 4 != 6 r = c; // compatible, but defined behavior only if // n == 6 and m == n+1 - } + } + @@ -7042,19 +7240,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int (*s)[m]; // valid: auto pointer to VLA extern int (*r)[m]; // invalid: r has linkage and points to VLA static int (*q)[m] = &B; // valid: q is a static block pointer to VLA - } + } +

    Forward references: function declarators (6.7.6.3), function definitions (6.9.1), initialization (6.7.9). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    142) When several ''array of'' specifications are adjacent, a multidimensional array is declared.

    143) Thus, * can be used only in function declarations that are not definitions (see 6.7.6.3).

    6.7.6.3 Function declarators (including prototypes)
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A function declarator shall not specify a return type that is a function type or an array type. @@ -7066,15 +7265,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    After adjustment, the parameters in a parameter type list in a function declarator that is part of a definition of that function shall not have incomplete type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If, in the declaration ''T D1'', D1 has the form

    -        D( parameter-type-list )
    + D( parameter-type-list ) + or
    -        D( identifier-listopt )
    + D( identifier-listopt ) + and the type specified for ident in the declaration ''T D'' is ''derived-declarator-type-list T '', then the type specified for ident is ''derived-declarator-type-list function returning T ''. @@ -7137,7 +7338,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 1 The declaration

    -          int f(void), *fip(), (*pfi)();
    + int f(void), *fip(), (*pfi)(); + declares a function f with no parameters returning an int, a function fip with no parameter specification returning a pointer to an int, and a pointer pfi to a function with no parameter specification returning an int. It is especially useful to compare the last two. The binding of *fip() is *(fip()), so that the @@ -7154,7 +7356,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 2 The declaration

    -          int (*apfi[3])(int *x, int *y);
    + int (*apfi[3])(int *x, int *y); + declares an array apfi of three pointers to functions returning int. Each of these functions has two parameters that are pointers to int. The identifiers x and y are declared for descriptive purposes only and go out of scope at the end of the declaration of apfi. @@ -7162,7 +7365,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE 3 The declaration

    -          int (*fpfi(int (*)(long), int))(int, ...);
    + int (*fpfi(int (*)(long), int))(int, ...); + declares a function fpfi that returns a pointer to a function returning an int. The function fpfi has two parameters: a pointer to a function returning an int (with one parameter of type long int), and an int. The pointer returned by fpfi points to a function that has one int parameter and accepts zero or more @@ -7189,7 +7393,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. for (int j = 0, k = n*m+300; j < k; j++) // a is a pointer to a VLA with n*m+300 elements a[i][j] += x; - } + } +

    EXAMPLE 5 The following are all compatible function prototype declarators. @@ -7197,20 +7402,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. double maximum(int n, int m, double a[n][m]); double maximum(int n, int m, double a[*][*]); double maximum(int n, int m, double a[ ][*]); - double maximum(int n, int m, double a[ ][m]); + double maximum(int n, int m, double a[ ][m]); + as are:

                void   f(double     (* restrict a)[5]);
                void   f(double     a[restrict][5]);
                void   f(double     a[restrict 3][5]);
    -           void   f(double     a[restrict static 3][5]);
    + void f(double a[restrict static 3][5]); + (Note that the last declaration also specifies that the argument corresponding to a in any call to f must be a non-null pointer to the first of at least three arrays of 5 doubles, which the others do not.)

    Forward references: function definitions (6.9.1), type names (6.7.7). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    144) The macros defined in the <stdarg.h> header (7.16) may be used to access arguments that correspond to the ellipsis. @@ -7220,7 +7427,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.7 Type names

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               type-name:
    @@ -7237,8 +7444,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       direct-abstract-declaratoropt [ type-qualifier-list static
                                      assignment-expression ]
                       direct-abstract-declaratoropt [ * ]
    -                  direct-abstract-declaratoropt ( parameter-type-listopt )
    -
    Semantics
    + direct-abstract-declaratoropt ( parameter-type-listopt ) + +

    Semantics

    In several contexts, it is necessary to specify a type. This is accomplished using a type name, which is syntactically a declaration for a function or an object of that type that @@ -7253,7 +7461,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (e) int (*)[*] (f) int *() (g) int (*)(void) - (h) int (*const [])(unsigned int, ...) + (h) int (*const [])(unsigned int, ...) + name respectively the types (a) int, (b) pointer to int, (c) array of three pointers to int, (d) pointer to an array of three ints, (e) pointer to a variable length array of an unspecified number of ints, (f) function with no parameter specification returning a pointer to int, (g) pointer to function with no parameters @@ -7266,21 +7475,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    147) As indicated by the syntax, empty parentheses in a type name are interpreted as ''function with no parameter specification'', rather than redundant parentheses around the omitted identifier.

    6.7.8 Type definitions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               typedef-name:
    -                 identifier
    -
    Constraints
    + identifier + +

    Constraints

    If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type then it shall have block scope. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    In a declaration whose storage-class specifier is typedef, each declarator defines an identifier to be a typedef name that denotes the type specified for the identifier in the way @@ -7290,7 +7500,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. synonym for the type so specified. That is, in the following declarations:

               typedef T type_ident;
    -          type_ident D;
    + type_ident D; + type_ident is defined as a typedef name with the type specified by the declaration specifiers in T (known as T ), and the identifier in D has the type ''derived-declarator- type-list T '' where the derived-declarator-type-list is specified by the declarators of D. A @@ -7300,13 +7511,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 After
               typedef int MILES, KLICKSP();
    -          typedef struct { double hi, lo; } range;
    + typedef struct { double hi, lo; } range; + the constructions
               MILES distance;
               extern KLICKSP *metricp;
               range x;
    -          range z, *zp;
    + range z, *zp; + are all valid declarations. The type of distance is int, that of metricp is ''pointer to function with no parameter specification returning int'', and that of x and z is the specified structure; zp is a pointer to such a structure. The object distance has a type compatible with any other int object. @@ -7315,7 +7528,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 2 After the declarations
               typedef struct s1 { int x; } t1, *tp1;
    -          typedef struct s2 { int x; } t2, *tp2;
    + typedef struct s2 { int x; } t2, *tp2; + type t1 and the type pointed to by tp1 are compatible. Type t1 is also compatible with type struct s1, but not compatible with the types struct s2, t2, the type pointed to by tp2, or int. @@ -7328,7 +7542,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. unsigned t:4; const t:5; plain r:5; - }; + }; + declare a typedef name t with type signed int, a typedef name plain with type int, and a structure with three bit-field members, one named t that contains values in the range [0, 15], an unnamed const- qualified bit-field which (if it could be accessed) would contain values in either the range [-15, +15] or @@ -7339,7 +7554,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. in an inner scope by
               t f(t (t));
    -          long t;
    + long t; + then a function f is declared with type ''function returning signed int with one unnamed parameter with type pointer to function returning signed int with one unnamed parameter with type signed int'', and an identifier t with type long int. @@ -7352,7 +7568,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. typedef void fv(int), (*pfv)(int); void (*signal(int, void (*)(int)))(int); fv *signal(int, fv *); - pfv signal(int, pfv); + pfv signal(int, pfv); +

    EXAMPLE 5 If a typedef name denotes a variable length array type, the length of the array is fixed at the @@ -7367,10 +7584,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int b[n]; // a and b are different sizes for (int i = 1; i < n; i++) a[i-1] = b[i]; - } + } +

    6.7.9 Initialization

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               initializer:
    @@ -7387,8 +7605,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      designator-list designator
               designator:
                      [ constant-expression ]
    -                 . identifier
    -
    Constraints
    + . identifier + +

    Constraints

    No initializer shall attempt to provide a value for an object not contained within the entity being initialized. @@ -7404,18 +7623,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If a designator has the form

    -          [ constant-expression ]
    + [ constant-expression ] + then the current object (defined below) shall have array type and the expression shall be an integer constant expression. If the array is of unknown size, any nonnegative value is valid.

    If a designator has the form

    -          . identifier
    + . identifier + then the current object (defined below) shall have structure or union type and the identifier shall be the name of a member of that type. -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    An initializer specifies the initial value stored in an object.

    @@ -7511,13 +7732,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 Provided that <complex.h> has been #included, the declarations

               int i = 3.5;
    -          double complex c = 5 + 3 * I;
    + double complex c = 5 + 3 * I; + define and initialize i with the value 3 and c with the value 5.0 + i3.0.

    EXAMPLE 2 The declaration

    -          int x[] = { 1, 3, 5 };
    + int x[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; + defines and initializes x as a one-dimensional array object that has three elements, as no size was specified and there are three initializers. @@ -7528,7 +7751,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { 1, 3, 5 }, { 2, 4, 6 }, { 3, 5, 7 }, - }; + }; + is a definition with a fully bracketed initialization: 1, 3, and 5 initialize the first row of y (the array object y[0]), namely y[0][0], y[0][1], and y[0][2]. Likewise the next two lines initialize y[1] and y[2]. The initializer ends early, so y[3] is initialized with zeros. Precisely the same effect could have @@ -7536,7 +7760,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               int y[4][3] = {
                     1, 3, 5, 2, 4, 6, 3, 5, 7
    -          };
    + }; + The initializer for y[0] does not begin with a left brace, so three items from the list are used. Likewise the next three are taken successively for y[1] and y[2]. @@ -7545,13 +7770,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               int z[4][3] = {
                     { 1 }, { 2 }, { 3 }, { 4 }
    -          };
    + }; + initializes the first column of z as specified and initializes the rest with zeros.

    EXAMPLE 5 The declaration

    -          struct { int a[3], b; } w[] = { { 1 }, 2 };
    + struct { int a[3], b; } w[] = { { 1 }, 2 }; + is a definition with an inconsistently bracketed initialization. It defines an array with two element @@ -7566,7 +7793,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { 1 }, { 2, 3 }, { 4, 5, 6 } - }; + }; + contains an incompletely but consistently bracketed initialization. It defines a three-dimensional array object: q[0][0][0] is 1, q[1][0][0] is 2, q[1][0][1] is 3, and 4, 5, and 6 initialize q[2][0][0], q[2][0][1], and q[2][1][0], respectively; all the rest are zero. The initializer for @@ -7580,7 +7808,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 2, 3, 0, 0, 0, 0, 4, 5, 6 - }; + }; + or by:
                short q[4][3][2] = {
    @@ -7594,7 +7823,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                            { 4, 5 },
                            { 6 },
                      }
    -           };
    + }; + in a fully bracketed form.

    Note that the fully bracketed and minimally bracketed forms of initialization are, in general, less likely to @@ -7604,27 +7834,33 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 7 One form of initialization that completes array types involves typedef names. Given the declaration

    -           typedef int A[];          // OK - declared with block scope
    + typedef int A[]; // OK - declared with block scope + the declaration
    -           A a = { 1, 2 }, b = { 3, 4, 5 };
    + A a = { 1, 2 }, b = { 3, 4, 5 }; + is identical to
    -           int a[] = { 1, 2 }, b[] = { 3, 4, 5 };
    + int a[] = { 1, 2 }, b[] = { 3, 4, 5 }; + due to the rules for incomplete types.

    EXAMPLE 8 The declaration

    -          char s[] = "abc", t[3] = "abc";
    + char s[] = "abc", t[3] = "abc"; + defines ''plain'' char array objects s and t whose elements are initialized with character string literals. This declaration is identical to
               char s[] = { 'a', 'b', 'c', '\0' },
    -               t[] = { 'a', 'b', 'c' };
    + t[] = { 'a', 'b', 'c' }; + The contents of the arrays are modifiable. On the other hand, the declaration
    -          char *p = "abc";
    + char *p = "abc"; + defines p with type ''pointer to char'' and initializes it to point to an object with type ''array of char'' with length 4 whose elements are initialized with a character string literal. If an attempt is made to use p to modify the contents of the array, the behavior is undefined. @@ -7637,39 +7873,44 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. const char *nm[] = { [member_two] = "member two", [member_one] = "member one", - }; + }; +

    EXAMPLE 10 Structure members can be initialized to nonzero values without depending on their order:

    -          div_t answer = { .quot = 2, .rem = -1 };
    + div_t answer = { .quot = 2, .rem = -1 }; +

    EXAMPLE 11 Designators can be used to provide explicit initialization when unadorned initializer lists might be misunderstood:

               struct { int a[3], b; } w[] =
    -                { [0].a = {1}, [1].a[0] = 2 };
    + { [0].a = {1}, [1].a[0] = 2 }; +

    EXAMPLE 12 Space can be ''allocated'' from both ends of an array by using a single designator: -

               int a[MAX] = {
                     1, 3, 5, 7, 9, [MAX-5] = 8, 6, 4, 2, 0
    -          };
    + }; + +

    In the above, if MAX is greater than ten, there will be some zero-valued elements in the middle; if it is less than ten, some of the values provided by the first five initializers will be overridden by the second five.

    EXAMPLE 13 Any member of a union can be initialized:

    -          union { /* ... */ } u = { .any_member = 42 };
    + union { /* ... */ } u = { .any_member = 42 }; +

    Forward references: common definitions <stddef.h> (7.19). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    148) If the initializer list for a subaggregate or contained union does not begin with a left brace, its subobjects are initialized as usual, but the subaggregate or contained union does not become the current object: current objects are associated only with brace-enclosed initializer lists. @@ -7687,15 +7928,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.7.10 Static assertions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               static_assert-declaration:
    -                  _Static_assert ( constant-expression , string-literal ) ;
    -
    Constraints
    + _Static_assert ( constant-expression , string-literal ) ; + +

    Constraints

    The constant expression shall compare unequal to 0. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The constant expression shall be an integer constant expression. If the value of the constant expression compares unequal to 0, the declaration has no effect. Otherwise, the @@ -7706,7 +7948,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.8 Statements and blocks

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               statement:
    @@ -7715,8 +7957,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      expression-statement
                      selection-statement
                      iteration-statement
    -                 jump-statement
    -
    Semantics
    + jump-statement + +

    Semantics

    A statement specifies an action to be performed. Except as indicated, statements are executed in sequence. @@ -7739,21 +7982,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (6.8.4), iteration statements (6.8.5), the return statement (6.8.6.4).

    6.8.1 Labeled statements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               labeled-statement:
                      identifier : statement
                      case constant-expression : statement
    -                 default : statement
    -
    Constraints
    + default : statement + +

    Constraints

    A case or default label shall appear only in a switch statement. Further constraints on such labels are discussed under the switch statement.

    Label names shall be unique within a function. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    Any statement may be preceded by a prefix that declares an identifier as a label name. Labels in themselves do not alter the flow of control, which continues unimpeded across @@ -7761,7 +8005,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: the goto statement (6.8.6.1), the switch statement (6.8.4.2).

    6.8.2 Compound statement

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               compound-statement:
    @@ -7771,18 +8015,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       block-item-list block-item
               block-item:
                       declaration
    -                  statement
    -
    Semantics
    + statement + +

    Semantics

    A compound statement is a block.

    6.8.3 Expression and null statements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               expression-statement:
    -                 expressionopt ;
    -
    Semantics
    + expressionopt ; + +

    Semantics

    The expression in an expression statement is evaluated as a void expression for its side effects.153) @@ -7795,7 +8041,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               int p(int);
               /* ... */
    -          (void)p(0);
    + (void)p(0); + @@ -7806,7 +8053,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. char *s; /* ... */ while (*s++ != '\0') - ; + ; + a null statement is used to supply an empty loop body to the iteration statement.

    @@ -7823,23 +8071,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. } /* ... */ end_loop1: ; - } + } +

    Forward references: iteration statements (6.8.5). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    153) Such as assignments, and function calls which have side effects.

    6.8.4 Selection statements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               selection-statement:
                       if ( expression ) statement
                       if ( expression ) statement else statement
    -                  switch ( expression ) statement
    -
    Semantics
    + switch ( expression ) statement + +

    Semantics

    A selection statement selects among a set of statements depending on the value of a controlling expression. @@ -7849,10 +8099,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. subset of the scope of the selection statement.

    6.8.4.1 The if statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The controlling expression of an if statement shall have scalar type. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    In both forms, the first substatement is executed if the expression compares unequal to 0. In the else form, the second substatement is executed if the expression compares equal @@ -7864,7 +8114,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. syntax.

    6.8.4.2 The switch statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The controlling expression of a switch statement shall have integer type.

    @@ -7878,7 +8128,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (Any enclosed switch statement may have a default label or case constant expressions with values that duplicate case constant expressions in the enclosing switch statement.) -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A switch statement causes control to jump to, into, or past the statement that is the switch body, depending on the value of a controlling expression, and on the presence of a @@ -7892,7 +8142,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. a default label, control jumps to the labeled statement. If no converted case constant expression matches and there is no default label, no part of the switch body is executed. -

    Implementation limits
    +

    Implementation limits

    As discussed in 5.2.4.1, the implementation may limit the number of case values in a switch statement. @@ -7913,33 +8163,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /* falls through into default code */ default: printf("%d\n", i); - } + } + the object whose identifier is i exists with automatic storage duration (within the block) but is never initialized, and thus if the controlling expression has a nonzero value, the call to the printf function will access an indeterminate value. Similarly, the call to the function f cannot be reached. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    154) That is, the declaration either precedes the switch statement, or it follows the last case or default label associated with the switch that is in the block containing the declaration.

    6.8.5 Iteration statements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               iteration-statement:
                       while ( expression ) statement
                       do statement while ( expression ) ;
                       for ( expressionopt ; expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement
    -                  for ( declaration expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement
    -
    Constraints
    + for ( declaration expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement + +

    Constraints

    The controlling expression of an iteration statement shall have scalar type.

    The declaration part of a for statement shall only declare identifiers for objects having storage class auto or register. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    An iteration statement causes a statement called the loop body to be executed repeatedly until the controlling expression compares equal to 0. The repetition occurs regardless of @@ -7957,7 +8209,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. a for statement) its expression-3, may be assumed by the implementation to terminate.157) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    155) Code jumped over is not executed. In particular, the controlling expression of a for or while statement is not evaluated before entering the loop body, nor is clause-1 of a for statement. @@ -7981,7 +8233,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The statement

    -          for ( clause-1 ; expression-2 ; expression-3 ) statement
    + for ( clause-1 ; expression-2 ; expression-3 ) statement + behaves as follows: The expression expression-2 is the controlling expression that is evaluated before each execution of the loop body. The expression expression-3 is evaluated as a void expression after each execution of the loop body. If clause-1 is a @@ -7993,7 +8246,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Both clause-1 and expression-3 can be omitted. An omitted expression-2 is replaced by a nonzero constant. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    158) Thus, clause-1 specifies initialization for the loop, possibly declaring one or more variables for use in the loop; the controlling expression, expression-2, specifies an evaluation made before each iteration, such that execution of the loop continues until the expression compares equal to 0; and expression-3 @@ -8001,30 +8254,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.8.6 Jump statements

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               jump-statement:
                      goto identifier ;
                      continue ;
                      break ;
    -                 return expressionopt ;
    + return expressionopt ; + -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A jump statement causes an unconditional jump to another place.

    6.8.6.1 The goto statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The identifier in a goto statement shall name a label located somewhere in the enclosing function. A goto statement shall not jump from outside the scope of an identifier having a variably modified type to inside the scope of that identifier. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A goto statement causes an unconditional jump to the statement prefixed by the named label in the enclosing function. @@ -8037,8 +8291,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

  • The code to determine the next operation is at the head of the loop. (To allow it to be reached by continue statements, for example.) - -

         /* ... */
         goto first_time;
    @@ -8055,7 +8307,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 }
                 // handle other operations
                 /* ... */
    -    }
    + } + + +

    EXAMPLE 2 A goto statement is not allowed to jump past any declarations of objects with variably modified types. A jump within the scope, however, is permitted.

    @@ -8070,14 +8325,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              lab4:
                    a[j] = 6.6;
              }
    -         goto lab4;                         // invalid: going INTO scope of VLA.
    + goto lab4; // invalid: going INTO scope of VLA. +
    6.8.6.2 The continue statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A continue statement shall appear only in or as a loop body. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A continue statement causes a jump to the loop-continuation portion of the smallest enclosing iteration statement; that is, to the end of the loop body. More precisely, in each @@ -8086,21 +8342,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

         /* ... */                            /* ... */                            /* ... */
         continue;                            continue;                            continue;
    -    /* ... */                            /* ... */                            /* ... */
    + /* ... */ /* ... */ /* ... */ + contin: ; contin: ; contin: ; } } while (/* ... */); } unless the continue statement shown is in an enclosed iteration statement (in which case it is interpreted within that statement), it is equivalent to goto contin;.159) -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    159) Following the contin: label is a null statement.

    6.8.6.3 The break statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A break statement shall appear only in or as a switch body or loop body. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A break statement terminates execution of the smallest enclosing switch or iteration statement. @@ -8110,12 +8367,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.8.6.4 The return statement
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A return statement with an expression shall not appear in a function whose return type is void. A return statement without an expression shall only appear in a function whose return type is void. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A return statement terminates execution of the current function and returns control to its caller. A function may have any number of return statements. @@ -8143,7 +8400,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. return g.u1.f2; } /* ... */ - g.u2.f3 = f(); + g.u2.f3 = f(); + there is no undefined behavior, although there would be if the assignment were done directly (without using a function call to fetch the value). @@ -8152,14 +8410,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    160) The return statement is not an assignment. The overlap restriction of subclause 6.5.16.1 does not apply to the case of function return. The representation of floating-point values may have wider range or precision than implied by the type; a cast may be used to remove this extra range and precision.

    6.9 External definitions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               translation-unit:
    @@ -8167,8 +8425,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       translation-unit external-declaration
               external-declaration:
                      function-definition
    -                 declaration
    -
    Constraints
    + declaration + +

    Constraints

    The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. @@ -8178,7 +8437,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. linkage is used in an expression (other than as a part of the operand of a sizeof operator whose result is an integer constant), there shall be exactly one external definition for the identifier in the translation unit. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    As discussed in 5.1.1.1, the unit of program text after preprocessing is a translation unit, which consists of a sequence of external declarations. These are described as ''external'' @@ -8198,21 +8457,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    161) Thus, if an identifier declared with external linkage is not used in an expression, there need be no external definition for it.

    6.9.1 Function definitions

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

               function-definition:
                      declaration-specifiers declarator declaration-listopt compound-statement
               declaration-list:
                      declaration
    -                 declaration-list declaration
    -
    Constraints
    + declaration-list declaration + +

    Constraints

    The identifier declared in a function definition (which is the name of the function) shall have a function type, as specified by the declarator portion of the function definition.162) @@ -8238,7 +8498,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The declarator in a function definition specifies the name of the function being defined and the identifiers of its parameters. If the declarator includes a parameter type list, the @@ -8271,11 +8531,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. extern int max(int a, int b) { return a > b ? a : b; - } + } + extern is the storage-class specifier and int is the type specifier; max(int a, int b) is the function declarator; and

    -          { return a > b ? a : b; }
    + { return a > b ? a : b; } + is the function body. The following similar definition uses the identifier-list form for the parameter declarations: @@ -8288,7 +8550,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int a, b; { return a > b ? a : b; - } + } + Here int a, b; is the declaration list for the parameters. The difference between these two definitions is that the first form acts as a prototype declaration that forces conversion of the arguments of subsequent calls to the function, whereas the second form does not. @@ -8298,24 +8561,27 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                           int f(void);
                           /* ... */
    -                      g(f);
    + g(f); + Then the definition of g might read
               void g(int (*funcp)(void))
               {
                     /* ... */
                     (*funcp)(); /* or funcp(); ...                    */
    -          }
    + } + or, equivalently,
               void g(int func(void))
               {
                     /* ... */
                     func(); /* or (*func)(); ...                   */
    -          }
    + } + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    162) The intent is that the type category in a function definition cannot be inherited from a typedef:

    @@ -8329,7 +8595,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               F *e(void) { /* ... */ }                      //   e returns a pointer to a function
               F *((e))(void) { /* ... */ }                  //   same: parentheses irrelevant
               int (*fp)(void);                              //   fp points to a function that has type F
    -          F *Fp;                                        //   Fp points to a function that has type F
    + F *Fp; // Fp points to a function that has type F +

    163) See ''future language directions'' (6.11.7). @@ -8337,7 +8604,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.9.2 External object definitions

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If the declaration of an identifier for an object has file scope and an initializer, the declaration is an external definition for the identifier. @@ -8370,18 +8637,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. extern int i2; // refers to previous, whose linkage is internal extern int i3; // refers to previous, whose linkage is external extern int i4; // refers to previous, whose linkage is external - extern int i5; // refers to previous, whose linkage is internal + extern int i5; // refers to previous, whose linkage is internal +

    EXAMPLE 2 If at the end of the translation unit containing

    -          int i[];
    + int i[]; + the array i still has incomplete type, the implicit initializer causes it to have one element, which is set to zero on program startup.

    6.10 Preprocessing directives

    -
    Syntax
    +

    Syntax

    @@ -8435,8 +8704,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      preprocessing-token
                      pp-tokens preprocessing-token
               new-line:
    -                 the new-line character
    -
    Description
    + the new-line character + +

    Description

    A preprocessing directive consists of a sequence of preprocessing tokens that satisfies the following constraints: The first token in the sequence is a # preprocessing token that (at @@ -8455,14 +8725,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. When in a group that is skipped (6.10.1), the directive syntax is relaxed to allow any sequence of preprocessing tokens to occur between the directive name and the following new-line character. -

    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The only white-space characters that shall appear between preprocessing tokens within a preprocessing directive (from just after the introducing # preprocessing token through just before the terminating new-line character) are space and horizontal-tab (including spaces that have replaced comments or possibly other white-space characters in translation phase 3). -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The implementation can process and skip sections of source files conditionally, include other source files, and replace macros. These capabilities are called preprocessing, @@ -8474,29 +8744,32 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE In:

                #define EMPTY
    -           EMPTY # include <file.h>
    + EMPTY # include <file.h> + the sequence of preprocessing tokens on the second line is not a preprocessing directive, because it does not begin with a # at the start of translation phase 4, even though it will do so after the macro EMPTY has been replaced. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    165) Thus, preprocessing directives are commonly called ''lines''. These ''lines'' have no other syntactic significance, as all white space is equivalent except in certain situations during preprocessing (see the # character string literal creation operator in 6.10.3.2, for example).

    6.10.1 Conditional inclusion

    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The expression that controls conditional inclusion shall be an integer constant expression except that: identifiers (including those lexically identical to keywords) are interpreted as * described below;166) and it may contain unary operator expressions of the form

    -      defined identifier
    + defined identifier + or
    -      defined ( identifier )
    + defined ( identifier ) + which evaluate to 1 if the identifier is currently defined as a macro name (that is, if it is @@ -8507,12 +8780,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Each preprocessing token that remains (in the list of preprocessing tokens that will become the controlling expression) after all macro replacements have occurred shall be in the lexical form of a token (6.4). -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    Preprocessing directives of the forms

         # if   constant-expression new-line groupopt
    -    # elif constant-expression new-line groupopt
    + # elif constant-expression new-line groupopt + check whether the controlling constant expression evaluates to nonzero.

    Prior to evaluation, macro invocations in the list of preprocessing tokens that will become @@ -8542,7 +8816,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Preprocessing directives of the forms

         # ifdef identifier new-line groupopt
    -    # ifndef identifier new-line groupopt
    + # ifndef identifier new-line groupopt + check whether the identifier is or is not currently defined as a macro name. Their conditions are equivalent to #if defined identifier and #if !defined identifier respectively. @@ -8558,7 +8833,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: macro replacement (6.10.3), source file inclusion (6.10.2), largest integer types (7.20.1.5). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    166) Because the controlling constant expression is evaluated during translation phase 4, all identifiers either are or are not macro names -- there simply are no keywords, enumeration constants, etc. @@ -8577,15 +8852,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.10.2 Source file inclusion

    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A #include directive shall identify a header or source file that can be processed by the implementation. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # include <h-char-sequence> new-line
    + # include <h-char-sequence> new-line + searches a sequence of implementation-defined places for a header identified uniquely by the specified sequence between the < and > delimiters, and causes the replacement of that directive by the entire contents of the header. How the places are specified or the header @@ -8593,7 +8869,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # include "q-char-sequence" new-line
    + # include "q-char-sequence" new-line + causes the replacement of that directive by the entire contents of the source file identified by the specified sequence between the " delimiters. The named source file is searched @@ -8602,13 +8879,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. for in an implementation-defined manner. If this search is not supported, or if the search fails, the directive is reprocessed as if it read
    -    # include <h-char-sequence> new-line
    + # include <h-char-sequence> new-line + with the identical contained sequence (including > characters, if any) from the original directive.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # include pp-tokens new-line
    + # include pp-tokens new-line + (that does not match one of the two previous forms) is permitted. The preprocessing tokens after include in the directive are processed just as in normal text. (Each identifier currently defined as a macro name is replaced by its replacement list of @@ -8630,7 +8909,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 The most common uses of #include preprocessing directives are as in the following:
               #include <stdio.h>
    -          #include "myprog.h"
    + #include "myprog.h" + @@ -8646,17 +8926,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #else #define INCFILE "versN.h" #endif - #include INCFILE + #include INCFILE +

    Forward references: macro replacement (6.10.3). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    170) Note that adjacent string literals are not concatenated into a single string literal (see the translation phases in 5.1.1.2); thus, an expansion that results in two string literals is an invalid directive.

    6.10.3 Macro replacement

    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    Two replacement lists are identical if and only if the preprocessing tokens in both have the same number, ordering, spelling, and white-space separation, where all white-space @@ -8685,7 +8966,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A parameter identifier in a function-like macro shall be uniquely declared within its scope. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The identifier immediately following the define is called the macro name. There is one name space for macro names. Any white-space characters preceding or following the @@ -8698,7 +8979,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # define identifier replacement-list new-line
    + # define identifier replacement-list new-line + defines an object-like macro that causes each subsequent instance of the macro name171) to be replaced by the replacement list of preprocessing tokens that constitute the remainder of the directive. The replacement list is then rescanned for more macro names @@ -8708,7 +8990,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
         # define identifier lparen identifier-listopt ) replacement-list new-line
         # define identifier lparen ... ) replacement-list new-line
    -    # define identifier lparen identifier-list , ... ) replacement-list new-line
    + # define identifier lparen identifier-list , ... ) replacement-list new-line + defines a function-like macro with parameters, whose use is similar syntactically to a function call. The parameters are specified by the optional list of identifiers, whose scope extends from their declaration in the identifier list until the new-line character that @@ -8737,7 +9020,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. merger, the number of arguments is one more than the number of parameters in the macro definition (excluding the ...). -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    171) Since, by macro-replacement time, all character constants and string literals are preprocessing tokens, not sequences possibly containing identifier-like subsequences (see 5.1.1.2, translation phases), they are never scanned for macro names or parameters. @@ -8760,11 +9043,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. replace it.

    6.10.3.2 The # operator
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    Each # preprocessing token in the replacement list for a function-like macro shall be followed by a parameter as the next preprocessing token in the replacement list. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If, in the replacement list, a parameter is immediately preceded by a # preprocessing token, both are replaced by a single character string literal preprocessing token that @@ -8784,11 +9067,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.10.3.3 The ## operator
    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    A ## preprocessing token shall not occur at the beginning or at the end of a replacement list for either form of macro definition. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If, in the replacement list of a function-like macro, a parameter is immediately preceded or followed by a ## preprocessing token, the parameter is replaced by the corresponding @@ -8814,21 +9097,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #define in_between(a) mkstr(a) #define join(c, d) in_between(c hash_hash d) char p[] = join(x, y); // equivalent to - // char p[] = "x ## y"; + // char p[] = "x ## y"; + The expansion produces, at various stages:

              join(x, y)
              in_between(x hash_hash y)
              in_between(x ## y)
              mkstr(x ## y)
    -         "x ## y"
    + "x ## y" + In other words, expanding hash_hash produces a new token, consisting of two adjacent sharp signs, but this new token is not the ## operator. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    173) Placemarker preprocessing tokens do not appear in the syntax because they are temporary entities that exist only within translation phase 4. @@ -8859,14 +9144,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # undef identifier new-line
    + # undef identifier new-line + causes the specified identifier no longer to be defined as a macro name. It is ignored if the specified identifier is not currently defined as a macro name.

    EXAMPLE 1 The simplest use of this facility is to define a ''manifest constant'', as in

              #define TABSIZE 100
    -         int table[TABSIZE];
    + int table[TABSIZE]; +

    EXAMPLE 2 The following defines a function-like macro whose value is the maximum of its arguments. @@ -8875,7 +9162,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. arguments a second time (including side effects) and generating more code than a function if invoked several times. It also cannot have its address taken, as it has none.

    -         #define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
    + #define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b)) + The parentheses ensure that the arguments and the resulting expression are bound properly.

    @@ -8899,13 +9187,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. g(x+(3,4)-w) | h 5) & m (f)^m(m); p() i[q()] = { q(1), r(2,3), r(4,), r(,5), r(,) }; - char c[2][6] = { str(hello), str() }; + char c[2][6] = { str(hello), str() }; + results in

               f(2 * (y+1)) + f(2 * (f(2 * (z[0])))) % f(2 * (0)) + t(1);
               f(2 * (2+(3,4)-0,1)) | f(2 * (~ 5)) & f(2 * (0,1))^m(0,1);
               int i[] = { 1, 23, 4, 5, };
    -          char c[2][6] = { "hello", "" };
    + char c[2][6] = { "hello", "" }; +

    EXAMPLE 4 To illustrate the rules for creating character string literals and concatenating tokens, the @@ -8925,7 +9215,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. == 0) str(: @\n), s); #include xstr(INCFILE(2).h) glue(HIGH, LOW); - xglue(HIGH, LOW) + xglue(HIGH, LOW) + results in

    @@ -8935,7 +9226,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 s);
               #include "vers2.h"    (after macro replacement, before file access)
               "hello";
    -          "hello" ", world"
    + "hello" ", world" + or, after concatenation of the character string literals,
               printf("x1= %d, x2= %s", x1, x2);
    @@ -8944,7 +9236,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 s);
               #include "vers2.h"    (after macro replacement, before file access)
               "hello";
    -          "hello, world"
    + "hello, world" + Space around the # and ## tokens in the macro definition is optional.

    @@ -8952,11 +9245,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               #define t(x,y,z) x ## y ## z
               int j[] = { t(1,2,3), t(,4,5), t(6,,7), t(8,9,),
    -                     t(10,,), t(,11,), t(,,12), t(,,) };
    + t(10,,), t(,11,), t(,,12), t(,,) }; + results in
               int j[] = { 123, 45, 67, 89,
    -                      10, 11, 12, };
    + 10, 11, 12, }; +

    EXAMPLE 6 To demonstrate the redefinition rules, the following sequence is valid. @@ -8966,13 +9261,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #define FUNC_LIKE(a) ( a ) #define FUNC_LIKE( a )( /* note the white space */ \ a /* other stuff on this line - */ ) + */ ) + But the following redefinitions are invalid:

               #define      OBJ_LIKE    (0)     // different token sequence
               #define      OBJ_LIKE    (1 - 1) // different white space
               #define      FUNC_LIKE(b) ( a ) // different parameter usage
    -          #define      FUNC_LIKE(b) ( b ) // different parameter spelling
    + #define FUNC_LIKE(b) ( b ) // different parameter spelling +

    EXAMPLE 7 Finally, to show the variable argument list macro facilities: @@ -8985,21 +9282,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. debug("Flag"); debug("X = %d\n", x); showlist(The first, second, and third items.); - report(x>y, "x is %d but y is %d", x, y); + report(x>y, "x is %d but y is %d", x, y); + results in

               fprintf(stderr, "Flag" );
               fprintf(stderr, "X = %d\n", x );
               puts( "The first, second, and third items." );
               ((x>y)?puts("x>y"):
    -                      printf("x is %d but y is %d", x, y));
    + printf("x is %d but y is %d", x, y)); +

    6.10.4 Line control

    -
    Constraints
    +

    Constraints

    The string literal of a #line directive, if present, shall be a character string literal. -

    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    The line number of the current source line is one greater than the number of new-line characters read or introduced in translation phase 1 (5.1.1.2) while processing the source @@ -9007,7 +9306,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # line digit-sequence new-line
    + # line digit-sequence new-line + causes the implementation to behave as if the following sequence of source lines begins with a source line that has a line number as specified by the digit sequence (interpreted as a decimal integer). The digit sequence shall not specify zero, nor a number greater than @@ -9015,13 +9315,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # line digit-sequence "s-char-sequenceopt" new-line
    + # line digit-sequence "s-char-sequenceopt" new-line + sets the presumed line number similarly and changes the presumed name of the source file to be the contents of the character string literal.

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # line pp-tokens new-line
    + # line pp-tokens new-line + (that does not match one of the two previous forms) is permitted. The preprocessing tokens after line on the directive are processed just as in normal text (each identifier currently defined as a macro name is replaced by its replacement list of preprocessing @@ -9030,20 +9332,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.10.5 Error directive

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # error pp-tokensopt new-line
    + # error pp-tokensopt new-line + causes the implementation to produce a diagnostic message that includes the specified sequence of preprocessing tokens.

    6.10.6 Pragma directive

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # pragma pp-tokensopt new-line
    + # pragma pp-tokensopt new-line + where the preprocessing token STDC does not immediately follow pragma in the directive (prior to any macro replacement)174) causes the implementation to behave in an implementation-defined manner. The behavior might cause translation to fail or cause the @@ -9059,7 +9363,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS on-off-switch #pragma STDC CX_LIMITED_RANGE on-off-switch on-off-switch: one of - ON OFF DEFAULT + ON OFF DEFAULT +

    Forward references: the FP_CONTRACT pragma (7.12.2), the FENV_ACCESS pragma (7.6.1), the CX_LIMITED_RANGE pragma (7.3.4). @@ -9068,7 +9373,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    174) An implementation is not required to perform macro replacement in pragmas, but it is permitted except for in standard pragmas (where STDC immediately follows pragma). If the result of macro replacement in a non-standard pragma has the same form as a standard pragma, the behavior is still @@ -9079,11 +9384,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    6.10.7 Null directive

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A preprocessing directive of the form

    -    # new-line
    + # new-line + has no effect.

    6.10.8 Predefined macro names

    @@ -9100,7 +9406,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. in any standard header.

    Forward references: standard headers (7.1.2). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    176) See ''future language directions'' (6.11.9). @@ -9113,15 +9419,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. months are the same as those generated by the asctime function, and the first character of dd is a space character if the value is less than 10. If the date of translation is not available, an implementation-defined valid date - shall be supplied. + shall be supplied. + __FILE__ The presumed name of the current source file (a character string literal).177) __LINE__ The presumed line number (within the current source file) of the current

    -            source line (an integer constant).177)
    + source line (an integer constant).177) + __STDC__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate a conforming implementation. __STDC_HOSTED__ The integer constant 1 if the implementation is a hosted
    -           implementation or the integer constant 0 if it is not.
    + implementation or the integer constant 0 if it is not. + @@ -9132,10 +9441,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 string literal of the form "hh:mm:ss" as in the time generated by the
                 asctime function. If the time of translation is not available, an
    -            implementation-defined valid time shall be supplied.
    + implementation-defined valid time shall be supplied. +

    Forward references: the asctime function (7.26.3.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    177) The presumed source file name and line number can be changed by the #line directive.

    178) This macro was not specified in ISO/IEC 9899:1990 and was specified as 199409L in @@ -9155,22 +9465,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. consists of all the characters that are defined by ISO/IEC 10646, along with all amendments and technical corrigenda, as of the specified year and month. If some other encoding is used, the macro shall not be defined and - the actual encoding used is implementation-defined. + the actual encoding used is implementation-defined. + __STDC_MB_MIGHT_NEQ_WC__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that, in

                the encoding for wchar_t, a member of the basic character set need not
                have a code value equal to its value when used as the lone character in an
    -           integer character constant.
    + integer character constant. + __STDC_UTF_16__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that values of type
                char16_t are UTF-16 encoded. If some other encoding is used, the
                macro shall not be defined and the actual encoding used is implementation-
    -           defined.
    + defined. + __STDC_UTF_32__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that values of type
                char32_t are UTF-32 encoded. If some other encoding is used, the
                macro shall not be defined and the actual encoding used is implementation-
    -           defined.
    + defined. +

    Forward references: common definitions (7.19), unicode utilities (7.27). @@ -9183,45 +9497,53 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The following macro names are conditionally defined by the implementation: __STDC_ANALYZABLE__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate conformance to

    -           the specifications in annex L (Analyzability).
    + the specifications in annex L (Analyzability). + __STDC_IEC_559__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate conformance to the
    -           specifications in annex F (IEC 60559 floating-point arithmetic).
    + specifications in annex F (IEC 60559 floating-point arithmetic). + __STDC_IEC_559_COMPLEX__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate
                adherence to the specifications in annex G (IEC 60559 compatible complex
    -           arithmetic).
    + arithmetic). + __STDC_LIB_EXT1__ The integer constant 201ymmL, intended to indicate support
    -           for the extensions defined in annex K (Bounds-checking interfaces).179)
    + for the extensions defined in annex K (Bounds-checking interfaces).179) + __STDC_NO_COMPLEX__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that the
                implementation does not support complex types or the <complex.h>
    -           header.
    + header. + __STDC_NO_THREADS__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that the
                implementation does not support atomic types (including the _Atomic
                type qualifier and the <stdatomic.h> header) or the <threads.h>
    -           header.
    + header. + __STDC_NO_VLA__ The integer constant 1, intended to indicate that the -

                implementation does not support variable length arrays or variably
    -           modified types.
    + modified types. + +

    An implementation that defines __STDC_NO_COMPLEX__ shall not define __STDC_IEC_559_COMPLEX__. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    179) The intention is that this will remain an integer constant of type long int that is increased with each revision of this International Standard.

    6.10.9 Pragma operator

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    A unary operator expression of the form:

    -    _Pragma ( string-literal )
    + _Pragma ( string-literal ) + is processed as follows: The string literal is destringized by deleting the L prefix, if present, deleting the leading and trailing double-quotes, replacing each escape sequence \" by a double-quote, and replacing each escape sequence \\ by a single backslash. The @@ -9235,17 +9557,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    EXAMPLE A directive of the form:

    -           #pragma listing on "..\listing.dir"
    + #pragma listing on "..\listing.dir" + can also be expressed as:
    -           _Pragma ( "listing on \"..\\listing.dir\"" )
    + _Pragma ( "listing on \"..\\listing.dir\"" ) + The latter form is processed in the same way whether it appears literally as shown, or results from macro replacement, as in:
                #define LISTING(x) PRAGMA(listing on #x)
                #define PRAGMA(x) _Pragma(#x)
    -           LISTING ( ..\listing.dir )
    + LISTING ( ..\listing.dir ) +

    6.11 Future language directions

    @@ -9331,7 +9656,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    180) The functions that make use of the decimal-point character are the numeric conversion functions (7.22.1, 7.28.4.1) and the formatted input/output functions (7.21.6, 7.28.2). @@ -9350,7 +9675,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. include type qualifiers, unless explicitly stated otherwise.

    The standard headers are183) -

             <assert.h>             <iso646.h>              <stdarg.h>              <string.h>
             <complex.h>            <limits.h>              <stdatomic.h>           <tgmath.h>
    @@ -9358,7 +9682,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
             <errno.h>              <math.h>                <stddef.h>              <time.h>
             <fenv.h>               <setjmp.h>              <stdint.h>              <uchar.h>
             <float.h>              <signal.h>              <stdio.h>               <wchar.h>
    -        <inttypes.h>           <stdalign.h>            <stdlib.h>              <wctype.h>
    + <inttypes.h> <stdalign.h> <stdlib.h> <wctype.h> + +

    If a file with the same name as one of the above < and > delimited sequences, not provided as part of the implementation, is placed in any of the standard places that are searched for included source files, the behavior is undefined. @@ -9388,7 +9714,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. A summary of the contents of the standard headers is given in annex B.

    Forward references: diagnostics (7.2). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    182) A header is not necessarily a source file, nor are the < and > delimited sequences in header names necessarily valid source file names. @@ -9430,7 +9756,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    184) The list of reserved identifiers with external linkage includes math_errhandling, setjmp, va_copy, and va_end. @@ -9494,7 +9820,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdlib.h> const char *str; /* ... */ - i = atoi(str); + i = atoi(str); +

  • by use of its associated header (assuredly generating a true function reference) @@ -9506,23 +9833,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #undef atoi const char *str; /* ... */ - i = atoi(str); + i = atoi(str); + or
                #include <stdlib.h>
                const char *str;
                /* ... */
    -           i = (atoi)(str);
    + i = (atoi)(str); +
  • by explicit declaration
                extern int atoi(const char *);
                const char *str;
                /* ... */
    -           i = atoi(str);
    + i = atoi(str); + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    185) This means that an implementation shall provide an actual function for each library function, even if it also provides a macro for that function. @@ -9534,13 +9864,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. appropriate header could specify

    -           #define abs(x) _BUILTIN_abs(x)
    + #define abs(x) _BUILTIN_abs(x) + for a compiler whose code generator will accept it. In this manner, a user desiring to guarantee that a given library function such as abs will be a genuine function may write
    -           #undef abs
    + #undef abs + whether the implementation's header provides a macro implementation of abs or a built-in implementation. The prototype for the function, which precedes and is hidden by any macro definition, is thereby revealed also. @@ -9559,12 +9891,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The header <assert.h> defines the assert and static_assert macros and refers to another macro,
    -         NDEBUG
    + NDEBUG + which is not defined by <assert.h>. If NDEBUG is defined as a macro name at the point in the source file where <assert.h> is included, the assert macro is defined simply as
    -         #define assert(ignore) ((void)0)
    + #define assert(ignore) ((void)0) + The assert macro is redefined according to the current state of NDEBUG each time that <assert.h> is included.

    @@ -9574,18 +9908,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The macro

    -         static_assert
    + static_assert + expands to _Static_assert.

    7.2.1 Program diagnostics

    7.2.1.1 The assert macro
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <assert.h>
    -         void assert(scalar expression);
    -
    Description
    + void assert(scalar expression); + +

    Description

    The assert macro puts diagnostic tests into programs; it expands to a void expression. When it is executed, if expression (which shall have a scalar type) is false (that is, @@ -9599,13 +9935,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The assert macro returns no value.

    Forward references: the abort function (7.22.4.1). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    191) The message written might be of the form: Assertion failed: expression, function abc, file xyz, line nnn. @@ -9627,26 +9963,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The macro

    -          complex
    + complex + expands to _Complex; the macro
    -          _Complex_I
    + _Complex_I + expands to a constant expression of type const float _Complex, with the value of the imaginary unit.193)

    The macros

    -          imaginary
    + imaginary + and
    -          _Imaginary_I
    + _Imaginary_I + are defined if and only if the implementation supports imaginary types;194) if defined, they expand to _Imaginary and a constant expression of type const float _Imaginary with the value of the imaginary unit.

    The macro

    -          I
    + I + expands to either _Imaginary_I or _Complex_I. If _Imaginary_I is not defined, I shall expand to _Complex_I.

    @@ -9656,7 +9997,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Forward references: IEC 60559-compatible complex arithmetic (annex G). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    192) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.1).

    193) The imaginary unit is a number i such that i 2 = -1. @@ -9689,12 +10030,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. so the cut maps to the positive imaginary axis.

    7.3.4 The CX_LIMITED_RANGE pragma

    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
    -        #pragma STDC CX_LIMITED_RANGE on-off-switch
    -
    Description
    + #pragma STDC CX_LIMITED_RANGE on-off-switch + +

    Description

    The usual mathematical formulas for complex multiply, divide, and absolute value are problematic because of their treatment of infinities and because of undue overflow and @@ -9712,50 +10054,53 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. compound statement. If this pragma is used in any other context, the behavior is undefined. The default state for the pragma is ''off''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    195) The purpose of the pragma is to allow the implementation to use the formulas:

         (x + iy) x (u + iv) = (xu - yv) + i(yu + xv)
         (x + iy) / (u + iv) = [(xu + yv) + i(yu - xv)]/(u2 + v 2 )
         | x + iy | = (sqrt) x 2 + y 2
    -                 -----
    + ----- + where the programmer can determine they are safe.

    7.3.5 Trigonometric functions

    7.3.5.1 The cacos functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex cacos(double complex z);
              float complex cacosf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex cacosl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex cacosl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cacos functions compute the complex arc cosine of z, with branch cuts outside the interval [-1, +1] along the real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cacos functions return the complex arc cosine value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the imaginary axis and in the interval [0, pi ] along the real axis.

    7.3.5.2 The casin functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex casin(double complex z);
              float complex casinf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex casinl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex casinl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The casin functions compute the complex arc sine of z, with branch cuts outside the interval [-1, +1] along the real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The casin functions return the complex arc sine value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the imaginary axis and in the interval [-pi /2, +pi /2] @@ -9764,203 +10109,215 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. along the real axis.

    7.3.5.3 The catan functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex catan(double complex z);
             float complex catanf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex catanl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex catanl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The catan functions compute the complex arc tangent of z, with branch cuts outside the interval [-i, +i] along the imaginary axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The catan functions return the complex arc tangent value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the imaginary axis and in the interval [-pi /2, +pi /2] along the real axis.

    7.3.5.4 The ccos functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex ccos(double complex z);
             float complex ccosf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex ccosl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex ccosl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The ccos functions compute the complex cosine of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ccos functions return the complex cosine value.

    7.3.5.5 The csin functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex csin(double complex z);
             float complex csinf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex csinl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex csinl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The csin functions compute the complex sine of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The csin functions return the complex sine value.

    7.3.5.6 The ctan functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex ctan(double complex z);
              float complex ctanf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex ctanl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex ctanl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The ctan functions compute the complex tangent of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ctan functions return the complex tangent value.

    7.3.6 Hyperbolic functions

    7.3.6.1 The cacosh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex cacosh(double complex z);
              float complex cacoshf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex cacoshl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex cacoshl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cacosh functions compute the complex arc hyperbolic cosine of z, with a branch cut at values less than 1 along the real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cacosh functions return the complex arc hyperbolic cosine value, in the range of a half-strip of nonnegative values along the real axis and in the interval [-ipi , +ipi ] along the imaginary axis.

    7.3.6.2 The casinh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex casinh(double complex z);
              float complex casinhf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex casinhl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex casinhl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The casinh functions compute the complex arc hyperbolic sine of z, with branch cuts outside the interval [-i, +i] along the imaginary axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The casinh functions return the complex arc hyperbolic sine value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the real axis and in the interval [-ipi /2, +ipi /2] along the imaginary axis.

    7.3.6.3 The catanh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex catanh(double complex z);
             float complex catanhf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex catanhl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex catanhl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The catanh functions compute the complex arc hyperbolic tangent of z, with branch cuts outside the interval [-1, +1] along the real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The catanh functions return the complex arc hyperbolic tangent value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the real axis and in the interval [-ipi /2, +ipi /2] along the imaginary axis.

    7.3.6.4 The ccosh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex ccosh(double complex z);
             float complex ccoshf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex ccoshl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex ccoshl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The ccosh functions compute the complex hyperbolic cosine of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ccosh functions return the complex hyperbolic cosine value.

    7.3.6.5 The csinh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex csinh(double complex z);
              float complex csinhf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex csinhl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex csinhl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The csinh functions compute the complex hyperbolic sine of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The csinh functions return the complex hyperbolic sine value.

    7.3.6.6 The ctanh functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex ctanh(double complex z);
              float complex ctanhf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex ctanhl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex ctanhl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The ctanh functions compute the complex hyperbolic tangent of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ctanh functions return the complex hyperbolic tangent value.

    7.3.7 Exponential and logarithmic functions

    7.3.7.1 The cexp functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex cexp(double complex z);
              float complex cexpf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex cexpl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex cexpl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cexp functions compute the complex base-e exponential of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cexp functions return the complex base-e exponential value.

    7.3.7.2 The clog functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex clog(double complex z);
             float complex clogf(float complex z);
    -        long double complex clogl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex clogl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The clog functions compute the complex natural (base-e) logarithm of z, with a branch cut along the negative real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The clog functions return the complex natural logarithm value, in the range of a strip mathematically unbounded along the real axis and in the interval [-ipi , +ipi ] along the @@ -9969,23 +10326,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    7.3.8 Power and absolute-value functions

    7.3.8.1 The cabs functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double cabs(double complex z);
             float cabsf(float complex z);
    -        long double cabsl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double cabsl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cabs functions compute the complex absolute value (also called norm, modulus, or magnitude) of z. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cabs functions return the complex absolute value.

    7.3.8.2 The cpow functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

    @@ -9993,28 +10351,30 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
             double complex cpow(double complex x, double complex y);
             float complex cpowf(float complex x, float complex y);
             long double complex cpowl(long double complex x,
    -             long double complex y);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex y); + +

    Description

    The cpow functions compute the complex power function xy , with a branch cut for the first parameter along the negative real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cpow functions return the complex power function value.

    7.3.8.3 The csqrt functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex csqrt(double complex z);
              float complex csqrtf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex csqrtl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex csqrtl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The csqrt functions compute the complex square root of z, with a branch cut along the negative real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The csqrt functions return the complex square root value, in the range of the right half- plane (including the imaginary axis). @@ -10022,59 +10382,62 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    7.3.9 Manipulation functions

    7.3.9.1 The carg functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double carg(double complex z);
              float cargf(float complex z);
    -         long double cargl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double cargl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The carg functions compute the argument (also called phase angle) of z, with a branch cut along the negative real axis. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The carg functions return the value of the argument in the interval [-pi , +pi ].

    7.3.9.2 The cimag functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double cimag(double complex z);
             float cimagf(float complex z);
    -        long double cimagl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double cimagl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cimag functions compute the imaginary part of z.196) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The cimag functions return the imaginary part value (as a real). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    196) For a variable z of complex type, z == creal(z) + cimag(z)*I.

    7.3.9.3 The CMPLX macros
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <complex.h>
             double complex CMPLX(double x, double y);
             float complex CMPLXF(float x, float y);
    -        long double complex CMPLXL(long double x, long double y);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex CMPLXL(long double x, long double y); + +

    Description

    The CMPLX macros expand to an expression of the specified complex type, with the real part having the (converted) value of x and the imaginary part having the (converted) value of y. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    The resulting expression should be suitable for use as an initializer for an object with static or thread storage duration, provided both arguments are likewise suitable. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The CMPLX macros return the complex value x + i y.

    @@ -10085,7 +10448,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #define CMPLXF(x, y) ((float complex)((float)(x) + \ _Imaginary_I * (float)(y))) #define CMPLXL(x, y) ((long double complex)((long double)(x) + \ - _Imaginary_I * (long double)(y))) + _Imaginary_I * (long double)(y))) + @@ -10093,54 +10457,58 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    7.3.9.4 The conj functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex conj(double complex z);
              float complex conjf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex conjl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex conjl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The conj functions compute the complex conjugate of z, by reversing the sign of its imaginary part. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The conj functions return the complex conjugate value.

    7.3.9.5 The cproj functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double complex cproj(double complex z);
              float complex cprojf(float complex z);
    -         long double complex cprojl(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double complex cprojl(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The cproj functions compute a projection of z onto the Riemann sphere: z projects to z except that all complex infinities (even those with one infinite part and one NaN part) project to positive infinity on the real axis. If z has an infinite part, then cproj(z) is equivalent to

    -         INFINITY + I * copysign(0.0, cimag(z))
    -
    Returns
    + INFINITY + I * copysign(0.0, cimag(z)) + +

    Returns

    The cproj functions return the value of the projection onto the Riemann sphere.

    7.3.9.6 The creal functions
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <complex.h>
              double creal(double complex z);
              float crealf(float complex z);
    -         long double creall(long double complex z);
    -
    Description
    + long double creall(long double complex z); + +

    Description

    The creal functions compute the real part of z.197) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The creal functions return the real part value. @@ -10149,7 +10517,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    197) For a variable z of complex type, z == creal(z) + cimag(z)*I. @@ -10169,7 +10537,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. characters.199) All letters and digits are printing characters.

    Forward references: EOF (7.21.1), localization (7.11). -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    198) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.2).

    199) In an implementation that uses the seven-bit US ASCII character set, the printing characters are those @@ -10183,22 +10551,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. argument c conforms to that in the description of the function.

    7.4.1.1 The isalnum function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #include <ctype.h>
    -          int isalnum(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isalnum(int c); + +

    Description

    The isalnum function tests for any character for which isalpha or isdigit is true.

    7.4.1.2 The isalpha function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #include <ctype.h>
    -          int isalpha(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isalpha(int c); + +

    Description

    The isalpha function tests for any character for which isupper or islower is true, or any character that is one of a locale-specific set of alphabetic characters for which @@ -10209,18 +10579,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. none of iscntrl, isdigit, ispunct, or isspace is true.200) In the "C" locale, isalpha returns true only for the characters for which isupper or islower is true. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    200) The functions islower and isupper test true or false separately for each of these additional characters; all four combinations are possible.

    7.4.1.3 The isblank function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int isblank(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isblank(int c); + +

    Description

    The isblank function tests for any character that is a standard blank character or is one of a locale-specific set of characters for which isspace is true and that is used to @@ -10229,47 +10600,51 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. for the standard blank characters.

    7.4.1.4 The iscntrl function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int iscntrl(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int iscntrl(int c); + +

    Description

    The iscntrl function tests for any control character.

    7.4.1.5 The isdigit function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int isdigit(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isdigit(int c); + +

    Description

    The isdigit function tests for any decimal-digit character (as defined in 5.2.1).

    7.4.1.6 The isgraph function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int isgraph(int c);
    + int isgraph(int c); + -
    Description
    +

    Description

    The isgraph function tests for any printing character except space (' ').

    7.4.1.7 The islower function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int islower(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int islower(int c); + +

    Description

    The islower function tests for any character that is a lowercase letter or is one of a locale-specific set of characters for which none of iscntrl, isdigit, ispunct, or @@ -10277,22 +10652,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. letters (as defined in 5.2.1).

    7.4.1.8 The isprint function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int isprint(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isprint(int c); + +

    Description

    The isprint function tests for any printing character including space (' ').

    7.4.1.9 The ispunct function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int ispunct(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int ispunct(int c); + +

    Description

    The ispunct function tests for any printing character that is one of a locale-specific set of punctuation characters for which neither isspace nor isalnum is true. In the "C" @@ -10300,12 +10677,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. nor isalnum is true.

    7.4.1.10 The isspace function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int isspace(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isspace(int c); + +

    Description

    The isspace function tests for any character that is a standard white-space character or is one of a locale-specific set of characters for which isalnum is false. The standard @@ -10315,12 +10693,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. "C" locale, isspace returns true only for the standard white-space characters.

    7.4.1.11 The isupper function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <ctype.h>
    -        int isupper(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isupper(int c); + +

    Description

    The isupper function tests for any character that is an uppercase letter or is one of a locale-specific set of characters for which none of iscntrl, isdigit, ispunct, or @@ -10328,27 +10707,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. letters (as defined in 5.2.1).

    7.4.1.12 The isxdigit function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <ctype.h>
    -        int isxdigit(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int isxdigit(int c); + +

    Description

    The isxdigit function tests for any hexadecimal-digit character (as defined in 6.4.4.1).

    7.4.2 Character case mapping functions

    7.4.2.1 The tolower function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <ctype.h>
    -        int tolower(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int tolower(int c); + +

    Description

    The tolower function converts an uppercase letter to a corresponding lowercase letter. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If the argument is a character for which isupper is true and there are one or more corresponding characters, as specified by the current locale, for which islower is true, @@ -10357,15 +10738,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    7.4.2.2 The toupper function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <ctype.h>
    -         int toupper(int c);
    -
    Description
    + int toupper(int c); + +

    Description

    The toupper function converts a lowercase letter to a corresponding uppercase letter. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If the argument is a character for which islower is true and there are one or more corresponding characters, as specified by the current locale, for which isupper is true, @@ -10382,11 +10764,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

               EDOM
               EILSEQ
    -          ERANGE
    + ERANGE + which expand to integer constant expressions with type int, distinct positive values, and which are suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives; and
    -          errno
    + errno + which expands to a modifiable lvalue201) that has type int and thread local storage duration, the value of which is set to a positive error number by several library functions. If a macro definition is suppressed in order to access an actual object, or a program @@ -10406,7 +10790,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    201) The macro errno need not be the identifier of an object. It might expand to a modifiable lvalue resulting from a function call (for example, *errno()). @@ -10447,12 +10831,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The type

    -         fenv_t
    + fenv_t + represents the entire floating-point environment.

    The type

    -         fexcept_t
    + fexcept_t + represents the floating-point status flags collectively, including any status the implementation associates with the flags. @@ -10465,7 +10851,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. FE_INEXACT FE_INVALID FE_OVERFLOW - FE_UNDERFLOW + FE_UNDERFLOW + is defined if and only if the implementation supports the floating-point exception by means of the functions in 7.6.2.207) Additional implementation-defined floating-point exceptions, with macro definitions beginning with FE_ and an uppercase letter, may also @@ -10476,7 +10863,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The macro

    -          FE_ALL_EXCEPT
    + FE_ALL_EXCEPT + is simply the bitwise OR of all floating-point exception macros defined by the implementation. If no such macros are defined, FE_ALL_EXCEPT shall be defined as 0.

    @@ -10485,7 +10873,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. FE_DOWNWARD FE_TONEAREST FE_TOWARDZERO - FE_UPWARD + FE_UPWARD + is defined if and only if the implementation supports getting and setting the represented rounding direction by means of the fegetround and fesetround functions. Additional implementation-defined rounding directions, with macro definitions beginning @@ -10499,7 +10888,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    -          FE_DFL_ENV
    + FE_DFL_ENV + represents the default floating-point environment -- the one installed at program startup
    • and has type ''pointer to const-qualified fenv_t''. It can be used as an argument to @@ -10510,7 +10900,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. FE_ and an uppercase letter, and having type ''pointer to const-qualified fenv_t'', may also be specified by the implementation. -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      204) This header is designed to support the floating-point exception status flags and directed-rounding control modes required by IEC 60559, and other similar floating-point state information. It is also designed to facilitate code portability among all systems. @@ -10532,12 +10922,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.6.1 The FENV_ACCESS pragma

      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <fenv.h>
      -          #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS on-off-switch
      -
      Description
      + #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS on-off-switch + +

      Description

      The FENV_ACCESS pragma provides a means to inform the implementation when a program might access the floating-point environment to test floating-point status flags or @@ -10564,7 +10955,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      EXAMPLE -

                #include <fenv.h>
                void f(double x)
      @@ -10576,13 +10966,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      g(x + 1);
                      h(x + 1);
                      /* ... */
      -         }
      + } + +

      If the function g might depend on status flags set as a side effect of the first x + 1, or if the second x + 1 might depend on control modes set as a side effect of the call to function g, then the program shall contain an appropriately placed invocation of #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS ON.211) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      210) The purpose of the FENV_ACCESS pragma is to allow certain optimizations that could subvert flag tests and mode changes (e.g., global common subexpression elimination, code motion, and constant folding). In general, if the state of FENV_ACCESS is ''off'', the translator can assume that default @@ -10601,7 +10993,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. FE_OVERFLOW | FE_INEXACT. For other argument values the behavior of these functions is undefined. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      212) The functions fetestexcept, feraiseexcept, and feclearexcept support the basic abstraction of flags that are either set or clear. An implementation may endow floating-point status flags with more information -- for example, the address of the code which first raised the floating- @@ -10610,16 +11002,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.6.2.1 The feclearexcept function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int feclearexcept(int excepts);
      -
      Description
      + int feclearexcept(int excepts); + +

      Description

      The feclearexcept function attempts to clear the supported floating-point exceptions represented by its argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The feclearexcept function returns zero if the excepts argument is zero or if all the specified exceptions were successfully cleared. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value. @@ -10628,36 +11021,38 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.6.2.2 The fegetexceptflag function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <fenv.h>
                 int fegetexceptflag(fexcept_t *flagp,
      -               int excepts);
      -
      Description
      + int excepts); + +

      Description

      The fegetexceptflag function attempts to store an implementation-defined representation of the states of the floating-point status flags indicated by the argument excepts in the object pointed to by the argument flagp. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fegetexceptflag function returns zero if the representation was successfully stored. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

      7.6.2.3 The feraiseexcept function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <fenv.h>
      -          int feraiseexcept(int excepts);
      -
      Description
      + int feraiseexcept(int excepts); + +

      Description

      The feraiseexcept function attempts to raise the supported floating-point exceptions represented by its argument.213) The order in which these floating-point exceptions are raised is unspecified, except as stated in F.8.6. Whether the feraiseexcept function additionally raises the ''inexact'' floating-point exception whenever it raises the ''overflow'' or ''underflow'' floating-point exception is implementation-defined. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The feraiseexcept function returns zero if the excepts argument is zero or if all the specified exceptions were successfully raised. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value. @@ -10667,20 +11062,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      213) The effect is intended to be similar to that of floating-point exceptions raised by arithmetic operations. Hence, enabled traps for floating-point exceptions raised by this function are taken. The specification in F.8.6 is in the same spirit.

      7.6.2.4 The fesetexceptflag function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
                int fesetexceptflag(const fexcept_t *flagp,
      -              int excepts);
      -
      Description
      + int excepts); + +

      Description

      The fesetexceptflag function attempts to set the floating-point status flags indicated by the argument excepts to the states stored in the object pointed to by @@ -10688,24 +11084,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. fegetexceptflag whose second argument represented at least those floating-point exceptions represented by the argument excepts. This function does not raise floating- point exceptions, but only sets the state of the flags. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fesetexceptflag function returns zero if the excepts argument is zero or if all the specified flags were successfully set to the appropriate state. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

      7.6.2.5 The fetestexcept function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int fetestexcept(int excepts);
      -
      Description
      + int fetestexcept(int excepts); + +

      Description

      The fetestexcept function determines which of a specified subset of the floating- point exception flags are currently set. The excepts argument specifies the floating- point status flags to be queried.214) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fetestexcept function returns the value of the bitwise OR of the floating-point exception macros corresponding to the currently set floating-point exceptions included in @@ -10729,10 +11126,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. if (set_excepts & FE_INVALID) f(); if (set_excepts & FE_OVERFLOW) g(); /* ... */ - } + } + -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      214) This mechanism allows testing several floating-point exceptions with just one function call. @@ -10742,32 +11140,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. modes.

      7.6.3.1 The fegetround function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int fegetround(void);
      -
      Description
      + int fegetround(void); + +

      Description

      The fegetround function gets the current rounding direction. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fegetround function returns the value of the rounding direction macro representing the current rounding direction or a negative value if there is no such rounding direction macro or the current rounding direction is not determinable.

      7.6.3.2 The fesetround function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int fesetround(int round);
      -
      Description
      + int fesetround(int round); + +

      Description

      The fesetround function establishes the rounding direction represented by its argument round. If the argument is not equal to the value of a rounding direction macro, the rounding direction is not changed. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fesetround function returns zero if and only if the requested rounding direction was established. @@ -10789,7 +11189,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /* ... */ fesetround(save_round); /* ... */ - } + } +

      7.6.4 Environment

      @@ -10798,39 +11199,41 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. control modes -- as one entity.
      7.6.4.1 The fegetenv function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <fenv.h>
      -        int fegetenv(fenv_t *envp);
      -
      Description
      + int fegetenv(fenv_t *envp); + +

      Description

      The fegetenv function attempts to store the current floating-point environment in the object pointed to by envp. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fegetenv function returns zero if the environment was successfully stored. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

      7.6.4.2 The feholdexcept function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <fenv.h>
      -        int feholdexcept(fenv_t *envp);
      -
      Description
      + int feholdexcept(fenv_t *envp); + +

      Description

      The feholdexcept function saves the current floating-point environment in the object pointed to by envp, clears the floating-point status flags, and then installs a non-stop (continue on floating-point exceptions) mode, if available, for all floating-point exceptions.215) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The feholdexcept function returns zero if and only if non-stop floating-point exception handling was successfully installed. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      215) IEC 60559 systems have a default non-stop mode, and typically at least one other mode for trap handling or aborting; if the system provides only the non-stop mode then installing it is trivial. For such systems, the feholdexcept function can be used in conjunction with the feupdateenv @@ -10838,37 +11241,39 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.6.4.3 The fesetenv function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int fesetenv(const fenv_t *envp);
      -
      Description
      + int fesetenv(const fenv_t *envp); + +

      Description

      The fesetenv function attempts to establish the floating-point environment represented by the object pointed to by envp. The argument envp shall point to an object set by a call to fegetenv or feholdexcept, or equal a floating-point environment macro. Note that fesetenv merely installs the state of the floating-point status flags represented through its argument, and does not raise these floating-point exceptions. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fesetenv function returns zero if the environment was successfully established. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

      7.6.4.4 The feupdateenv function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <fenv.h>
      -         int feupdateenv(const fenv_t *envp);
      -
      Description
      + int feupdateenv(const fenv_t *envp); + +

      Description

      The feupdateenv function attempts to save the currently raised floating-point exceptions in its automatic storage, install the floating-point environment represented by the object pointed to by envp, and then raise the saved floating-point exceptions. The argument envp shall point to an object set by a call to feholdexcept or fegetenv, or equal a floating-point environment macro. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The feupdateenv function returns zero if all the actions were successfully carried out. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value. @@ -10896,7 +11301,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. if (feupdateenv(&save_env)) return /* indication of an environmental problem */; return result; - } + } +

      7.7 Characteristics of floating types

      @@ -10915,14 +11321,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. It declares functions for manipulating greatest-width integers and converting numeric character strings to greatest-width integers, and it declares the type

      -          imaxdiv_t
      + imaxdiv_t + which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by the imaxdiv function. For each type declared in <stdint.h>, it defines corresponding macros for conversion specifiers for use with the formatted input/output functions.216)

      Forward references: integer types <stdint.h> (7.20), formatted input/output functions (7.21.6), formatted wide character input/output functions (7.28.2). -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      216) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.4). @@ -10939,32 +11346,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. format string to print the value of an integer of type int_fast32_t.

      The fprintf macros for signed integers are: -

               PRIdN             PRIdLEASTN                PRIdFASTN          PRIdMAX             PRIdPTR
      -        PRIiN             PRIiLEASTN                PRIiFASTN          PRIiMAX             PRIiPTR
      + PRIiN PRIiLEASTN PRIiFASTN PRIiMAX PRIiPTR + +

      The fprintf macros for unsigned integers are: -

               PRIoN             PRIoLEASTN                PRIoFASTN          PRIoMAX             PRIoPTR
               PRIuN             PRIuLEASTN                PRIuFASTN          PRIuMAX             PRIuPTR
               PRIxN             PRIxLEASTN                PRIxFASTN          PRIxMAX             PRIxPTR
      -        PRIXN             PRIXLEASTN                PRIXFASTN          PRIXMAX             PRIXPTR
      + PRIXN PRIXLEASTN PRIXFASTN PRIXMAX PRIXPTR + +

      The fscanf macros for signed integers are: -

               SCNdN           SCNdLEASTN               SCNdFASTN              SCNdMAX             SCNdPTR
      -        SCNiN           SCNiLEASTN               SCNiFASTN              SCNiMAX             SCNiPTR
      + SCNiN SCNiLEASTN SCNiFASTN SCNiMAX SCNiPTR + +

      The fscanf macros for unsigned integers are: -

               SCNoN           SCNoLEASTN               SCNoFASTN              SCNoMAX             SCNoPTR
               SCNuN           SCNuLEASTN               SCNuFASTN              SCNuMAX             SCNuPTR
      -        SCNxN           SCNxLEASTN               SCNxFASTN              SCNxMAX             SCNxPTR
      + SCNxN SCNxLEASTN SCNxFASTN SCNxMAX SCNxPTR + +

      For each type that the implementation provides in <stdint.h>, the corresponding fprintf macros shall be defined and the corresponding fscanf macros shall be defined unless the implementation does not have a suitable fscanf length modifier for @@ -10980,10 +11391,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. wprintf(L"The largest integer value is %020" PRIxMAX "\n", i); return 0; - } + } + -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      217) Separate macros are given for use with fprintf and fscanf functions because, in the general case, different format specifiers may be required for fprintf and fscanf, even when the type is the same. @@ -10992,16 +11404,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.8.2 Functions for greatest-width integer types

      7.8.2.1 The imaxabs function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <inttypes.h>
      -         intmax_t imaxabs(intmax_t j);
      -
      Description
      + intmax_t imaxabs(intmax_t j); + +

      Description

      The imaxabs function computes the absolute value of an integer j. If the result cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined.218) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The imaxabs function returns the absolute value. @@ -11010,21 +11423,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      218) The absolute value of the most negative number cannot be represented in two's complement.

      7.8.2.2 The imaxdiv function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <inttypes.h>
      -        imaxdiv_t imaxdiv(intmax_t numer, intmax_t denom);
      -
      Description
      + imaxdiv_t imaxdiv(intmax_t numer, intmax_t denom); + +

      Description

      The imaxdiv function computes numer / denom and numer % denom in a single operation. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The imaxdiv function returns a structure of type imaxdiv_t comprising both the quotient and the remainder. The structure shall contain (in either order) the members @@ -11032,20 +11446,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. either part of the result cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined.

      7.8.2.3 The strtoimax and strtoumax functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <inttypes.h>
               intmax_t strtoimax(const char * restrict nptr,
                    char ** restrict endptr, int base);
               uintmax_t strtoumax(const char * restrict nptr,
      -             char ** restrict endptr, int base);
      -
      Description
      + char ** restrict endptr, int base); + +

      Description

      The strtoimax and strtoumax functions are equivalent to the strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions, except that the initial portion of the string is converted to intmax_t and uintmax_t representation, respectively. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The strtoimax and strtoumax functions return the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value is outside the range @@ -11057,7 +11472,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.8.2.4 The wcstoimax and wcstoumax functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stddef.h>           // for wchar_t
      @@ -11065,13 +11480,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                intmax_t wcstoimax(const wchar_t * restrict nptr,
                     wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base);
                uintmax_t wcstoumax(const wchar_t * restrict nptr,
      -              wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base); + +

      Description

      The wcstoimax and wcstoumax functions are equivalent to the wcstol, wcstoll, wcstoul, and wcstoull functions except that the initial portion of the wide string is converted to intmax_t and uintmax_t representation, respectively. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcstoimax function returns the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value is outside the range of representable @@ -11098,7 +11514,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. or || or_eq |= xor ^ - xor_eq ^= + xor_eq ^= +

      7.10 Sizes of integer types

      @@ -11115,13 +11532,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The type is

      -        struct lconv
      + struct lconv + which contains members related to the formatting of numeric values. The structure shall contain at least the following members, in any order. The semantics of the members and their normal ranges are explained in 7.11.2.1. In the "C" locale, the members shall have the values specified in the comments. -

               char   *decimal_point;                 //   "."
               char   *thousands_sep;                 //   ""
      @@ -11146,7 +11563,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               char   int_p_sep_by_space;             //   CHAR_MAX
               char   int_n_sep_by_space;             //   CHAR_MAX
               char   int_p_sign_posn;                //   CHAR_MAX
      -        char   int_n_sign_posn;                //   CHAR_MAX
      + char int_n_sign_posn; // CHAR_MAX + +

      The macros defined are NULL (described in 7.19); and

                 LC_ALL
      @@ -11154,13 +11573,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 LC_CTYPE
                 LC_MONETARY
                 LC_NUMERIC
      -          LC_TIME
      + LC_TIME + which expand to integer constant expressions with distinct values, suitable for use as the first argument to the setlocale function.219) Additional macro definitions, beginning with the characters LC_ and an uppercase letter,220) may also be specified by the implementation. -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      219) ISO/IEC 9945-2 specifies locale and charmap formats that may be used to specify locales for C.

      220) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.5). @@ -11169,12 +11589,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.11.1 Locale control

      7.11.1.1 The setlocale function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <locale.h>
      -          char *setlocale(int category, const char *locale);
      -
      Description
      + char *setlocale(int category, const char *locale); + +

      Description

      The setlocale function selects the appropriate portion of the program's locale as specified by the category and locale arguments. The setlocale function may be @@ -11197,13 +11618,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      At program startup, the equivalent of

      -         setlocale(LC_ALL, "C");
      + setlocale(LC_ALL, "C"); + is executed.

      A call to the setlocale function may introduce a data race with other calls to the setlocale function or with calls to functions that are affected by the current locale. The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the setlocale function. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If a pointer to a string is given for locale and the selection can be honored, the setlocale function returns a pointer to the string associated with the specified @@ -11223,7 +11645,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (7.22.8), numeric conversion functions (7.22.1), the strcoll function (7.23.4.3), the strftime function (7.26.3.5), the strxfrm function (7.23.4.5). -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      221) The only functions in 7.4 whose behavior is not affected by the current locale are isdigit and isxdigit. @@ -11234,12 +11656,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.11.2 Numeric formatting convention inquiry

      7.11.2.1 The localeconv function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <locale.h>
      -         struct lconv *localeconv(void);
      -
      Description
      + struct lconv *localeconv(void); + +

      Description

      The localeconv function sets the components of an object with type struct lconv with values appropriate for the formatting of numeric quantities (monetary and otherwise) @@ -11257,128 +11680,156 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. available in the current locale. The members include the following: char *decimal_point

      -           The decimal-point character used to format nonmonetary quantities.
      + The decimal-point character used to format nonmonetary quantities. + char *thousands_sep
                  The character used to separate groups of digits before the decimal-point
      -           character in formatted nonmonetary quantities.
      + character in formatted nonmonetary quantities. + char *grouping
                  A string whose elements indicate the size of each group of digits in
      -           formatted nonmonetary quantities.
      + formatted nonmonetary quantities. + char *mon_decimal_point
      -           The decimal-point used to format monetary quantities.
      + The decimal-point used to format monetary quantities. + char *mon_thousands_sep
                  The separator for groups of digits before the decimal-point in formatted
      -           monetary quantities.
      + monetary quantities. + char *mon_grouping
                  A string whose elements indicate the size of each group of digits in
      -           formatted monetary quantities.
      + formatted monetary quantities. + char *positive_sign
                  The string used to indicate a nonnegative-valued formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char *negative_sign
      -           The string used to indicate a negative-valued formatted monetary quantity.
      + The string used to indicate a negative-valued formatted monetary quantity. + char *currency_symbol
      -           The local currency symbol applicable to the current locale.
      + The local currency symbol applicable to the current locale. + char frac_digits
                  The number of fractional digits (those after the decimal-point) to be
      -           displayed in a locally formatted monetary quantity.
      + displayed in a locally formatted monetary quantity. + char p_cs_precedes
                  Set to 1 or 0 if the currency_symbol respectively precedes or
      -           succeeds the value for a nonnegative locally formatted monetary quantity.
      + succeeds the value for a nonnegative locally formatted monetary quantity. + char n_cs_precedes
                  Set to 1 or 0 if the currency_symbol respectively precedes or
      -           succeeds the value for a negative locally formatted monetary quantity.
      + succeeds the value for a negative locally formatted monetary quantity. + char p_sep_by_space
                  Set to a value indicating the separation of the currency_symbol, the
                  sign string, and the value for a nonnegative locally formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char n_sep_by_space
                  Set to a value indicating the separation of the currency_symbol, the
                  sign string, and the value for a negative locally formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char p_sign_posn
                  Set to a value indicating the positioning of the positive_sign for a
      -           nonnegative locally formatted monetary quantity.
      + nonnegative locally formatted monetary quantity. + char n_sign_posn
                  Set to a value indicating the positioning of the negative_sign for a
      -           negative locally formatted monetary quantity.
      + negative locally formatted monetary quantity. + char *int_curr_symbol
                  The international currency symbol applicable to the current locale. The
                  first three characters contain the alphabetic international currency symbol
                  in accordance with those specified in ISO 4217. The fourth character
                  (immediately preceding the null character) is the character used to separate
      -           the international currency symbol from the monetary quantity.
      + the international currency symbol from the monetary quantity. + char int_frac_digits
                  The number of fractional digits (those after the decimal-point) to be
      -           displayed in an internationally formatted monetary quantity.
      + displayed in an internationally formatted monetary quantity. + char int_p_cs_precedes
                  Set to 1 or 0 if the int_curr_symbol respectively precedes or
                  succeeds the value for a nonnegative internationally formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char int_n_cs_precedes
                  Set to 1 or 0 if the int_curr_symbol respectively precedes or
                  succeeds the value for a negative internationally formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char int_p_sep_by_space
                  Set to a value indicating the separation of the int_curr_symbol, the
                  sign string, and the value for a nonnegative internationally formatted
      -           monetary quantity.
      + monetary quantity. + char int_n_sep_by_space
                  Set to a value indicating the separation of the int_curr_symbol, the
                  sign string, and the value for a negative internationally formatted monetary
      -           quantity.
      + quantity. + char int_p_sign_posn
                  Set to a value indicating the positioning of the positive_sign for a
      -           nonnegative internationally formatted monetary quantity.
      + nonnegative internationally formatted monetary quantity. + char int_n_sign_posn -

                  Set to a value indicating the positioning of the negative_sign for a
      -           negative internationally formatted monetary quantity.
      + negative internationally formatted monetary quantity. + +

      The elements of grouping and mon_grouping are interpreted according to the following: CHAR_MAX No further grouping is to be performed. 0 The previous element is to be repeatedly used for the remainder of the

      -               digits.
      + digits. + other The integer value is the number of digits that compose the current group. -

                      The next element is examined to determine the size of the next group of
      -               digits before the current group.
      + digits before the current group. + +

      The values of p_sep_by_space, n_sep_by_space, int_p_sep_by_space, and int_n_sep_by_space are interpreted according to the following: 0 No space separates the currency symbol and value. 1 If the currency symbol and sign string are adjacent, a space separates them from the

      -     value; otherwise, a space separates the currency symbol from the value.
      + value; otherwise, a space separates the currency symbol from the value. + 2 If the currency symbol and sign string are adjacent, a space separates them;
      -     otherwise, a space separates the sign string from the value.
      + otherwise, a space separates the sign string from the value. + For int_p_sep_by_space and int_n_sep_by_space, the fourth character of int_curr_symbol is used instead of a space.

      @@ -11393,7 +11844,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the localeconv function. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The localeconv function returns a pointer to the filled-in object. The structure pointed to by the return value shall not be modified by the program, but may be @@ -11404,7 +11855,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 The following table illustrates rules which may well be used by four countries to format monetary quantities.

      -                               Local format                                     International format
      + Local format International format + Country Positive Negative Positive Negative @@ -11416,7 +11868,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. For these four countries, the respective values for the monetary members of the structure returned by localeconv could be:
      -                                   Country1              Country2              Country3            Country4
      + Country1 Country2 Country3 Country4 + mon_decimal_point "," "" "," "." mon_thousands_sep "." "." "." "," @@ -11444,7 +11897,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 2 The following table illustrates how the cs_precedes, sep_by_space, and sign_posn members affect the formatted value.
      -                                                               p_sep_by_space
      + p_sep_by_space + p_cs_precedes p_sign_posn 0 1 2 @@ -11453,7 +11907,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. 1 +1.25$ +1.25 $ + 1.25$ 2 1.25$+ 1.25 $+ 1.25$ + 3 1.25+$ 1.25 +$ 1.25+ $ - 4 1.25$+ 1.25 $+ 1.25$ + + 4 1.25$+ 1.25 $+ 1.25$ + +
      @@ -11461,7 +11916,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                                             1         +$1.25             +$ 1.25             + $1.25
                                             2         $1.25+             $ 1.25+             $1.25 +
                                             3         +$1.25             +$ 1.25             + $1.25
      -                                      4         $+1.25             $+ 1.25             $ +1.25
      + 4 $+1.25 $+ 1.25 $ +1.25 +

      7.12 Mathematics

      @@ -11475,7 +11931,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The types

                float_t
      -         double_t
      + double_t + are floating types at least as wide as float and double, respectively, and such that double_t is at least as wide as float_t. If FLT_EVAL_METHOD equals 0, float_t and double_t are float and double, respectively; if @@ -11485,17 +11942,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The macro

      -         HUGE_VAL
      + HUGE_VAL + expands to a positive double constant expression, not necessarily representable as a float. The macros
                HUGE_VALF
      -         HUGE_VALL
      + HUGE_VALL + are respectively float and long double analogs of HUGE_VAL.225)

      The macro

      -         INFINITY
      + INFINITY + expands to a constant expression of type float representing positive or unsigned infinity, if available; else to a positive constant of type float that overflows at @@ -11506,7 +11966,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The macro

      -          NAN
      + NAN + is defined if and only if the implementation supports quiet NaNs for the float type. It expands to a constant expression of type float representing a quiet NaN.

      @@ -11516,7 +11977,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. FP_NAN FP_NORMAL FP_SUBNORMAL - FP_ZERO + FP_ZERO + represent the mutually exclusive kinds of floating-point values. They expand to integer constant expressions with distinct values. Additional implementation-defined floating- point classifications, with macro definitions beginning with FP_ and an uppercase letter, @@ -11524,20 +11986,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The macro

      -          FP_FAST_FMA
      + FP_FAST_FMA + is optionally defined. If defined, it indicates that the fma function generally executes about as fast as, or faster than, a multiply and an add of double operands.227) The macros
                 FP_FAST_FMAF
      -          FP_FAST_FMAL
      + FP_FAST_FMAL + are, respectively, float and long double analogs of FP_FAST_FMA. If defined, these macros expand to the integer constant 1.

      The macros

                 FP_ILOGB0
      -          FP_ILOGBNAN
      + FP_ILOGBNAN + expand to integer constant expressions whose values are returned by ilogb(x) if x is zero or NaN, respectively. The value of FP_ILOGB0 shall be either INT_MIN or -INT_MAX. The value of FP_ILOGBNAN shall be either INT_MAX or INT_MIN. @@ -11548,10 +12013,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The macros
                MATH_ERRNO
      -         MATH_ERREXCEPT
      + MATH_ERREXCEPT + expand to the integer constants 1 and 2, respectively; the macro
      -         math_errhandling
      + math_errhandling + expands to an expression that has type int and the value MATH_ERRNO, MATH_ERREXCEPT, or the bitwise OR of both. The value of math_errhandling is constant for the duration of the program. It is unspecified whether @@ -11562,7 +12029,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. shall define the macros FE_DIVBYZERO, FE_INVALID, and FE_OVERFLOW in <fenv.h>. -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      223) Particularly on systems with wide expression evaluation, a <math.h> function might pass arguments and return values in wider format than the synopsis prototype indicates. @@ -11643,7 +12110,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      228) In an implementation that supports infinities, this allows an infinity as an argument to be a domain error if the mathematical domain of the function does not include the infinity. @@ -11654,12 +12121,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.2 The FP_CONTRACT pragma

      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
      -          #pragma STDC FP_CONTRACT on-off-switch
      -
      Description
      + #pragma STDC FP_CONTRACT on-off-switch + +

      Description

      The FP_CONTRACT pragma can be used to allow (if the state is ''on'') or disallow (if the state is ''off'') the implementation to contract expressions (6.5). Each pragma can occur @@ -11680,18 +12148,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. expression of real floating type.

      7.12.3.1 The fpclassify macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
      -          int fpclassify(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int fpclassify(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The fpclassify macro classifies its argument value as NaN, infinite, normal, subnormal, zero, or into another implementation-defined category. First, an argument represented in a format wider than its semantic type is converted to its semantic type. Then classification is based on the type of the argument.231) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fpclassify macro returns the value of the number classification macro appropriate to the value of its argument. * @@ -11699,52 +12168,55 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      231) Since an expression can be evaluated with more range and precision than its type has, it is important to know the type that classification is based on. For example, a normal long double value might become subnormal when converted to double, and zero when converted to float.

      7.12.3.2 The isfinite macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int isfinite(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int isfinite(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The isfinite macro determines whether its argument has a finite value (zero, subnormal, or normal, and not infinite or NaN). First, an argument represented in a format wider than its semantic type is converted to its semantic type. Then determination is based on the type of the argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isfinite macro returns a nonzero value if and only if its argument has a finite value.

      7.12.3.3 The isinf macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int isinf(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int isinf(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The isinf macro determines whether its argument value is an infinity (positive or negative). First, an argument represented in a format wider than its semantic type is converted to its semantic type. Then determination is based on the type of the argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isinf macro returns a nonzero value if and only if its argument has an infinite value.

      7.12.3.4 The isnan macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int isnan(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int isnan(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The isnan macro determines whether its argument value is a NaN. First, an argument represented in a format wider than its semantic type is converted to its semantic type. @@ -11752,42 +12224,44 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isnan macro returns a nonzero value if and only if its argument has a NaN value. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      232) For the isnan macro, the type for determination does not matter unless the implementation supports NaNs in the evaluation type but not in the semantic type.

      7.12.3.5 The isnormal macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int isnormal(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int isnormal(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The isnormal macro determines whether its argument value is normal (neither zero, subnormal, infinite, nor NaN). First, an argument represented in a format wider than its semantic type is converted to its semantic type. Then determination is based on the type of the argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isnormal macro returns a nonzero value if and only if its argument has a normal value.

      7.12.3.6 The signbit macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int signbit(real-floating x);
      -
      Description
      + int signbit(real-floating x); + +

      Description

      The signbit macro determines whether the sign of its argument value is negative.233) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The signbit macro returns a nonzero value if and only if the sign of its argument value is negative. @@ -11797,7 +12271,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      233) The signbit macro reports the sign of all values, including infinities, zeros, and NaNs. If zero is unsigned, it is treated as positive. @@ -11805,283 +12279,300 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.4 Trigonometric functions

      7.12.4.1 The acos functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double acos(double x);
                float acosf(float x);
      -         long double acosl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double acosl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The acos functions compute the principal value of the arc cosine of x. A domain error occurs for arguments not in the interval [-1, +1]. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The acos functions return arccos x in the interval [0, pi ] radians.

      7.12.4.2 The asin functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double asin(double x);
                float asinf(float x);
      -         long double asinl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double asinl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The asin functions compute the principal value of the arc sine of x. A domain error occurs for arguments not in the interval [-1, +1]. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The asin functions return arcsin x in the interval [-pi /2, +pi /2] radians.

      7.12.4.3 The atan functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double atan(double x);
                float atanf(float x);
      -         long double atanl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double atanl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The atan functions compute the principal value of the arc tangent of x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atan functions return arctan x in the interval [-pi /2, +pi /2] radians.

      7.12.4.4 The atan2 functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double atan2(double y, double x);
               float atan2f(float y, float x);
      -        long double atan2l(long double y, long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double atan2l(long double y, long double x); + +

      Description

      The atan2 functions compute the value of the arc tangent of y/x, using the signs of both arguments to determine the quadrant of the return value. A domain error may occur if both arguments are zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atan2 functions return arctan y/x in the interval [-pi , +pi ] radians.

      7.12.4.5 The cos functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double cos(double x);
               float cosf(float x);
      -        long double cosl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double cosl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The cos functions compute the cosine of x (measured in radians). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The cos functions return cos x.

      7.12.4.6 The sin functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double sin(double x);
               float sinf(float x);
      -        long double sinl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double sinl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The sin functions compute the sine of x (measured in radians). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The sin functions return sin x.

      7.12.4.7 The tan functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double tan(double x);
                float tanf(float x);
      -         long double tanl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double tanl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The tan functions return the tangent of x (measured in radians). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The tan functions return tan x.

      7.12.5 Hyperbolic functions

      7.12.5.1 The acosh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double acosh(double x);
                float acoshf(float x);
      -         long double acoshl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double acoshl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The acosh functions compute the (nonnegative) arc hyperbolic cosine of x. A domain error occurs for arguments less than 1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The acosh functions return arcosh x in the interval [0, +(inf)].

      7.12.5.2 The asinh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double asinh(double x);
                float asinhf(float x);
      -         long double asinhl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double asinhl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The asinh functions compute the arc hyperbolic sine of x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The asinh functions return arsinh x.

      7.12.5.3 The atanh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double atanh(double x);
               float atanhf(float x);
      -        long double atanhl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double atanhl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The atanh functions compute the arc hyperbolic tangent of x. A domain error occurs for arguments not in the interval [-1, +1]. A pole error may occur if the argument equals -1 or +1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atanh functions return artanh x.

      7.12.5.4 The cosh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double cosh(double x);
               float coshf(float x);
      -        long double coshl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double coshl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The cosh functions compute the hyperbolic cosine of x. A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The cosh functions return cosh x.

      7.12.5.5 The sinh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double sinh(double x);
               float sinhf(float x);
      -        long double sinhl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double sinhl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The sinh functions compute the hyperbolic sine of x. A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The sinh functions return sinh x.

      7.12.5.6 The tanh functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double tanh(double x);
                float tanhf(float x);
      -         long double tanhl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double tanhl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The tanh functions compute the hyperbolic tangent of x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The tanh functions return tanh x.

      7.12.6 Exponential and logarithmic functions

      7.12.6.1 The exp functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double exp(double x);
                float expf(float x);
      -         long double expl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double expl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The exp functions compute the base-e exponential of x. A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The exp functions return ex .

      7.12.6.2 The exp2 functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double exp2(double x);
                float exp2f(float x);
      -         long double exp2l(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double exp2l(long double x); + +

      Description

      The exp2 functions compute the base-2 exponential of x. A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The exp2 functions return 2x .

      7.12.6.3 The expm1 functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double expm1(double x);
                float expm1f(float x);
      -         long double expm1l(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double expm1l(long double x); + +

      Description

      The expm1 functions compute the base-e exponential of the argument, minus 1. A range error occurs if x is too large.234) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The expm1 functions return ex - 1. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      234) For small magnitude x, expm1(x) is expected to be more accurate than exp(x) - 1.

      7.12.6.4 The frexp functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double frexp(double value, int *exp);
                float frexpf(float value, int *exp);
      -         long double frexpl(long double value, int *exp);
      -
      Description
      + long double frexpl(long double value, int *exp); + +

      Description

      The frexp functions break a floating-point number into a normalized fraction and an integral power of 2. They store the integer in the int object pointed to by exp. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If value is not a floating-point number or if the integral power of 2 is outside the range of int, the results are unspecified. Otherwise, the frexp functions return the value x, @@ -12094,14 +12585,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.6.5 The ilogb functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                int ilogb(double x);
                int ilogbf(float x);
      -         int ilogbl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + int ilogbl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The ilogb functions extract the exponent of x as a signed int value. If x is zero they compute the value FP_ILOGB0; if x is infinite they compute the value INT_MAX; if x is @@ -12109,74 +12601,78 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the corresponding logb function and casting the returned value to type int. A domain error or range error may occur if x is zero, infinite, or NaN. If the correct value is outside the range of the return type, the numeric result is unspecified. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The ilogb functions return the exponent of x as a signed int value.

      Forward references: the logb functions (7.12.6.11).

      7.12.6.6 The ldexp functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double ldexp(double x, int exp);
                float ldexpf(float x, int exp);
      -         long double ldexpl(long double x, int exp);
      -
      Description
      + long double ldexpl(long double x, int exp); + +

      Description

      The ldexp functions multiply a floating-point number by an integral power of 2. A range error may occur. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The ldexp functions return x x 2exp .

      7.12.6.7 The log functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double log(double x);
                float logf(float x);
      -         long double logl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double logl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The log functions compute the base-e (natural) logarithm of x. A domain error occurs if the argument is negative. A pole error may occur if the argument is zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The log functions return loge x.

      7.12.6.8 The log10 functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double log10(double x);
                float log10f(float x);
      -         long double log10l(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double log10l(long double x); + +

      Description

      The log10 functions compute the base-10 (common) logarithm of x. A domain error occurs if the argument is negative. A pole error may occur if the argument is zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The log10 functions return log10 x.

      7.12.6.9 The log1p functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double log1p(double x);
                float log1pf(float x);
      -         long double log1pl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double log1pl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The log1p functions compute the base-e (natural) logarithm of 1 plus the argument.235) A domain error occurs if the argument is less than -1. A pole error may occur if the argument equals -1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The log1p functions return loge (1 + x). @@ -12185,66 +12681,70 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      235) For small magnitude x, log1p(x) is expected to be more accurate than log(1 + x).

      7.12.6.10 The log2 functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double log2(double x);
                float log2f(float x);
      -         long double log2l(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double log2l(long double x); + +

      Description

      The log2 functions compute the base-2 logarithm of x. A domain error occurs if the argument is less than zero. A pole error may occur if the argument is zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The log2 functions return log2 x.

      7.12.6.11 The logb functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double logb(double x);
                float logbf(float x);
      -         long double logbl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double logbl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The logb functions extract the exponent of x, as a signed integer value in floating-point format. If x is subnormal it is treated as though it were normalized; thus, for positive finite x,

      -       1 <= x x FLT_RADIX-logb(x) < FLT_RADIX
      + 1 <= x x FLT_RADIX-logb(x) < FLT_RADIX + A domain error or pole error may occur if the argument is zero. -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The logb functions return the signed exponent of x.

      7.12.6.12 The modf functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double modf(double value, double *iptr);
                float modff(float value, float *iptr);
      -         long double modfl(long double value, long double *iptr);
      -
      Description
      + long double modfl(long double value, long double *iptr); + +

      Description

      The modf functions break the argument value into integral and fractional parts, each of which has the same type and sign as the argument. They store the integral part (in floating-point format) in the object pointed to by iptr. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The modf functions return the signed fractional part of value.

      7.12.6.13 The scalbn and scalbln functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
      @@ -12253,189 +12753,205 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               long double scalbnl(long double x, int n);
               double scalbln(double x, long int n);
               float scalblnf(float x, long int n);
      -        long double scalblnl(long double x, long int n);
      -
      Description
      + long double scalblnl(long double x, long int n); + +

      Description

      The scalbn and scalbln functions compute x x FLT_RADIXn efficiently, not normally by computing FLT_RADIXn explicitly. A range error may occur. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The scalbn and scalbln functions return x x FLT_RADIXn .

      7.12.7 Power and absolute-value functions

      7.12.7.1 The cbrt functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double cbrt(double x);
               float cbrtf(float x);
      -        long double cbrtl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double cbrtl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The cbrt functions compute the real cube root of x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The cbrt functions return x1/3 .

      7.12.7.2 The fabs functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double fabs(double x);
                float fabsf(float x);
      -         long double fabsl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double fabsl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The fabs functions compute the absolute value of a floating-point number x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fabs functions return | x |.

      7.12.7.3 The hypot functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double hypot(double x, double y);
                float hypotf(float x, float y);
      -         long double hypotl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double hypotl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The hypot functions compute the square root of the sum of the squares of x and y, without undue overflow or underflow. A range error may occur.

      -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The hypot functions return (sqrt)x2 + y2 .

                                   -
      -                            -----
      + ----- +
      7.12.7.4 The pow functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double pow(double x, double y);
                float powf(float x, float y);
      -         long double powl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double powl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The pow functions compute x raised to the power y. A domain error occurs if x is finite and negative and y is finite and not an integer value. A range error may occur. A domain error may occur if x is zero and y is zero. A domain error or pole error may occur if x is zero and y is less than zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The pow functions return xy .

      7.12.7.5 The sqrt functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double sqrt(double x);
               float sqrtf(float x);
      -        long double sqrtl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double sqrtl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The sqrt functions compute the nonnegative square root of x. A domain error occurs if the argument is less than zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The sqrt functions return (sqrt)x.

                                  -
      -                           -
      + - +

      7.12.8 Error and gamma functions

      7.12.8.1 The erf functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double erf(double x);
               float erff(float x);
      -        long double erfl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double erfl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The erf functions compute the error function of x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

                                           2        x
                                                (integral)       e-t dt.
      -                                                   2
      + 2 + The erf functions return erf x =
                                           (sqrt)pi
                                           -
      -                                    -    0
      + - 0 +
      7.12.8.2 The erfc functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double erfc(double x);
               float erfcf(float x);
      -        long double erfcl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double erfcl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The erfc functions compute the complementary error function of x. A range error occurs if x is too large. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

                                                            2       (inf)
                                                                (integral)       e-t dt.
      -                                                                   2
      + 2 + The erfc functions return erfc x = 1 - erf x =
                                                         (sqrt)pi
                                                         -
      -                                                  -      x
      + - x +
      7.12.8.3 The lgamma functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double lgamma(double x);
                float lgammaf(float x);
      -         long double lgammal(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double lgammal(long double x); + +

      Description

      The lgamma functions compute the natural logarithm of the absolute value of gamma of x. A range error occurs if x is too large. A pole error may occur if x is a negative integer or zero. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The lgamma functions return loge | (Gamma)(x) |.

      7.12.8.4 The tgamma functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double tgamma(double x);
                float tgammaf(float x);
      -         long double tgammal(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double tgammal(long double x); + +

      Description

      The tgamma functions compute the gamma function of x. A domain error or pole error may occur if x is a negative integer or zero. A range error occurs if the magnitude of x is too large and may occur if the magnitude of x is too small. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The tgamma functions return (Gamma)(x). @@ -12443,72 +12959,76 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.9 Nearest integer functions

      7.12.9.1 The ceil functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double ceil(double x);
               float ceilf(float x);
      -        long double ceill(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double ceill(long double x); + +

      Description

      The ceil functions compute the smallest integer value not less than x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The ceil functions return [^x^], expressed as a floating-point number.

      7.12.9.2 The floor functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double floor(double x);
               float floorf(float x);
      -        long double floorl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double floorl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The floor functions compute the largest integer value not greater than x. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The floor functions return [_x_], expressed as a floating-point number.

      7.12.9.3 The nearbyint functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double nearbyint(double x);
               float nearbyintf(float x);
      -        long double nearbyintl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double nearbyintl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The nearbyint functions round their argument to an integer value in floating-point format, using the current rounding direction and without raising the ''inexact'' floating- point exception. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The nearbyint functions return the rounded integer value.

      7.12.9.4 The rint functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double rint(double x);
                float rintf(float x);
      -         long double rintl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double rintl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The rint functions differ from the nearbyint functions (7.12.9.3) only in that the rint functions may raise the ''inexact'' floating-point exception if the result differs in value from the argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The rint functions return the rounded integer value.

      7.12.9.5 The lrint and llrint functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      @@ -12517,37 +13037,39 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                long int lrintl(long double x);
                long long int llrint(double x);
                long long int llrintf(float x);
      -         long long int llrintl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long long int llrintl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The lrint and llrint functions round their argument to the nearest integer value, rounding according to the current rounding direction. If the rounded value is outside the range of the return type, the numeric result is unspecified and a domain error or range error may occur. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The lrint and llrint functions return the rounded integer value.

      7.12.9.6 The round functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double round(double x);
               float roundf(float x);
      -        long double roundl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double roundl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The round functions round their argument to the nearest integer value in floating-point format, rounding halfway cases away from zero, regardless of the current rounding direction. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The round functions return the rounded integer value.

      7.12.9.7 The lround and llround functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
      @@ -12556,48 +13078,51 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               long int lroundl(long double x);
               long long int llround(double x);
               long long int llroundf(float x);
      -        long long int llroundl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long long int llroundl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The lround and llround functions round their argument to the nearest integer value, rounding halfway cases away from zero, regardless of the current rounding direction. If the rounded value is outside the range of the return type, the numeric result is unspecified and a domain error or range error may occur. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The lround and llround functions return the rounded integer value.

      7.12.9.8 The trunc functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double trunc(double x);
               float truncf(float x);
      -        long double truncl(long double x);
      -
      Description
      + long double truncl(long double x); + +

      Description

      The trunc functions round their argument to the integer value, in floating format, nearest to but no larger in magnitude than the argument. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The trunc functions return the truncated integer value.

      7.12.10 Remainder functions

      7.12.10.1 The fmod functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
                 double fmod(double x, double y);
                 float fmodf(float x, float y);
      -          long double fmodl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double fmodl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The fmod functions compute the floating-point remainder of x/y. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fmod functions return the value x - ny, for some integer n such that, if y is nonzero, the result has the same sign as x and magnitude less than the magnitude of y. If y is zero, @@ -12605,14 +13130,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. defined.

      7.12.10.2 The remainder functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
                 double remainder(double x, double y);
                 float remainderf(float x, float y);
      -          long double remainderl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double remainderl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The remainder functions compute the remainder x REM y required by IEC 60559.236) @@ -12620,12 +13146,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The remainder functions return x REM y. If y is zero, whether a domain error occurs or the functions return zero is implementation defined. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      236) ''When y != 0, the remainder r = x REM y is defined regardless of the rounding mode by the mathematical relation r = x - ny, where n is the integer nearest the exact value of x/y; whenever | n - x/y | = 1/2, then n is even. If r = 0, its sign shall be that of x.'' This definition is applicable for * @@ -12633,21 +13159,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.10.3 The remquo functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double remquo(double x, double y, int *quo);
               float remquof(float x, float y, int *quo);
               long double remquol(long double x, long double y,
      -             int *quo);
      -
      Description
      + int *quo); + +

      Description

      The remquo functions compute the same remainder as the remainder functions. In the object pointed to by quo they store a value whose sign is the sign of x/y and whose magnitude is congruent modulo 2n to the magnitude of the integral quotient of x/y, where n is an implementation-defined integer greater than or equal to 3. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The remquo functions return x REM y. If y is zero, the value stored in the object pointed to by quo is unspecified and whether a domain error occurs or the functions @@ -12656,33 +13183,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.11 Manipulation functions

      7.12.11.1 The copysign functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
               double copysign(double x, double y);
               float copysignf(float x, float y);
      -        long double copysignl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double copysignl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The copysign functions produce a value with the magnitude of x and the sign of y. They produce a NaN (with the sign of y) if x is a NaN. On implementations that represent a signed zero but do not treat negative zero consistently in arithmetic operations, the copysign functions regard the sign of zero as positive. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The copysign functions return a value with the magnitude of x and the sign of y.

      7.12.11.2 The nan functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double nan(const char *tagp);
                float nanf(const char *tagp);
      -         long double nanl(const char *tagp);
      -
      Description
      + long double nanl(const char *tagp); + +

      Description

      The call nan("n-char-sequence") is equivalent to strtod("NAN(n-char- sequence)", (char**) NULL); the call nan("") is equivalent to @@ -12690,28 +13219,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. sequence or an empty string, the call is equivalent to strtod("NAN", (char**) NULL). Calls to nanf and nanl are equivalent to the corresponding calls to strtof and strtold. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The nan functions return a quiet NaN, if available, with content indicated through tagp. If the implementation does not support quiet NaNs, the functions return zero.

      Forward references: the strtod, strtof, and strtold functions (7.22.1.3).

      7.12.11.3 The nextafter functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double nextafter(double x, double y);
                float nextafterf(float x, float y);
      -         long double nextafterl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double nextafterl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The nextafter functions determine the next representable value, in the type of the function, after x in the direction of y, where x and y are first converted to the type of the function.237) The nextafter functions return y if x equals y. A range error may occur if the magnitude of x is the largest finite value representable in the type and the result is infinite or not representable in the type. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The nextafter functions return the next representable value in the specified format after x in the direction of y. @@ -12719,26 +13249,27 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      237) The argument values are converted to the type of the function, even by a macro implementation of the function.

      7.12.11.4 The nexttoward functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double nexttoward(double x, long double y);
                float nexttowardf(float x, long double y);
      -         long double nexttowardl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double nexttowardl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The nexttoward functions are equivalent to the nextafter functions except that the second parameter has type long double and the functions return y converted to the type of the function if x equals y.238) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      238) The result of the nexttoward functions is determined in the type of the function, without loss of range or precision in a floating second argument. @@ -12746,85 +13277,90 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.12 Maximum, minimum, and positive difference functions

      7.12.12.1 The fdim functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double fdim(double x, double y);
                float fdimf(float x, float y);
      -         long double fdiml(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double fdiml(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The fdim functions determine the positive difference between their arguments:

              {x - y if x > y
              {
      -       {+0     if x <= y
      + {+0 if x <= y + A range error may occur. -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fdim functions return the positive difference value.

      7.12.12.2 The fmax functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double fmax(double x, double y);
                float fmaxf(float x, float y);
      -         long double fmaxl(long double x, long double y);
      + long double fmaxl(long double x, long double y); + -
      Description
      +

      Description

      The fmax functions determine the maximum numeric value of their arguments.239) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fmax functions return the maximum numeric value of their arguments. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      239) NaN arguments are treated as missing data: if one argument is a NaN and the other numeric, then the fmax functions choose the numeric value. See F.10.9.2.

      7.12.12.3 The fmin functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double fmin(double x, double y);
                float fminf(float x, float y);
      -         long double fminl(long double x, long double y);
      -
      Description
      + long double fminl(long double x, long double y); + +

      Description

      The fmin functions determine the minimum numeric value of their arguments.240) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fmin functions return the minimum numeric value of their arguments. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      240) The fmin functions are analogous to the fmax functions in their treatment of NaNs.

      7.12.13 Floating multiply-add

      7.12.13.1 The fma functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
                double fma(double x, double y, double z);
                float fmaf(float x, float y, float z);
                long double fmal(long double x, long double y,
      -              long double z);
      -
      Description
      + long double z); + +

      Description

      The fma functions compute (x x y) + z, rounded as one ternary operation: they compute the value (as if) to infinite precision and round once to the result format, according to the current rounding mode. A range error may occur. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The fma functions return (x x y) + z, rounded as one ternary operation. @@ -12846,7 +13382,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the synopses in this subclause, real-floating indicates that the argument shall be an expression of real floating type242) (both arguments need not have the same type).243) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      241) IEC 60559 requires that the built-in relational operators raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception if the operands compare unordered, as an error indicator for programs written without consideration of NaNs; the result in these cases is false. @@ -12859,102 +13395,108 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.12.14.1 The isgreater macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
      -          int isgreater(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      -
      Description
      + int isgreater(real-floating x, real-floating y); + +

      Description

      The isgreater macro determines whether its first argument is greater than its second argument. The value of isgreater(x, y) is always equal to (x) > (y); however, unlike (x) > (y), isgreater(x, y) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception when x and y are unordered. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isgreater macro returns the value of (x) > (y).

      7.12.14.2 The isgreaterequal macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <math.h>
      -          int isgreaterequal(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      + int isgreaterequal(real-floating x, real-floating y); + -
      Description
      +

      Description

      The isgreaterequal macro determines whether its first argument is greater than or equal to its second argument. The value of isgreaterequal(x, y) is always equal to (x) >= (y); however, unlike (x) >= (y), isgreaterequal(x, y) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception when x and y are unordered. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isgreaterequal macro returns the value of (x) >= (y).

      7.12.14.3 The isless macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int isless(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      -
      Description
      + int isless(real-floating x, real-floating y); + +

      Description

      The isless macro determines whether its first argument is less than its second argument. The value of isless(x, y) is always equal to (x) < (y); however, unlike (x) < (y), isless(x, y) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception when x and y are unordered. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isless macro returns the value of (x) < (y).

      7.12.14.4 The islessequal macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <math.h>
      -         int islessequal(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      -
      Description
      + int islessequal(real-floating x, real-floating y); + +

      Description

      The islessequal macro determines whether its first argument is less than or equal to its second argument. The value of islessequal(x, y) is always equal to (x) <= (y); however, unlike (x) <= (y), islessequal(x, y) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception when x and y are unordered. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The islessequal macro returns the value of (x) <= (y).

      7.12.14.5 The islessgreater macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
      -        int islessgreater(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      -
      Description
      + int islessgreater(real-floating x, real-floating y); + +

      Description

      The islessgreater macro determines whether its first argument is less than or greater than its second argument. The islessgreater(x, y) macro is similar to (x) < (y) || (x) > (y); however, islessgreater(x, y) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception when x and y are unordered (nor does it evaluate x and y twice). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The islessgreater macro returns the value of (x) < (y) || (x) > (y).

      7.12.14.6 The isunordered macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <math.h>
      -        int isunordered(real-floating x, real-floating y);
      -
      Description
      + int isunordered(real-floating x, real-floating y); + +

      Description

      The isunordered macro determines whether its arguments are unordered. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The isunordered macro returns 1 if its arguments are unordered and 0 otherwise. @@ -12966,7 +13508,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The type declared is

      -         jmp_buf
      + jmp_buf + which is an array type suitable for holding the information needed to restore a calling environment. The environment of a call to the setjmp macro consists of information sufficient for a call to the longjmp function to return execution to the correct block and @@ -12978,7 +13521,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. linkage. If a macro definition is suppressed in order to access an actual function, or a program defines an external identifier with the name setjmp, the behavior is undefined. -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      244) These functions are useful for dealing with unusual conditions encountered in a low-level function of a program. @@ -12986,21 +13529,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.13.1 Save calling environment

      7.13.1.1 The setjmp macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <setjmp.h>
      -         int setjmp(jmp_buf env);
      -
      Description
      + int setjmp(jmp_buf env); + +

      Description

      The setjmp macro saves its calling environment in its jmp_buf argument for later use by the longjmp function. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If the return is from a direct invocation, the setjmp macro returns the value zero. If the return is from a call to the longjmp function, the setjmp macro returns a nonzero value. -

      Environmental limits
      +

      Environmental limits

      An invocation of the setjmp macro shall appear only in one of the following contexts:

        @@ -13021,12 +13565,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.13.2 Restore calling environment

        7.13.2.1 The longjmp function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <setjmp.h>
        -          _Noreturn void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val);
        -
        Description
        + _Noreturn void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val); + +

        Description

        The longjmp function restores the environment saved by the most recent invocation of the setjmp macro in the same invocation of the program with the corresponding @@ -13041,7 +13586,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. invocation of the corresponding setjmp macro that do not have volatile-qualified type and have been changed between the setjmp invocation and longjmp call are indeterminate. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        After longjmp is completed, program execution continues as if the corresponding invocation of the setjmp macro had just returned the value specified by val. The @@ -13077,9 +13622,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { int b[n]; // b may remain allocated longjmp(buf, 2); // might cause memory loss - } + } + -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        245) For example, by executing a return statement or because another longjmp call has caused a transfer to a setjmp invocation in a function earlier in the set of nested calls. @@ -13093,7 +13639,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The type defined is

        -          sig_atomic_t
        + sig_atomic_t + which is the (possibly volatile-qualified) integer type of an object that can be accessed as an atomic entity, even in the presence of asynchronous interrupts.

        @@ -13101,13 +13648,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                   SIG_DFL
                   SIG_ERR
        -          SIG_IGN
        + SIG_IGN + which expand to constant expressions with distinct values that have type compatible with the second argument to, and the return value of, the signal function, and whose values compare unequal to the address of any declarable function; and the following, which expand to positive integer constant expressions with type int and distinct values that are the signal numbers, each corresponding to the specified condition: -

                   SIGABRT abnormal termination, such as is initiated by the abort function
                   SIGFPE        an erroneous arithmetic operation, such as zero divide or an operation
        @@ -13115,7 +13662,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                   SIGILL        detection of an invalid function image, such as an invalid instruction
                   SIGINT        receipt of an interactive attention signal
                   SIGSEGV an invalid access to storage
        -          SIGTERM a termination request sent to the program
        + SIGTERM a termination request sent to the program + +

        An implementation need not generate any of these signals, except as a result of explicit calls to the raise function. Additional signals and pointers to undeclarable functions, with macro definitions beginning, respectively, with the letters SIG and an uppercase @@ -13128,7 +13677,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        247) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.6). The names of the signal numbers reflect the following terms (respectively): abort, floating-point exception, illegal instruction, interrupt, segmentation violation, and termination. @@ -13137,12 +13686,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.14.1 Specify signal handling

        7.14.1.1 The signal function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <signal.h>
        -         void (*signal(int sig, void (*func)(int)))(int);
        -
        Description
        + void (*signal(int sig, void (*func)(int)))(int); + +

        Description

        The signal function chooses one of three ways in which receipt of the signal number sig is to be subsequently handled. If the value of func is SIG_DFL, default handling @@ -13180,15 +13730,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        At program startup, the equivalent of

        -        signal(sig, SIG_IGN);
        + signal(sig, SIG_IGN); + may be executed for some signals selected in an implementation-defined manner; the equivalent of
        -        signal(sig, SIG_DFL);
        + signal(sig, SIG_DFL); + is executed for all other signals defined by the implementation.

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the signal function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the request can be honored, the signal function returns the value of func for the most recent successful call to signal for the specified signal sig. Otherwise, a value of @@ -13196,7 +13748,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        Forward references: the abort function (7.22.4.1), the exit function (7.22.4.4), the _Exit function (7.22.4.5), the quick_exit function (7.22.4.7). -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        248) This includes functions called indirectly via standard library functions (e.g., a SIGABRT handler called via the abort function). @@ -13206,17 +13758,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.14.2 Send signal

        7.14.2.1 The raise function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <signal.h>
        -        int raise(int sig);
        -
        Description
        + int raise(int sig); + +

        Description

        The raise function carries out the actions described in 7.14.1.1 for the signal sig. If a signal handler is called, the raise function shall not return until after the signal handler does. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The raise function returns zero if successful, nonzero if unsuccessful. @@ -13227,12 +13780,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The macro

        -         alignas
        + alignas + expands to _Alignas.

        The remaining macro is suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives. It is

        -         __alignas_is_defined
        + __alignas_is_defined + which expands to the integer constant 1. @@ -13249,7 +13804,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The type declared is

        -         va_list
        + va_list + which is a complete object type suitable for holding information needed by the macros va_start, va_arg, va_end, and va_copy. If access to the varying arguments is desired, the called function shall declare an object (generally referred to as ap in this @@ -13258,7 +13814,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. value of ap in the calling function is indeterminate and shall be passed to the va_end macro prior to any further reference to ap.250) -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        250) It is permitted to create a pointer to a va_list and pass that pointer to another function, in which case the original function may make further use of the original list after the other function returns. @@ -13274,12 +13830,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function.

        7.16.1.1 The va_arg macro
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdarg.h>
        -         type va_arg(va_list ap, type);
        -
        Description
        + type va_arg(va_list ap, type); + +

        Description

        The va_arg macro expands to an expression that has the specified type and the value of the next argument in the call. The parameter ap shall have been initialized by the @@ -13298,36 +13855,38 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. type, and the value is representable in both types;

      • one type is pointer to void and the other is a pointer to a character type.
      -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The first invocation of the va_arg macro after that of the va_start macro returns the value of the argument after that specified by parmN . Successive invocations return the values of the remaining arguments in succession.

      7.16.1.2 The va_copy macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdarg.h>
      -         void va_copy(va_list dest, va_list src);
      -
      Description
      + void va_copy(va_list dest, va_list src); + +

      Description

      The va_copy macro initializes dest as a copy of src, as if the va_start macro had been applied to dest followed by the same sequence of uses of the va_arg macro as had previously been used to reach the present state of src. Neither the va_copy nor va_start macro shall be invoked to reinitialize dest without an intervening invocation of the va_end macro for the same dest. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The va_copy macro returns no value.

      7.16.1.3 The va_end macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdarg.h>
      -         void va_end(va_list ap);
      -
      Description
      + void va_end(va_list ap); + +

      Description

      The va_end macro facilitates a normal return from the function whose variable argument list was referred to by the expansion of the va_start macro, or the function @@ -13337,17 +13896,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. by the va_start or va_copy macro). If there is no corresponding invocation of the va_start or va_copy macro, or if the va_end macro is not invoked before the return, the behavior is undefined. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The va_end macro returns no value.

      7.16.1.4 The va_start macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdarg.h>
      -         void va_start(va_list ap, parmN);
      -
      Description
      + void va_start(va_list ap, parmN); + +

      Description

      The va_start macro shall be invoked before any access to the unnamed arguments.

      @@ -13360,7 +13920,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. parmN is declared with the register storage class, with a function or array type, or with a type that is not compatible with the type that results after application of the default argument promotions, the behavior is undefined. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The va_start macro returns no value.

      @@ -13383,10 +13943,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array[ptr_no++] = va_arg(ap, char *); va_end(ap); f2(n_ptrs, array); - } + } + Each call to f1 is required to have visible the definition of the function or a declaration such as

      -          void f1(int, ...);
      + void f1(int, ...); +

      EXAMPLE 2 The function f3 is similar, but saves the status of the variable argument list after the @@ -13418,7 +13980,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array[ptr_no++] = va_arg(ap_save, char *); va_end(ap_save); f4(n_ptrs, array); - } + } +

      7.17 Atomics

      @@ -13440,25 +14003,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. ATOMIC_INT_LOCK_FREE ATOMIC_LONG_LOCK_FREE ATOMIC_LLONG_LOCK_FREE - ATOMIC_ADDRESS_LOCK_FREE + ATOMIC_ADDRESS_LOCK_FREE + which indicate the lock-free property of the corresponding atomic types (both signed and unsigned); and
      -        ATOMIC_FLAG_INIT
      + ATOMIC_FLAG_INIT + which expands to an initializer for an object of type atomic_flag.

      The types include

      -        memory_order
      + memory_order + which is an enumerated type whose enumerators identify memory ordering constraints;
      -        atomic_flag
      + atomic_flag + which is a structure type representing a lock-free, primitive atomic flag;
      -        atomic_bool
      + atomic_bool + which is a structure type representing the atomic analog of the type _Bool;
      -        atomic_address
      + atomic_address + which is a structure type representing the atomic analog of a pointer type; and several atomic analogs of integer types.

      @@ -13483,12 +14052,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.17.2 Initialization

      7.17.2.1 The ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         #define ATOMIC_VAR_INIT(C value)
      -
      Description
      + #define ATOMIC_VAR_INIT(C value) + +

      Description

      The ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro expands to a token sequence suitable for initializing an atomic object of a type that is initialization-compatible with value. An atomic object @@ -13502,16 +14072,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      EXAMPLE

      -         atomic_int guide = ATOMIC_VAR_INIT(42);
      + atomic_int guide = ATOMIC_VAR_INIT(42); +
      7.17.2.2 The atomic_init generic function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         void atomic_init(volatile A *obj, C value);
      -
      Description
      + void atomic_init(volatile A *obj, C value); + +

      Description

      The atomic_init generic function initializes the atomic object pointed to by obj to the value value, while also initializing any additional state that the implementation @@ -13521,14 +14093,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Although this function initializes an atomic object, it does not avoid data races; concurrent access to the variable being initialized, even via an atomic operation, constitutes a data race. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_init generic function returns no value.

      EXAMPLE

                atomic_int guide;
      -         atomic_init(&guide, 42);
      + atomic_init(&guide, 42); +

      7.17.3 Order and consistency

      @@ -13536,14 +14109,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The enumerated type memory_order specifies the detailed regular (non-atomic) memory synchronization operations as defined in 5.1.2.4 and may provide for operation ordering. Its enumeration constants are as follows: -

                memory_order_relaxed
                memory_order_consume
                memory_order_acquire
                memory_order_release
                memory_order_acq_rel
      -         memory_order_seq_cst
      + memory_order_seq_cst + +

      For memory_order_relaxed, no operation orders memory.

      For memory_order_release, memory_order_acq_rel, and @@ -13609,12 +14183,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                 // Thread 1:
                 r1 = atomic_load_explicit(&y, memory_order_relaxed);
      -          atomic_store_explicit(&x, r1, memory_order_relaxed);
      + atomic_store_explicit(&x, r1, memory_order_relaxed); +
                 // Thread 2:
                 r2 = atomic_load_explicit(&x, memory_order_relaxed);
      -          atomic_store_explicit(&y, 42, memory_order_relaxed);
      + atomic_store_explicit(&y, 42, memory_order_relaxed); + is allowed to produce r1 == 42 && r2 == 42. The sequence of evaluations justifying this consists of: @@ -13625,22 +14201,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. atomic_store_explicit(&y, 42, memory_order_relaxed); r1 = atomic_load_explicit(&y, memory_order_relaxed); atomic_store_explicit(&x, r1, memory_order_relaxed); - r2 = atomic_load_explicit(&x, memory_order_relaxed); + r2 = atomic_load_explicit(&x, memory_order_relaxed); + On the other hand,
                // Thread 1:
                r1 = atomic_load_explicit(&y, memory_order_relaxed);
      -         atomic_store_explicit(&x, r1, memory_order_relaxed);
      + atomic_store_explicit(&x, r1, memory_order_relaxed); +
                // Thread 2:
                r2 = atomic_load_explicit(&x, memory_order_relaxed);
      -         atomic_store_explicit(&y, r2, memory_order_relaxed);
      + atomic_store_explicit(&y, r2, memory_order_relaxed); + is not allowed to produce r1 == 42 && r2 = 42, since there is no sequence of evaluations that results in the computation of 42. In the absence of ''relaxed'' operations and read-modify-write operations with weaker than memory_order_acq_rel ordering, the second requirement has no impact. -
      Recommended practice
      +

      Recommended practice

      The requirements do not forbid r1 == 42 && r2 == 42 in the following example, with x and y initially zero: @@ -13648,34 +14227,37 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. // Thread 1: r1 = atomic_load_explicit(&x, memory_order_relaxed); if (r1 == 42) - atomic_store_explicit(&y, r1, memory_order_relaxed); + atomic_store_explicit(&y, r1, memory_order_relaxed); +

                // Thread 2:
                r2 = atomic_load_explicit(&y, memory_order_relaxed);
                if (r2 == 42)
      -              atomic_store_explicit(&x, 42, memory_order_relaxed);
      + atomic_store_explicit(&x, 42, memory_order_relaxed); + However, this is not useful behavior, and implementations should not allow it.

      Implementations should make atomic stores visible to atomic loads within a reasonable amount of time. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      251) Among other implications, atomic variables shall not decay.

      7.17.3.1 The kill_dependency macro
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         type kill_dependency(type y);
      -
      Description
      + type kill_dependency(type y); + +

      Description

      The kill_dependency macro terminates a dependency chain; the argument does not carry a dependency to the return value. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The kill_dependency macro returns the value of y. @@ -13703,12 +14285,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. in the release sequence headed by A.

      7.17.4.1 The atomic_thread_fence function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         void atomic_thread_fence(memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + void atomic_thread_fence(memory_order order); + +

      Description

      Depending on the value of order, this operation:

        @@ -13722,17 +14305,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. memory_order_seq_cst.
      -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_thread_fence function returns no value.

      7.17.4.2 The atomic_signal_fence function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         void atomic_signal_fence(memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + void atomic_signal_fence(memory_order order); + +

      Description

      Equivalent to atomic_thread_fence(order), except that ''synchronizes with'' relationships are established only between a thread and a signal handler executed in the @@ -13746,7 +14330,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. atomic_thread_fence, but the hardware fence instructions that atomic_thread_fence would have inserted are not emitted. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_signal_fence function returns no value. @@ -13763,16 +14347,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.17.5.1 The atomic_is_lock_free generic function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
      -         _Bool atomic_is_lock_free(atomic_type const volatile *obj);
      -
      Description
      + _Bool atomic_is_lock_free(atomic_type const volatile *obj); + +

      Description

      The atomic_is_lock_free generic function indicates whether or not the object pointed to by obj is lock-free. atomic_type can be any atomic type. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_is_lock_free generic function returns nonzero (true) if and only if the object's operations are lock-free. The result of a lock-free query on one object cannot be @@ -13784,7 +14369,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. For each line in the following table, the atomic type name is declared as the corresponding direct type. -

                   Atomic type name                              Direct type
               atomic_char                           _Atomic    char
      @@ -13822,7 +14406,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               atomic_size_t                         _Atomic    size_t
               atomic_ptrdiff_t                      _Atomic    ptrdiff_t
               atomic_intmax_t                       _Atomic    intmax_t
      -        atomic_uintmax_t                      _Atomic    uintmax_t
      + atomic_uintmax_t _Atomic uintmax_t + +

      The semantics of the operations on these types are defined in 7.17.7.

      The atomic_bool type provides an atomic boolean. @@ -13842,58 +14428,61 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. instances of those kinds. This subclause specifies each general kind.

      7.17.7.1 The atomic_store generic functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
                void atomic_store(volatile A *object, C desired);
                void atomic_store_explicit(volatile A *object,
      -              C desired, memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + C desired, memory_order order); + +

      Description

      The order argument shall not be memory_order_acquire, memory_order_consume, nor memory_order_acq_rel. Atomically replace the value pointed to by object with the value of desired. Memory is affected according to the value of order. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_store generic functions return no value.

      7.17.7.2 The atomic_load generic functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
                C atomic_load(volatile A *object);
                C atomic_load_explicit(volatile A *object,
      -              memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + memory_order order); + +

      Description

      The order argument shall not be memory_order_release nor memory_order_acq_rel. Memory is affected according to the value of order. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns Atomically returns the value pointed to by object.

      7.17.7.3 The atomic_exchange generic functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <stdatomic.h>
                 C atomic_exchange(volatile A *object, C desired);
                 C atomic_exchange_explicit(volatile A *object,
      -               C desired, memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + C desired, memory_order order); + +

      Description

      Atomically replace the value pointed to by object with desired. Memory is affected according to the value of order. These operations are read-modify-write operations (5.1.2.4). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      Atomically returns the value pointed to by object immediately before the effects.

      7.17.7.4 The atomic_compare_exchange generic functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <stdatomic.h>
      @@ -13906,8 +14495,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      C *expected, C desired);
                 _Bool atomic_compare_exchange_weak_explicit(
                      volatile A *object, C *expected, C desired,
      -               memory_order success, memory_order failure);
      -
      Description
      + memory_order success, memory_order failure); + +

      Description

      The failure argument shall not be memory_order_release nor memory_order_acq_rel. The failure argument shall be no stronger than the @@ -13924,7 +14514,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. if (*object == *expected) *object = desired; else - *expected = *object; + *expected = *object; +

      The weak compare-and-exchange operations may fail spuriously, that is, return zero @@ -13940,12 +14531,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. exp = atomic_load(&cur); do { des = function(exp); - } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_weak(&cur, &exp, des)); + } while (!atomic_compare_exchange_weak(&cur, &exp, des)); + When a compare-and-exchange is in a loop, the weak version will yield better performance on some platforms. When a weak compare-and-exchange would require a loop and a strong one would not, the strong one is preferable. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The result of the comparison. @@ -13961,14 +14553,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. or | bitwise inclusive or xor ^ bitwise exclusive or and & bitwise and -

      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <stdatomic.h>
                 C atomic_fetch_key(volatile A *object, M operand);
                 C atomic_fetch_key_explicit(volatile A *object,
      -               M operand, memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + M operand, memory_order order); + +

      Description

      Atomically replaces the value pointed to by object with the result of the computation applied to the value pointed to by object and the given operand. Memory is affected @@ -13978,7 +14571,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. complement representation with silent wrap-around on overflow; there are no undefined results. For address types, the result may be an undefined address, but the operations otherwise have no undefined behavior. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      Atomically, the value pointed to by object immediately before the effects.

      @@ -14008,42 +14601,45 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      EXAMPLE

      -         atomic_flag guard = ATOMIC_FLAG_INIT;
      + atomic_flag guard = ATOMIC_FLAG_INIT; +
      7.17.8.1 The atomic_flag_test_and_set functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
                bool atomic_flag_test_and_set(
                     volatile atomic_flag *object);
                bool atomic_flag_test_and_set_explicit(
      -              volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order); + +

      Description

      Atomically sets the value pointed to by object to true. Memory is affected according to the value of order. These operations are atomic read-modify-write operations (5.1.2.4). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      Atomically, the value of the object immediately before the effects.

      7.17.8.2 The atomic_flag_clear functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <stdatomic.h>
                void atomic_flag_clear(volatile atomic_flag *object);
                void atomic_flag_clear_explicit(
      -              volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order);
      -
      Description
      + volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order); + +

      Description

      The order argument shall not be memory_order_acquire nor memory_order_acq_rel. Atomically sets the value pointed to by object to false. Memory is affected according to the value of order. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The atomic_flag_clear functions return no value. @@ -14054,19 +14650,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The macro

      -          bool
      + bool + expands to _Bool.

      The remaining three macros are suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives. They are

      -          true
      + true + which expands to the integer constant 1,
      -          false
      + false + which expands to the integer constant 0, and
      -          __bool_true_false_are_defined
      + __bool_true_false_are_defined + which expands to the integer constant 1.

      Notwithstanding the provisions of 7.1.3, a program may undefine and perhaps then @@ -14077,7 +14677,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      252) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.7). @@ -14088,17 +14688,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The types are

      -         ptrdiff_t
      + ptrdiff_t + which is the signed integer type of the result of subtracting two pointers;
      -         size_t
      + size_t + which is the unsigned integer type of the result of the sizeof operator;
      -         max_align_t
      + max_align_t + which is an object type whose alignment is as great as is supported by the implementation in all contexts; and
      -         wchar_t
      + wchar_t + which is an integer type whose range of values can represent distinct codes for all members of the largest extended character set specified among the supported locales; the null character shall have the code value zero. Each member of the basic character set @@ -14108,19 +14712,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The macros are

      -         NULL
      + NULL + which expands to an implementation-defined null pointer constant; and
      -         offsetof(type, member-designator)
      + offsetof(type, member-designator) + which expands to an integer constant expression that has type size_t, the value of which is the offset in bytes, to the structure member (designated by member-designator), from the beginning of its structure (designated by type). The type and member designator shall be such that given
      -         static type t;
      + static type t; + then the expression &(t.member-designator) evaluates to an address constant. (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) -
      Recommended practice
      +

      Recommended practice

      The types used for size_t and ptrdiff_t should not have an integer conversion rank greater than that of signed long int unless the implementation supports objects @@ -14155,7 +14762,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. shall provide those types described as ''required'', but need not provide any of the others (described as ''optional''). -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      253) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.8).

      254) Some of these types may denote implementation-defined extended integer types. @@ -14205,7 +14812,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int_least8_t uint_least8_t int_least16_t uint_least16_t int_least32_t uint_least32_t - int_least64_t uint_least64_t + int_least64_t uint_least64_t + All other types of this form are optional.

      7.20.1.3 Fastest minimum-width integer types
      @@ -14227,10 +14835,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int_fast8_t uint_fast8_t int_fast16_t uint_fast16_t int_fast32_t uint_fast32_t - int_fast64_t uint_fast64_t + int_fast64_t uint_fast64_t + All other types of this form are optional. -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      255) The designated type is not guaranteed to be fastest for all purposes; if the implementation has no clear grounds for choosing one type over another, it will simply pick some integer type satisfying the signedness and width requirements. @@ -14242,12 +14851,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pointer to void can be converted to this type, then converted back to pointer to void, and the result will compare equal to the original pointer:

      -         intptr_t
      + intptr_t + The following type designates an unsigned integer type with the property that any valid pointer to void can be converted to this type, then converted back to pointer to void, and the result will compare equal to the original pointer:
      -         uintptr_t
      + uintptr_t + These types are optional.
      7.20.1.5 Greatest-width integer types
      @@ -14255,11 +14866,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The following type designates a signed integer type capable of representing any value of any signed integer type:
      -         intmax_t
      + intmax_t + The following type designates an unsigned integer type capable of representing any value of any unsigned integer type:
      -         uintmax_t
      + uintmax_t + These types are required.

      7.20.2 Limits of specified-width integer types

      @@ -14281,10 +14894,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
      • minimum values of exact-width signed integer types
        -     INTN_MIN                                  exactly -(2 N -1 )
        + INTN_MIN exactly -(2 N -1 ) +
      • maximum values of exact-width signed integer types
        -     INTN_MAX                                  exactly 2 N -1 - 1
        + INTN_MAX exactly 2 N -1 - 1 +
      • maximum values of exact-width unsigned integer types UINTN_MAX exactly 2 N - 1
      @@ -14294,10 +14909,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
      • minimum values of minimum-width signed integer types
        -     INT_LEASTN_MIN                                    -(2 N -1 - 1)
        + INT_LEASTN_MIN -(2 N -1 - 1) +
      • maximum values of minimum-width signed integer types
        -     INT_LEASTN_MAX                                    2 N -1 - 1
        + INT_LEASTN_MAX 2 N -1 - 1 +
      • maximum values of minimum-width unsigned integer types UINT_LEASTN_MAX 2N - 1
      @@ -14307,7 +14924,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
      • minimum values of fastest minimum-width signed integer types
        -     INT_FASTN_MIN                                     -(2 N -1 - 1)
        + INT_FASTN_MIN -(2 N -1 - 1) +
      • maximum values of fastest minimum-width signed integer types INT_FASTN_MAX 2 N -1 - 1
      • maximum values of fastest minimum-width unsigned integer types @@ -14319,7 +14937,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
        • minimum value of pointer-holding signed integer type
          -     INTPTR_MIN                                        -(215 - 1)
          + INTPTR_MIN -(215 - 1) +
        • maximum value of pointer-holding signed integer type INTPTR_MAX 215 - 1
        • maximum value of pointer-holding unsigned integer type @@ -14388,7 +15007,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. otherwise, wint_t is defined as an unsigned integer type, and the value of WINT_MIN shall be 0 and the value of WINT_MAX shall be no less than 65535. -
          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          256) A freestanding implementation need not provide all of these types.

          257) The values WCHAR_MIN and WCHAR_MAX do not necessarily correspond to members of the extended @@ -14427,12 +15046,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The following macro expands to an integer constant expression having the value specified by its argument and the type intmax_t:

          -         INTMAX_C(value)
          + INTMAX_C(value) + The following macro expands to an integer constant expression having the value specified by its argument and the type uintmax_t:
          -         UINTMAX_C(value)
          + UINTMAX_C(value) +

          7.21 Input/output

          @@ -14443,13 +15064,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          The types declared are size_t (described in 7.19);

          -        FILE
          + FILE + which is an object type capable of recording all the information needed to control a stream, including its file position indicator, a pointer to its associated buffer (if any), an error indicator that records whether a read/write error has occurred, and an end-of-file indicator that records whether the end of the file has been reached; and
          -        fpos_t
          + fpos_t + which is a complete object type other than an array type capable of recording all the information needed to specify uniquely every position within a file.

          @@ -14457,47 +15080,56 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                   _IOFBF
                   _IOLBF
          -        _IONBF
          + _IONBF + which expand to integer constant expressions with distinct values, suitable for use as the third argument to the setvbuf function;
          -        BUFSIZ
          + BUFSIZ + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the size of the buffer used by the setbuf function;
          -        EOF
          + EOF + which expands to an integer constant expression, with type int and a negative value, that is returned by several functions to indicate end-of-file, that is, no more input from a stream;
          -        FOPEN_MAX
          + FOPEN_MAX + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the minimum number of files that the implementation guarantees can be open simultaneously;
          -        FILENAME_MAX
          + FILENAME_MAX + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the size needed for an array of char large enough to hold the longest file name string that the implementation guarantees can be opened;258)
          -         L_tmpnam
          + L_tmpnam + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the size needed for an array of char large enough to hold a temporary file name string generated by the tmpnam function;
                    SEEK_CUR
                    SEEK_END
          -         SEEK_SET
          + SEEK_SET + which expand to integer constant expressions with distinct values, suitable for use as the third argument to the fseek function;
          -         TMP_MAX
          + TMP_MAX + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the minimum number of unique file names that can be generated by the tmpnam function;
                    stderr
                    stdin
          -         stdout
          + stdout + which are expressions of type ''pointer to FILE'' that point to the FILE objects associated, respectively, with the standard error, input, and output streams.

          @@ -14529,7 +15161,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          Forward references: files (7.21.3), the fseek function (7.21.9.2), streams (7.21.2), the tmpnam function (7.21.4.4), <wchar.h> (7.28). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          258) If the implementation imposes no practical limit on the length of file name strings, the value of FILENAME_MAX should instead be the recommended size of an array intended to hold a file name string. Of course, file name string contents are subject to other system-specific constraints; therefore @@ -14592,7 +15224,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. value of this mbstate_t object as part of the value of the fpos_t object. A later successful call to fsetpos using the same stored fpos_t value restores the value of the associated mbstate_t object as well as the position within the controlled stream. -

          Environmental limits
          +

          Environmental limits

          An implementation shall support text files with lines containing at least 254 characters, including the terminating new-line character. The value of the macro BUFSIZ shall be at @@ -14606,7 +15238,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          259) An implementation need not distinguish between text streams and binary streams. In such an implementation, there need be no new-line characters in a text stream nor any limit to the length of a line. @@ -14710,7 +15342,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. multibyte character. The wide character input/output functions and the byte input/output functions store the value of the macro EILSEQ in errno if and only if an encoding error occurs. -

          Environmental limits
          +

          Environmental limits

          The value of FOPEN_MAX shall be at least eight, including the three standard text streams. @@ -14720,7 +15352,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. fputwc function (7.28.3.3), conversion state (7.28.6), the mbrtowc function (7.28.6.3.2), the wcrtomb function (7.28.6.3.3). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          261) Setting the file position indicator to end-of-file, as with fseek(file, 0, SEEK_END), has undefined behavior for a binary stream (because of possible trailing null characters) or for any stream with state-dependent encoding that does not assuredly end in the initial shift state. @@ -14729,75 +15361,79 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.4 Operations on files

          7.21.4.1 The remove function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int remove(const char *filename);
          -
          Description
          + int remove(const char *filename); + +

          Description

          The remove function causes the file whose name is the string pointed to by filename to be no longer accessible by that name. A subsequent attempt to open that file using that name will fail, unless it is created anew. If the file is open, the behavior of the remove function is implementation-defined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The remove function returns zero if the operation succeeds, nonzero if it fails.

          7.21.4.2 The rename function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int rename(const char *old, const char *new);
          -
          Description
          + int rename(const char *old, const char *new); + +

          Description

          The rename function causes the file whose name is the string pointed to by old to be henceforth known by the name given by the string pointed to by new. The file named old is no longer accessible by that name. If a file named by the string pointed to by new exists prior to the call to the rename function, the behavior is implementation-defined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The rename function returns zero if the operation succeeds, nonzero if it fails,262) in which case if the file existed previously it is still known by its original name. -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          262) Among the reasons the implementation may cause the rename function to fail are that the file is open or that it is necessary to copy its contents to effectuate its renaming.

          7.21.4.3 The tmpfile function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         FILE *tmpfile(void);
          -
          Description
          + FILE *tmpfile(void); + +

          Description

          The tmpfile function creates a temporary binary file that is different from any other existing file and that will automatically be removed when it is closed or at program termination. If the program terminates abnormally, whether an open temporary file is removed is implementation-defined. The file is opened for update with "wb+" mode. -

          Recommended practice
          +

          Recommended practice

          It should be possible to open at least TMP_MAX temporary files during the lifetime of the program (this limit may be shared with tmpnam) and there should be no limit on the number simultaneously open other than this limit and any limit on the number of open files (FOPEN_MAX). -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The tmpfile function returns a pointer to the stream of the file that it created. If the file cannot be created, the tmpfile function returns a null pointer.

          Forward references: the fopen function (7.21.5.3).

          7.21.4.4 The tmpnam function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         char *tmpnam(char *s);
          -
          Description
          + char *tmpnam(char *s); + +

          Description

          The tmpnam function generates a string that is a valid file name and that is not the same as the name of an existing file.263) The function is potentially capable of generating at @@ -14812,7 +15448,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Calls to the tmpnam function with a null pointer argument may introduce data races with each other. The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the tmpnam function. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          If no suitable string can be generated, the tmpnam function returns a null pointer. Otherwise, if the argument is a null pointer, the tmpnam function leaves its result in an @@ -14820,11 +15456,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function may modify the same object). If the argument is not a null pointer, it is assumed to point to an array of at least L_tmpnam chars; the tmpnam function writes its result in that array and returns the argument as its value. -

          Environmental limits
          +

          Environmental limits

          The value of the macro TMP_MAX shall be at least 25. -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          263) Files created using strings generated by the tmpnam function are temporary only in the sense that their names should not collide with those generated by conventional naming rules for the implementation. It is still necessary to use the remove function to remove such files when their use @@ -14834,12 +15470,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.5 File access functions

          7.21.5.1 The fclose function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int fclose(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int fclose(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          A successful call to the fclose function causes the stream pointed to by stream to be flushed and the associated file to be closed. Any unwritten buffered data for the stream @@ -14847,19 +15484,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. are discarded. Whether or not the call succeeds, the stream is disassociated from the file and any buffer set by the setbuf or setvbuf function is disassociated from the stream (and deallocated if it was automatically allocated). -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fclose function returns zero if the stream was successfully closed, or EOF if any errors were detected.

          7.21.5.2 The fflush function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int fflush(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int fflush(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          If stream points to an output stream or an update stream in which the most recent operation was not input, the fflush function causes any unwritten data for that stream @@ -14868,20 +15506,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          If stream is a null pointer, the fflush function performs this flushing action on all streams for which the behavior is defined above. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fflush function sets the error indicator for the stream and returns EOF if a write error occurs, otherwise it returns zero.

          Forward references: the fopen function (7.21.5.3).

          7.21.5.3 The fopen function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    FILE *fopen(const char * restrict filename,
          -              const char * restrict mode);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict mode); + +

          Description

          The fopen function opens the file whose name is the string pointed to by filename, and associates a stream with it. @@ -14934,28 +15573,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          When opened, a stream is fully buffered if and only if it can be determined not to refer to an interactive device. The error and end-of-file indicators for the stream are cleared. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fopen function returns a pointer to the object controlling the stream. If the open operation fails, fopen returns a null pointer.

          Forward references: file positioning functions (7.21.9). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          264) If the string begins with one of the above sequences, the implementation might choose to ignore the remaining characters, or it might use them to select different kinds of a file (some of which might not conform to the properties in 7.21.2).

          7.21.5.4 The freopen function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    FILE *freopen(const char * restrict filename,
                         const char * restrict mode,
          -              FILE * restrict stream);
          -
          Description
          + FILE * restrict stream); + +

          Description

          The freopen function opens the file whose name is the string pointed to by filename and associates the stream pointed to by stream with it. The mode argument is used just @@ -14969,25 +15609,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The freopen function first attempts to close any file that is associated with the specified stream. Failure to close the file is ignored. The error and end-of-file indicators for the stream are cleared. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The freopen function returns a null pointer if the open operation fails. Otherwise, freopen returns the value of stream. -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          265) The primary use of the freopen function is to change the file associated with a standard text stream (stderr, stdin, or stdout), as those identifiers need not be modifiable lvalues to which the value returned by the fopen function may be assigned.

          7.21.5.5 The setbuf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    void setbuf(FILE * restrict stream,
          -              char * restrict buf);
          -
          Description
          + char * restrict buf); + +

          Description

          Except that it returns no value, the setbuf function is equivalent to the setvbuf function invoked with the values _IOFBF for mode and BUFSIZ for size, or (if buf @@ -14997,20 +15638,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The setbuf function returns no value.

          Forward references: the setvbuf function (7.21.5.6).

          7.21.5.6 The setvbuf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int setvbuf(FILE * restrict stream,
                         char * restrict buf,
          -              int mode, size_t size);
          -
          Description
          + int mode, size_t size); + +

          Description

          The setvbuf function may be used only after the stream pointed to by stream has been associated with an open file and before any other operation (other than an @@ -15022,7 +15664,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. specifies the size of the array; otherwise, size may determine the size of a buffer allocated by the setvbuf function. The contents of the array at any time are indeterminate. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The setvbuf function returns zero on success, or nonzero if an invalid value is given for mode or if the request cannot be honored. @@ -15032,7 +15674,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          266) The buffer has to have a lifetime at least as great as the open stream, so the stream should be closed before a buffer that has automatic storage duration is deallocated upon block exit. @@ -15042,18 +15684,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The formatted input/output functions shall behave as if there is a sequence point after the actions associated with each specifier.267) -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          267) The fprintf functions perform writes to memory for the %n specifier.

          7.21.6.1 The fprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                     #include <stdio.h>
                     int fprintf(FILE * restrict stream,
          -               const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The fprintf function writes output to the stream pointed to by stream, under control of the string pointed to by format that specifies how subsequent arguments are @@ -15103,15 +15746,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The flag characters and their meanings are: - The result of the conversion is left-justified within the field. (It is right-justified if

          -         this flag is not specified.)
          + this flag is not specified.) + + The result of a signed conversion always begins with a plus or minus sign. (It
                    begins with a sign only when a negative value is converted if this flag is not
          -         specified.)269)
          + specified.)269) + space If the first character of a signed conversion is not a sign, or if a signed conversion
                  results in no characters, a space is prefixed to the result. If the space and + flags
          -       both appear, the space flag is ignored.
          + both appear, the space flag is ignored. + # The result is converted to an ''alternative form''. For o conversion, it increases
                    the precision, if and only if necessary, to force the first digit of the result to be a
          @@ -15121,19 +15767,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    contains a decimal-point character, even if no digits follow it. (Normally, a
                    decimal-point character appears in the result of these conversions only if a digit
                    follows it.) For g and G conversions, trailing zeros are not removed from the
          -         result. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined.
          + result. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined. + 0 For d, i, o, u, x, X, a, A, e, E, f, F, g, and G conversions, leading zeros
                    (following any indication of sign or base) are used to pad to the field width rather
                    than performing space padding, except when converting an infinity or NaN. If the
          -         0 and - flags both appear, the 0 flag is ignored. For d, i, o, u, x, and X
          + 0 and - flags both appear, the 0 flag is ignored. For d, i, o, u, x, and X + -

                      conversions, if a precision is specified, the 0 flag is ignored. For other
          -           conversions, the behavior is undefined.
          + conversions, the behavior is undefined. + +

          The length modifiers and their meanings are: hh Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a

          @@ -15141,14 +15790,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          been promoted according to the integer promotions, but its value shall be
                          converted to signed char or unsigned char before printing); or that
                          a following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a signed char
          -               argument.
          + argument. + h Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                          short int or unsigned short int argument (the argument will
                          have been promoted according to the integer promotions, but its value shall
                          be converted to short int or unsigned short int before printing);
                          or that a following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a short
          -               int argument.
          + int argument. + l (ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                          long int or unsigned long int argument; that a following n
          @@ -15156,30 +15807,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          following c conversion specifier applies to a wint_t argument; that a
                          following s conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a wchar_t
                          argument; or has no effect on a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion
          -               specifier.
          + specifier. + ll (ell-ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                         long long int or unsigned long long int argument; or that a
                         following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a long long int
          -              argument.
          + argument. + j Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to
                          an intmax_t or uintmax_t argument; or that a following n conversion
          -               specifier applies to a pointer to an intmax_t argument.
          + specifier applies to a pointer to an intmax_t argument. + z Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                          size_t or the corresponding signed integer type argument; or that a
                          following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a signed integer type
          -               corresponding to size_t argument.
          + corresponding to size_t argument. + t Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                          ptrdiff_t or the corresponding unsigned integer type argument; or that a
                          following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a ptrdiff_t
          -               argument.
          + argument. + L Specifies that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier
          -                applies to a long double argument.
          + applies to a long double argument. + If a length modifier appears with any conversion specifier other than as specified above, the behavior is undefined.

          @@ -15189,7 +15846,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. precision specifies the minimum number of digits to appear; if the value being converted can be represented in fewer digits, it is expanded with leading zeros. The default precision is 1. The result of converting a zero - value with a precision of zero is no characters. + value with a precision of zero is no characters. + o,u,x,X The unsigned int argument is converted to unsigned octal (o), unsigned

                    decimal (u), or unsigned hexadecimal notation (x or X) in the style dddd; the
          @@ -15197,7 +15855,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    conversion. The precision specifies the minimum number of digits to appear;
                    if the value being converted can be represented in fewer digits, it is expanded
                    with leading zeros. The default precision is 1. The result of converting a
          -         zero value with a precision of zero is no characters.
          + zero value with a precision of zero is no characters. + f,F A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted to
                         decimal notation in the style [-]ddd.ddd, where the number of digits after
          @@ -15212,12 +15871,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                         [-]nan or [-]nan(n-char-sequence) -- which style, and the meaning of
                         any n-char-sequence, is implementation-defined. The F conversion specifier
                         produces INF, INFINITY, or NAN instead of inf, infinity, or nan,
          -              respectively.270)
          + respectively.270) + e,E A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in the
                         style [-]d.ddd e(+-)dd, where there is one digit (which is nonzero if the
                         argument is nonzero) before the decimal-point character and the number of
          -              digits after it is equal to the precision; if the precision is missing, it is taken as
          + digits after it is equal to the precision; if the precision is missing, it is taken as + @@ -15229,7 +15890,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. and only as many more digits as necessary to represent the exponent. If the value is zero, the exponent is zero. A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style - of an f or F conversion specifier. + of an f or F conversion specifier. + g,G A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in
                          style f or e (or in style F or E in the case of a G conversion specifier),
          @@ -15243,7 +15905,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          fractional portion of the result and the decimal-point character is removed if
                          there is no fractional portion remaining.
                          A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style
          -               of an f or F conversion specifier.
          + of an f or F conversion specifier. + a,A A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in the
                          style [-]0xh.hhhh p(+-)d, where there is one hexadecimal digit (which is
          @@ -15252,7 +15915,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          of hexadecimal digits after it is equal to the precision; if the precision is
                          missing and FLT_RADIX is a power of 2, then the precision is sufficient for
                          an exact representation of the value; if the precision is missing and
          -               FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2, then the precision is sufficient to
          + FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2, then the precision is sufficient to + @@ -15267,7 +15931,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. least one digit, and only as many more digits as necessary to represent the decimal exponent of 2. If the value is zero, the exponent is zero. A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style - of an f or F conversion specifier. + of an f or F conversion specifier. + c If no l length modifier is present, the int argument is converted to an
                          unsigned char, and the resulting character is written.
          @@ -15275,7 +15940,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          an ls conversion specification with no precision and an argument that points
                          to the initial element of a two-element array of wchar_t, the first element
                          containing the wint_t argument to the lc conversion specification and the
          -               second a null wide character.
          + second a null wide character. + s If no l length modifier is present, the argument shall be a pointer to the initial
                          element of an array of character type.273) Characters from the array are
          @@ -15293,26 +15959,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          (byte). If no precision is specified, the array shall contain a null wide
                          character. If a precision is specified, no more than that many bytes are
                          written (including shift sequences, if any), and the array shall contain a null
          -               wide character if, to equal the multibyte character sequence length given by
          + wide character if, to equal the multibyte character sequence length given by +
                           the precision, the function would need to access a wide character one past the
          -                end of the array. In no case is a partial multibyte character written.274)
          + end of the array. In no case is a partial multibyte character written.274) + p The argument shall be a pointer to void. The value of the pointer is
                           converted to a sequence of printing characters, in an implementation-defined
          -                manner.
          + manner. + n The argument shall be a pointer to signed integer into which is written the
                           number of characters written to the output stream so far by this call to
                           fprintf. No argument is converted, but one is consumed. If the conversion
                           specification includes any flags, a field width, or a precision, the behavior is
          -                undefined.
          + undefined. + % A % character is written. No argument is converted. The complete -

          -                conversion specification shall be %%.
          + conversion specification shall be %%. + +

          If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is undefined.275) If any argument is not the correct type for the corresponding conversion specification, the behavior is undefined. @@ -15323,7 +15994,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          For a and A conversions, if FLT_RADIX is a power of 2, the value is correctly rounded to a hexadecimal floating number with the given precision. -

          Recommended practice
          +

          Recommended practice

          For a and A conversions, if FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2 and the result is not exactly representable in the given precision, the result should be one of the two adjacent numbers @@ -15341,11 +16012,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. of the resultant decimal string D should satisfy L <= D <= U, with the extra stipulation that the error should have a correct sign for the current rounding direction. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred. -

          Environmental limits
          +

          Environmental limits

          The number of characters that can be produced by any single conversion shall be at least 4095. @@ -15360,7 +16031,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int day, hour, min; fprintf(stdout, "%s, %s %d, %.2d:%.2d\n", weekday, month, day, hour, min); - fprintf(stdout, "pi = %.5f\n", 4 * atan(1.0)); + fprintf(stdout, "pi = %.5f\n", 4 * atan(1.0)); +

          EXAMPLE 2 In this example, multibyte characters do not have a state-dependent encoding, and the @@ -15369,7 +16041,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          Given the following wide string with length seven,

          -          static wchar_t wstr[] = L" X Yabc Z W";
          + static wchar_t wstr[] = L" X Yabc Z W"; + the seven calls
                     fprintf(stdout,          "|1234567890123|\n");
          @@ -15378,7 +16051,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     fprintf(stdout,          "|%13.10ls|\n", wstr);
                     fprintf(stdout,          "|%13.11ls|\n", wstr);
                     fprintf(stdout,          "|%13.15ls|\n", &wstr[2]);
          -          fprintf(stdout,          "|%13lc|\n", (wint_t) wstr[5]);
          + fprintf(stdout, "|%13lc|\n", (wint_t) wstr[5]); + will print the following seven lines:
                     |1234567890123|
          @@ -15387,12 +16061,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     |     X Yabc Z|
                     |   X Yabc Z W|
                     |      abc Z W|
          -          |            Z|
          + | Z| +

          Forward references: conversion state (7.28.6), the wcrtomb function (7.28.6.3.3). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          268) Note that 0 is taken as a flag, not as the beginning of a field width.

          269) The results of all floating conversions of a negative zero, and of negative values that round to zero, @@ -15421,13 +16096,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.6.2 The fscanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int fscanf(FILE * restrict stream,
          -              const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The fscanf function reads input from the stream pointed to by stream, under control of the string pointed to by format that specifies the admissible input sequences and how @@ -15492,39 +16168,47 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The length modifiers and their meanings are: hh Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies

          -                to an argument with type pointer to signed char or unsigned char.
          + to an argument with type pointer to signed char or unsigned char. + h Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                           to an argument with type pointer to short int or unsigned short
          -                int.
          + int. + l (ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                           to an argument with type pointer to long int or unsigned long
                           int; that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier applies to
                           an argument with type pointer to double; or that a following c, s, or [
          -                conversion specifier applies to an argument with type pointer to wchar_t.
          + conversion specifier applies to an argument with type pointer to wchar_t. + ll (ell-ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                         to an argument with type pointer to long long int or unsigned
          -              long long int.
          + long long int. + j Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
          -              to an argument with type pointer to intmax_t or uintmax_t.
          + to an argument with type pointer to intmax_t or uintmax_t. + z Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                         to an argument with type pointer to size_t or the corresponding signed
          -              integer type.
          + integer type. + t Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                         to an argument with type pointer to ptrdiff_t or the corresponding
          -              unsigned integer type.
          + unsigned integer type. + L Specifies that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier
          -              applies to an argument with type pointer to long double.
          + applies to an argument with type pointer to long double. + If a length modifier appears with any conversion specifier other than as specified above, the behavior is undefined.

          @@ -15533,32 +16217,38 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                        expected for the subject sequence of the strtol function with the value 10
                        for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
          -             signed integer.
          + signed integer. + i Matches an optionally signed integer, whose format is the same as expected
                        for the subject sequence of the strtol function with the value 0 for the
                        base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to signed
          -             integer.
          + integer. + o Matches an optionally signed octal integer, whose format is the same as
                        expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with the value 8
                        for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
          -             unsigned integer.
          + unsigned integer. + u Matches an optionally signed decimal integer, whose format is the same as
                        expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with the value 10
                        for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
          -             unsigned integer.
          + unsigned integer. + x Matches an optionally signed hexadecimal integer, whose format is the same
                        as expected for the subject sequence of the strtoul function with the value
                        16 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
          -             unsigned integer.
          + unsigned integer. + a,e,f,g Matches an optionally signed floating-point number, infinity, or NaN, whose
                    format is the same as expected for the subject sequence of the strtod
          -         function. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to floating.
          + function. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to floating. + c Matches a sequence of characters of exactly the number specified by the field
                          width (1 if no field width is present in the directive).279)
          @@ -15572,7 +16262,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          initialized to zero before the first multibyte character is converted. The
                          corresponding argument shall be a pointer to the initial element of an array of
                          wchar_t large enough to accept the resulting sequence of wide characters.
          -               No null wide character is added.
          + No null wide character is added. + s Matches a sequence of non-white-space characters.279)
                          If no l length modifier is present, the corresponding argument shall be a
          @@ -15585,7 +16276,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          before the first multibyte character is converted. The corresponding argument
                          shall be a pointer to the initial element of an array of wchar_t large enough
                          to accept the sequence and the terminating null wide character, which will be
          -               added automatically.
          + added automatically. + [ Matches a nonempty sequence of characters from a set of expected characters
                          (the scanset).279)
          @@ -15595,7 +16287,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                          If an l length modifier is present, the input shall be a sequence of multibyte
                          characters that begins in the initial shift state. Each multibyte character is
                          converted to a wide character as if by a call to the mbrtowc function, with
          -               the conversion state described by an mbstate_t object initialized to zero
          + the conversion state described by an mbstate_t object initialized to zero +
          @@ -15614,7 +16307,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                           the first following right bracket character is the one that ends the
                           specification. If a - character is in the scanlist and is not the first, nor the
                           second where the first character is a ^, nor the last character, the behavior is
          -                implementation-defined.
          + implementation-defined. + p Matches an implementation-defined set of sequences, which should be the
                           same as the set of sequences that may be produced by the %p conversion of
          @@ -15622,7 +16316,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                           pointer to void. The input item is converted to a pointer value in an
                           implementation-defined manner. If the input item is a value converted earlier
                           during the same program execution, the pointer that results shall compare
          -                equal to that value; otherwise the behavior of the %p conversion is undefined.
          + equal to that value; otherwise the behavior of the %p conversion is undefined. + n No input is consumed. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
                           signed integer into which is to be written the number of characters read from
          @@ -15630,11 +16325,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                           %n directive does not increment the assignment count returned at the
                           completion of execution of the fscanf function. No argument is converted,
                           but one is consumed. If the conversion specification includes an assignment-
          -                suppressing character or a field width, the behavior is undefined.
          + suppressing character or a field width, the behavior is undefined. + % Matches a single % character; no conversion or assignment occurs. The -

          -                complete conversion specification shall be %%.
          + complete conversion specification shall be %%. + +

          If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is undefined.280)

          The conversion specifiers A, E, F, G, and X are also valid and behave the same as, @@ -15647,7 +16344,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Trailing white space (including new-line characters) is left unread unless matched by a directive. The success of literal matches and suppressed assignments is not directly determinable other than via the %n directive. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the function returns the @@ -15659,10 +16356,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ int n, i; float x; char name[50]; - n = fscanf(stdin, "%d%f%s", &i, &x, name); + n = fscanf(stdin, "%d%f%s", &i, &x, name); + with the input line:

          -          25 54.32E-1 thompson
          + 25 54.32E-1 thompson + will assign to n the value 3, to i the value 25, to x the value 5.432, and to name the sequence thompson\0. @@ -15672,16 +16371,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ int i; float x; char name[50]; - fscanf(stdin, "%2d%f%*d %[0123456789]", &i, &x, name); + fscanf(stdin, "%2d%f%*d %[0123456789]", &i, &x, name); + with input:
          -          56789 0123 56a72
          + 56789 0123 56a72 + will assign to i the value 56 and to x the value 789.0, will skip 0123, and will assign to name the sequence 56\0. The next character read from the input stream will be a.

          EXAMPLE 3 To accept repeatedly from stdin a quantity, a unit of measure, and an item name: -

                     #include <stdio.h>
                     /* ... */
          @@ -15689,7 +16389,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     do {
                             count = fscanf(stdin, "%f%20s of %20s", &quant, units, item);
                             fscanf(stdin,"%*[^\n]");
          -          } while (!feof(stdin) && !ferror(stdin));
          + } while (!feof(stdin) && !ferror(stdin)); + +

          If the stdin stream contains the following lines:

          @@ -15698,7 +16400,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     lots of luck
                     10.0LBS     of
                     dirt
          -          100ergs of energy
          + 100ergs of energy + the execution of the above example will be analogous to the following assignments:
                      quant     =   2; strcpy(units, "quarts"); strcpy(item, "oil");
          @@ -15709,7 +16412,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      quant     =   10.0; strcpy(units, "LBS"); strcpy(item, "dirt");
                      count     =   3;
                      count     =   0; // "100e" fails to match "%f"
          -           count     =   EOF;
          + count = EOF; +

          EXAMPLE 4 In: @@ -15717,7 +16421,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ int d1, d2, n1, n2, i; - i = sscanf("123", "%d%n%n%d", &d1, &n1, &n2, &d2); + i = sscanf("123", "%d%n%n%d", &d1, &n1, &n2, &d2); + the value 123 is assigned to d1 and the value 3 to n1. Because %n can never get an input failure the value of 3 is also assigned to n2. The value of d2 is not affected. The value 1 is assigned to i. @@ -15733,10 +16438,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ char str[50]; - fscanf(stdin, "a%s", str); + fscanf(stdin, "a%s", str); + with the input line:

          -           a(uparrow) X Y(downarrow) bc
          + a(uparrow) X Y(downarrow) bc + str will contain (uparrow) X Y(downarrow)\0 assuming that none of the bytes of the shift sequences (or of the multibyte characters, in the more general case) appears to be a single-byte white-space character.

          @@ -15746,7 +16453,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stddef.h> /* ... */ wchar_t wstr[50]; - fscanf(stdin, "a%ls", wstr); + fscanf(stdin, "a%ls", wstr); + with the same input line, wstr will contain the two wide characters that correspond to X and Y and a terminating null wide character.

          @@ -15757,7 +16465,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stddef.h> /* ... */ wchar_t wstr[50]; - fscanf(stdin, "a(uparrow) X(downarrow)%ls", wstr); + fscanf(stdin, "a(uparrow) X(downarrow)%ls", wstr); + with the same input line will return zero due to a matching failure against the (downarrow) sequence in the format string.

          @@ -15768,7 +16477,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stddef.h> /* ... */ wchar_t wstr[50]; - fscanf(stdin, "a(uparrow) Y(downarrow)%ls", wstr); + fscanf(stdin, "a(uparrow) Y(downarrow)%ls", wstr); + with the same input line, zero will again be returned, but stdin will be left with a partially consumed multibyte character. @@ -15776,7 +16486,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions (7.22.1.4), conversion state (7.28.6), the wcrtomb function (7.28.6.3.3). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          277) These white-space characters are not counted against a specified field width.

          278) fscanf pushes back at most one input character onto the input stream. Therefore, some sequences @@ -15790,32 +16500,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.6.3 The printf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int printf(const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + int printf(const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The printf function is equivalent to fprintf with the argument stdout interposed before the arguments to printf. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The printf function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred.

          7.21.6.4 The scanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int scanf(const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + int scanf(const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The scanf function is equivalent to fscanf with the argument stdin interposed before the arguments to scanf. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The scanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the scanf function returns the @@ -15823,13 +16535,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the event of an early matching failure.

          7.21.6.5 The snprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int snprintf(char * restrict s, size_t n,
          -              const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The snprintf function is equivalent to fprintf, except that the output is written into an array (specified by argument s) rather than to a stream. If n is zero, nothing is written, @@ -15837,7 +16550,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. discarded rather than being written to the array, and a null character is written at the end of the characters actually written into the array. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The snprintf function returns the number of characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating null character, or a negative @@ -15845,38 +16558,40 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. completely written if and only if the returned value is nonnegative and less than n.

          7.21.6.6 The sprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int sprintf(char * restrict s,
          -              const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The sprintf function is equivalent to fprintf, except that the output is written into an array (specified by the argument s) rather than to a stream. A null character is written at the end of the characters written; it is not counted as part of the returned value. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The sprintf function returns the number of characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null character, or a negative value if an encoding error occurred.

          7.21.6.7 The sscanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
                   int sscanf(const char * restrict s,
          -             const char * restrict format, ...);
          -
          Description
          + const char * restrict format, ...); + +

          Description

          The sscanf function is equivalent to fscanf, except that input is obtained from a string (specified by the argument s) rather than from a stream. Reaching the end of the string is equivalent to encountering end-of-file for the fscanf function. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The sscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the sscanf function @@ -15884,21 +16599,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

          7.21.6.8 The vfprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdarg.h>
                   #include <stdio.h>
                   int vfprintf(FILE * restrict stream,
                        const char * restrict format,
          -             va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vfprintf function is equivalent to fprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vfprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred. @@ -15921,30 +16637,32 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. // print out remainder of message vfprintf(stderr, format, args); va_end(args); - } + } + -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          281) As the functions vfprintf, vfscanf, vprintf, vscanf, vsnprintf, vsprintf, and vsscanf invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

          7.21.6.9 The vfscanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdarg.h>
                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int vfscanf(FILE * restrict stream,
                         const char * restrict format,
          -              va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vfscanf function is equivalent to fscanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vfscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vfscanf function @@ -15952,40 +16670,42 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

          7.21.6.10 The vprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdarg.h>
                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int vprintf(const char * restrict format,
          -              va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vprintf function is equivalent to printf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vprintf function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred.

          7.21.6.11 The vscanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdarg.h>
                   #include <stdio.h>
                   int vscanf(const char * restrict format,
          -             va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vscanf function is equivalent to scanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vscanf function @@ -15993,15 +16713,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

          7.21.6.12 The vsnprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdarg.h>
                   #include <stdio.h>
                   int vsnprintf(char * restrict s, size_t n,
                        const char * restrict format,
          -             va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vsnprintf function is equivalent to snprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and @@ -16009,7 +16730,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. va_end macro.281) If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vsnprintf function returns the number of characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating null character, or a negative @@ -16017,42 +16738,44 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. completely written if and only if the returned value is nonnegative and less than n.

          7.21.6.13 The vsprintf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdarg.h>
                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int vsprintf(char * restrict s,
                         const char * restrict format,
          -              va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vsprintf function is equivalent to sprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vsprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vsprintf function returns the number of characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null character, or a negative value if an encoding error occurred.

          7.21.6.14 The vsscanf function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdarg.h>
                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int vsscanf(const char * restrict s,
                         const char * restrict format,
          -              va_list arg);
          -
          Description
          + va_list arg); + +

          Description

          The vsscanf function is equivalent to sscanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vsscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.281) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The vsscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vsscanf function @@ -16063,18 +16786,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.7 Character input/output functions

          7.21.7.1 The fgetc function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int fgetc(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int fgetc(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          If the end-of-file indicator for the input stream pointed to by stream is not set and a next character is present, the fgetc function obtains that character as an unsigned char converted to an int and advances the associated file position indicator for the stream (if defined). -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          If the end-of-file indicator for the stream is set, or if the stream is at end-of-file, the end- of-file indicator for the stream is set and the fgetc function returns EOF. Otherwise, the @@ -16082,24 +16806,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If a read error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and the fgetc function returns EOF.282) -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          282) An end-of-file and a read error can be distinguished by use of the feof and ferror functions.

          7.21.7.2 The fgets function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    char *fgets(char * restrict s, int n,
          -              FILE * restrict stream);
          -
          Description
          + FILE * restrict stream); + +

          Description

          The fgets function reads at most one less than the number of characters specified by n from the stream pointed to by stream into the array pointed to by s. No additional characters are read after a new-line character (which is retained) or after end-of-file. A null character is written immediately after the last character read into the array. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fgets function returns s if successful. If end-of-file is encountered and no characters have been read into the array, the contents of the array remain unchanged and a @@ -16109,52 +16834,55 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.7.3 The fputc function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int fputc(int c, FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int fputc(int c, FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The fputc function writes the character specified by c (converted to an unsigned char) to the output stream pointed to by stream, at the position indicated by the associated file position indicator for the stream (if defined), and advances the indicator appropriately. If the file cannot support positioning requests, or if the stream was opened with append mode, the character is appended to the output stream. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fputc function returns the character written. If a write error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and fputc returns EOF.

          7.21.7.4 The fputs function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int fputs(const char * restrict s,
          -              FILE * restrict stream);
          -
          Description
          + FILE * restrict stream); + +

          Description

          The fputs function writes the string pointed to by s to the stream pointed to by stream. The terminating null character is not written. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fputs function returns EOF if a write error occurs; otherwise it returns a nonnegative value.

          7.21.7.5 The getc function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int getc(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int getc(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The getc function is equivalent to fgetc, except that if it is implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so the argument should never be an expression with side effects. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The getc function returns the next character from the input stream pointed to by stream. If the stream is at end-of-file, the end-of-file indicator for the stream is set and @@ -16162,15 +16890,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. getc returns EOF.

          7.21.7.6 The getchar function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int getchar(void);
          -
          Description
          + int getchar(void); + +

          Description

          The getchar function is equivalent to getc with the argument stdin. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The getchar function returns the next character from the input stream pointed to by stdin. If the stream is at end-of-file, the end-of-file indicator for the stream is set and @@ -16178,59 +16907,63 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. getchar returns EOF. *

          7.21.7.7 The putc function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int putc(int c, FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int putc(int c, FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The putc function is equivalent to fputc, except that if it is implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so that argument should never be an expression with side effects. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The putc function returns the character written. If a write error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and putc returns EOF.

          7.21.7.8 The putchar function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int putchar(int c);
          -
          Description
          + int putchar(int c); + +

          Description

          The putchar function is equivalent to putc with the second argument stdout. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The putchar function returns the character written. If a write error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and putchar returns EOF.

          7.21.7.9 The puts function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int puts(const char *s);
          -
          Description
          + int puts(const char *s); + +

          Description

          The puts function writes the string pointed to by s to the stream pointed to by stdout, and appends a new-line character to the output. The terminating null character is not written. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The puts function returns EOF if a write error occurs; otherwise it returns a nonnegative value.

          7.21.7.10 The ungetc function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         int ungetc(int c, FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int ungetc(int c, FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The ungetc function pushes the character specified by c (converted to an unsigned char) back onto the input stream pointed to by stream. Pushed-back characters will be @@ -16255,27 +16988,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. For a binary stream, its file position indicator is decremented by each successful call to the ungetc function; if its value was zero before a call, it is indeterminate after the call.283) -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The ungetc function returns the character pushed back after conversion, or EOF if the operation fails.

          Forward references: file positioning functions (7.21.9). -

          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          283) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.9).

          7.21.8 Direct input/output functions

          7.21.8.1 The fread function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                     #include <stdio.h>
                     size_t fread(void * restrict ptr,
                          size_t size, size_t nmemb,
          -               FILE * restrict stream);
          -
          Description
          + FILE * restrict stream); + +

          Description

          The fread function reads, into the array pointed to by ptr, up to nmemb elements whose size is specified by size, from the stream pointed to by stream. For each @@ -16284,7 +17018,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. indicator for the stream (if defined) is advanced by the number of characters successfully read. If an error occurs, the resulting value of the file position indicator for the stream is indeterminate. If a partial element is read, its value is indeterminate. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fread function returns the number of elements successfully read, which may be less than nmemb if a read error or end-of-file is encountered. If size or nmemb is zero, @@ -16297,14 +17031,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.8.2 The fwrite function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    size_t fwrite(const void * restrict ptr,
                         size_t size, size_t nmemb,
          -              FILE * restrict stream);
          -
          Description
          + FILE * restrict stream); + +

          Description

          The fwrite function writes, from the array pointed to by ptr, up to nmemb elements whose size is specified by size, to the stream pointed to by stream. For each object, @@ -16313,7 +17048,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. stream (if defined) is advanced by the number of characters successfully written. If an error occurs, the resulting value of the file position indicator for the stream is indeterminate. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fwrite function returns the number of elements successfully written, which will be less than nmemb only if a write error is encountered. If size or nmemb is zero, @@ -16322,19 +17057,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.9 File positioning functions

          7.21.9.1 The fgetpos function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
                    int fgetpos(FILE * restrict stream,
          -              fpos_t * restrict pos);
          -
          Description
          + fpos_t * restrict pos); + +

          Description

          The fgetpos function stores the current values of the parse state (if any) and file position indicator for the stream pointed to by stream in the object pointed to by pos. The values stored contain unspecified information usable by the fsetpos function for repositioning the stream to its position at the time of the call to the fgetpos function. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          If successful, the fgetpos function returns zero; on failure, the fgetpos function returns nonzero and stores an implementation-defined positive value in errno. @@ -16342,12 +17078,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.9.2 The fseek function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int fseek(FILE *stream, long int offset, int whence);
          -
          Description
          + int fseek(FILE *stream, long int offset, int whence); + +

          Description

          The fseek function sets the file position indicator for the stream pointed to by stream. If a read or write error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and fseek fails. @@ -16366,18 +17103,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. effects of the ungetc function on the stream, clears the end-of-file indicator for the stream, and then establishes the new position. After a successful fseek call, the next operation on an update stream may be either input or output. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The fseek function returns nonzero only for a request that cannot be satisfied.

          Forward references: the ftell function (7.21.9.4).

          7.21.9.3 The fsetpos function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int fsetpos(FILE *stream, const fpos_t *pos);
          -
          Description
          + int fsetpos(FILE *stream, const fpos_t *pos); + +

          Description

          The fsetpos function sets the mbstate_t object (if any) and file position indicator for the stream pointed to by stream according to the value of the object pointed to by @@ -16390,18 +17128,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. parse state and position. After a successful fsetpos call, the next operation on an update stream may be either input or output. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          If successful, the fsetpos function returns zero; on failure, the fsetpos function returns nonzero and stores an implementation-defined positive value in errno.

          7.21.9.4 The ftell function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         long int ftell(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + long int ftell(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The ftell function obtains the current value of the file position indicator for the stream pointed to by stream. For a binary stream, the value is the number of characters from @@ -16410,26 +17149,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. stream to its position at the time of the ftell call; the difference between two such return values is not necessarily a meaningful measure of the number of characters written or read. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          If successful, the ftell function returns the current value of the file position indicator for the stream. On failure, the ftell function returns -1L and stores an implementation-defined positive value in errno.

          7.21.9.5 The rewind function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         void rewind(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + void rewind(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The rewind function sets the file position indicator for the stream pointed to by stream to the beginning of the file. It is equivalent to

          -         (void)fseek(stream, 0L, SEEK_SET)
          + (void)fseek(stream, 0L, SEEK_SET) + except that the error indicator for the stream is also cleared. -
          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The rewind function returns no value. @@ -16437,55 +17178,59 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.21.10 Error-handling functions

          7.21.10.1 The clearerr function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        void clearerr(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + void clearerr(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The clearerr function clears the end-of-file and error indicators for the stream pointed to by stream. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The clearerr function returns no value.

          7.21.10.2 The feof function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int feof(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int feof(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The feof function tests the end-of-file indicator for the stream pointed to by stream. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The feof function returns nonzero if and only if the end-of-file indicator is set for stream.

          7.21.10.3 The ferror function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdio.h>
          -        int ferror(FILE *stream);
          -
          Description
          + int ferror(FILE *stream); + +

          Description

          The ferror function tests the error indicator for the stream pointed to by stream. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The ferror function returns nonzero if and only if the error indicator is set for stream.

          7.21.10.4 The perror function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdio.h>
          -         void perror(const char *s);
          -
          Description
          + void perror(const char *s); + +

          Description

          The perror function maps the error number in the integer expression errno to an error message. It writes a sequence of characters to the standard error stream thus: first @@ -16493,7 +17238,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. string pointed to by s followed by a colon (:) and a space; then an appropriate error message string followed by a new-line character. The contents of the error message strings are the same as those returned by the strerror function with argument errno. -

          Returns
          +

          Returns

          The perror function returns no value.

          Forward references: the strerror function (7.23.6.2). @@ -16506,30 +17251,37 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          The types declared are size_t and wchar_t (both described in 7.19),

          -          div_t
          + div_t + which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by the div function,
          -          ldiv_t
          + ldiv_t + which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by the ldiv function, and
          -          lldiv_t
          + lldiv_t + which is a structure type that is the type of the value returned by the lldiv function.

          The macros defined are NULL (described in 7.19);

          -          EXIT_FAILURE
          + EXIT_FAILURE + and
          -          EXIT_SUCCESS
          + EXIT_SUCCESS + which expand to integer constant expressions that can be used as the argument to the exit function to return unsuccessful or successful termination status, respectively, to the host environment;
          -          RAND_MAX
          + RAND_MAX + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the maximum value returned by the rand function; and
          -          MB_CUR_MAX
          + MB_CUR_MAX + which expands to a positive integer expression with type size_t that is the maximum number of bytes in a multibyte character for the extended character set specified by the current locale (category LC_CTYPE), which is never greater than MB_LEN_MAX. @@ -16539,7 +17291,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -
          footnotes
          +

          Footnotes

          284) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.10). @@ -16550,31 +17302,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. behavior is undefined.

          7.22.1.1 The atof function
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdlib.h>
          -         double atof(const char *nptr);
          -
          Description
          + double atof(const char *nptr); + +

          Description

          The atof function converts the initial portion of the string pointed to by nptr to double representation. Except for the behavior on error, it is equivalent to

          -         strtod(nptr, (char **)NULL)
          -
          Returns
          + strtod(nptr, (char **)NULL) + +

          Returns

          The atof function returns the converted value.

          Forward references: the strtod, strtof, and strtold functions (7.22.1.3).

          7.22.1.2 The atoi, atol, and atoll functions
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                    #include <stdlib.h>
                    int atoi(const char *nptr);
                    long int atol(const char *nptr);
          -         long long int atoll(const char *nptr);
          -
          Description
          + long long int atoll(const char *nptr); + +

          Description

          The atoi, atol, and atoll functions convert the initial portion of the string pointed to by nptr to int, long int, and long long int representation, respectively. @@ -16582,8 +17337,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                    atoi: (int)strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10)
                    atol: strtol(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10)
          -         atoll: strtoll(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10)
          -
          Returns
          + atoll: strtoll(nptr, (char **)NULL, 10) + +

          Returns

          The atoi, atol, and atoll functions return the converted value.

          Forward references: the strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions @@ -16591,7 +17347,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

          7.22.1.3 The strtod, strtof, and strtold functions
          -
          Synopsis
          +

          Synopsis

                   #include <stdlib.h>
          @@ -16600,8 +17356,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                   float strtof(const char * restrict nptr,
                        char ** restrict endptr);
                   long double strtold(const char * restrict nptr,
          -             char ** restrict endptr);
          -
          Description
          + char ** restrict endptr); + +

          Description

          The strtod, strtof, and strtold functions convert the initial portion of the string pointed to by nptr to double, float, and long double representation, @@ -16626,7 +17383,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. digit nondigit n-char-sequence digit - n-char-sequence nondigit + n-char-sequence nondigit +

        The subject sequence is defined as the longest initial subsequence of the input string, starting with the first non-white-space character, that is of the expected form. The subject @@ -16658,7 +17416,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the object pointed to by endptr, provided that endptr is not a null pointer. -
        Recommended practice
        +

        Recommended practice

        If the subject sequence has the hexadecimal form, FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2, and the result is not exactly representable, the result should be one of the two numbers in the @@ -16677,7 +17435,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. stipulation that the error with respect to D should have a correct sign for the current rounding direction.287) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The functions return the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value overflows and default rounding is in effect (7.12.1), @@ -16687,7 +17445,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. no greater than the smallest normalized positive number in the return type; whether errno acquires the value ERANGE is implementation-defined. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        285) It is unspecified whether a minus-signed sequence is converted to a negative number directly or by negating the value resulting from converting the corresponding unsigned sequence (see F.5); the two methods may yield different results if rounding is toward positive or negative infinity. In either case, @@ -16701,7 +17459,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.22.1.4 The strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        @@ -16720,8 +17478,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  unsigned long long int strtoull(
                       const char * restrict nptr,
                       char ** restrict endptr,
        -              int base);
        -
        Description
        + int base); + +

        Description

        The strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions convert the initial portion of the string pointed to by nptr to long int, long long int, unsigned @@ -16766,7 +17525,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the object pointed to by endptr, provided that endptr is not a null pointer. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strtol, strtoll, strtoul, and strtoull functions return the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value @@ -16778,38 +17537,40 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.22.2 Pseudo-random sequence generation functions

        7.22.2.1 The rand function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         int rand(void);
        -
        Description
        + int rand(void); + +

        Description

        The rand function computes a sequence of pseudo-random integers in the range 0 to RAND_MAX.288)

        The rand function is not required to avoid data races. The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the rand function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The rand function returns a pseudo-random integer. -

        Environmental limits
        +

        Environmental limits

        The value of the RAND_MAX macro shall be at least 32767. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        288) There are no guarantees as to the quality of the random sequence produced and some implementations are known to produce sequences with distressingly non-random low-order bits. Applications with particular requirements should use a generator that is known to be sufficient for their needs.

        7.22.2.2 The srand function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void srand(unsigned int seed);
        -
        Description
        + void srand(unsigned int seed); + +

        Description

        The srand function uses the argument as a seed for a new sequence of pseudo-random numbers to be returned by subsequent calls to rand. If srand is then called with the @@ -16818,7 +17579,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. as when srand is first called with a seed value of 1.

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the srand function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The srand function returns no value. @@ -16838,7 +17599,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. void srand(unsigned int seed) { next = seed; - } + } +

        7.22.3 Memory management functions

        @@ -16857,66 +17619,70 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. returned pointer shall not be used to access an object.
        7.22.3.1 The aligned_alloc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void *aligned_alloc(size_t alignment, size_t size);
        -
        Description
        + void *aligned_alloc(size_t alignment, size_t size); + +

        Description

        The aligned_alloc function allocates space for an object whose alignment is specified by alignment, whose size is specified by size, and whose value is indeterminate. The value of alignment shall be a valid alignment supported by the implementation and the value of size shall be an integral multiple of alignment. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The aligned_alloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to the allocated space.

        7.22.3.2 The calloc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void *calloc(size_t nmemb, size_t size);
        -
        Description
        + void *calloc(size_t nmemb, size_t size); + +

        Description

        The calloc function allocates space for an array of nmemb objects, each of whose size is size. The space is initialized to all bits zero.289) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The calloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to the allocated space. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        289) Note that this need not be the same as the representation of floating-point zero or a null pointer constant.

        7.22.3.3 The free function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void free(void *ptr);
        -
        Description
        + void free(void *ptr); + +

        Description

        The free function causes the space pointed to by ptr to be deallocated, that is, made available for further allocation. If ptr is a null pointer, no action occurs. Otherwise, if the argument does not match a pointer earlier returned by a memory management function, or if the space has been deallocated by a call to free or realloc, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The free function returns no value.

        7.22.3.4 The malloc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void *malloc(size_t size);
        -
        Description
        + void *malloc(size_t size); + +

        Description

        The malloc function allocates space for an object whose size is specified by size and whose value is indeterminate. @@ -16925,17 +17691,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The malloc function returns either a null pointer or a pointer to the allocated space.

        7.22.3.5 The realloc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         void *realloc(void *ptr, size_t size);
        -
        Description
        + void *realloc(void *ptr, size_t size); + +

        Description

        The realloc function deallocates the old object pointed to by ptr and returns a pointer to a new object that has the size specified by size. The contents of the new @@ -16948,7 +17715,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. management function, or if the space has been deallocated by a call to the free or realloc function, the behavior is undefined. If memory for the new object cannot be allocated, the old object is not deallocated and its value is unchanged. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The realloc function returns a pointer to the new object (which may have the same value as a pointer to the old object), or a null pointer if the new object could not be @@ -16957,12 +17724,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.22.4 Communication with the environment

        7.22.4.1 The abort function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         _Noreturn void abort(void);
        -
        Description
        + _Noreturn void abort(void); + +

        Description

        The abort function causes abnormal program termination to occur, unless the signal SIGABRT is being caught and the signal handler does not return. Whether open streams @@ -16971,48 +17739,50 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. unsuccessful termination is returned to the host environment by means of the function call raise(SIGABRT). -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The abort function does not return to its caller.

        7.22.4.2 The atexit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdlib.h>
        -        int atexit(void (*func)(void));
        -
        Description
        + int atexit(void (*func)(void)); + +

        Description

        The atexit function registers the function pointed to by func, to be called without arguments at normal program termination.290) -

        Environmental limits
        +

        Environmental limits

        The implementation shall support the registration of at least 32 functions. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The atexit function returns zero if the registration succeeds, nonzero if it fails.

        Forward references: the at_quick_exit function (7.22.4.3), the exit function (7.22.4.4). -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        290) The atexit function registrations are distinct from the at_quick_exit registrations, so applications may need to call both registration functions with the same argument.

        7.22.4.3 The at_quick_exit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdlib.h>
        -        int at_quick_exit(void (*func)(void));
        -
        Description
        + int at_quick_exit(void (*func)(void)); + +

        Description

        The at_quick_exit function registers the function pointed to by func, to be called without arguments should quick_exit be called.291) -

        Environmental limits
        +

        Environmental limits

        The implementation shall support the registration of at least 32 functions. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The at_quick_exit function returns zero if the registration succeeds, nonzero if it fails. @@ -17021,18 +17791,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        291) The at_quick_exit function registrations are distinct from the atexit registrations, so applications may need to call both registration functions with the same argument.

        7.22.4.4 The exit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         _Noreturn void exit(int status);
        -
        Description
        + _Noreturn void exit(int status); + +

        Description

        The exit function causes normal program termination to occur. No functions registered by the at_quick_exit function are called. If a program calls the exit function @@ -17053,22 +17824,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. returned. If the value of status is EXIT_FAILURE, an implementation-defined form of the status unsuccessful termination is returned. Otherwise the status returned is implementation-defined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The exit function cannot return to its caller. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        292) Each function is called as many times as it was registered, and in the correct order with respect to other registered functions.

        7.22.4.5 The _Exit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         _Noreturn void _Exit(int status);
        -
        Description
        + _Noreturn void _Exit(int status); + +

        Description

        The _Exit function causes normal program termination to occur and control to be returned to the host environment. No functions registered by the atexit function, the @@ -17080,17 +17852,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the exit function (7.22.4.4). Whether open streams with unwritten buffered data are flushed, open streams are closed, or temporary files are removed is implementation- defined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The _Exit function cannot return to its caller.

        7.22.4.6 The getenv function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         char *getenv(const char *name);
        -
        Description
        + char *getenv(const char *name); + +

        Description

        The getenv function searches an environment list, provided by the host environment, for a string that matches the string pointed to by name. The set of environment names @@ -17099,24 +17872,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the environment list.293)

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the getenv function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The getenv function returns a pointer to a string associated with the matched list member. The string pointed to shall not be modified by the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent call to the getenv function. If the specified name cannot be found, a null pointer is returned. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        293) Many implementations provide non-standard functions that modify the environment list.

        7.22.4.7 The quick_exit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         _Noreturn void quick_exit(int status);
        -
        Description
        + _Noreturn void quick_exit(int status); + +

        Description

        The quick_exit function causes normal program termination to occur. No functions registered by the atexit function or signal handlers registered by the signal function @@ -17134,29 +17908,30 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        Then control is returned to the host environment by means of the function call _Exit(status). -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The quick_exit function cannot return to its caller. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        294) Each function is called as many times as it was registered, and in the correct order with respect to other registered functions.

        7.22.4.8 The system function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
        -         int system(const char *string);
        -
        Description
        + int system(const char *string); + +

        Description

        If string is a null pointer, the system function determines whether the host environment has a command processor. If string is not a null pointer, the system function passes the string pointed to by string to that command processor to be executed in a manner which the implementation shall document; this might then cause the program calling system to behave in a non-conforming manner or to terminate. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the argument is a null pointer, the system function returns nonzero only if a command processor is available. If the argument is not a null pointer, and the system @@ -17194,25 +17969,27 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. comparison function, and also between any call to the comparison function and any movement of the objects passed as arguments to that call. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        295) That is, if the value passed is p, then the following expressions are always nonzero:

                   ((char *)p - (char *)base) % size == 0
                   (char *)p >= (char *)base
        -          (char *)p < (char *)base + nmemb * size
        + (char *)p < (char *)base + nmemb * size +
        7.22.5.1 The bsearch function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <stdlib.h>
                   void *bsearch(const void *key, const void *base,
                        size_t nmemb, size_t size,
        -               int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
        -
        Description
        + int (*compar)(const void *, const void *)); + +

        Description

        The bsearch function searches an array of nmemb objects, the initial element of which is pointed to by base, for an element that matches the object pointed to by key. The @@ -17224,7 +18001,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. respectively, to be less than, to match, or to be greater than the array element. The array shall consist of: all the elements that compare less than, all the elements that compare equal to, and all the elements that compare greater than the key object, in that order.296) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The bsearch function returns a pointer to a matching element of the array, or a null pointer if no match is found. If two elements compare as equal, which element is @@ -17233,18 +18010,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. matched is unspecified. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        296) In practice, the entire array is sorted according to the comparison function.

        7.22.5.2 The qsort function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
                  void qsort(void *base, size_t nmemb, size_t size,
        -              int (*compar)(const void *, const void *));
        -
        Description
        + int (*compar)(const void *, const void *)); + +

        Description

        The qsort function sorts an array of nmemb objects, the initial element of which is pointed to by base. The size of each object is specified by size. @@ -17256,25 +18034,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. or greater than the second.

        If two elements compare as equal, their order in the resulting sorted array is unspecified. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The qsort function returns no value.

        7.22.6 Integer arithmetic functions

        7.22.6.1 The abs, labs and llabs functions
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
                  int abs(int j);
                  long int labs(long int j);
        -         long long int llabs(long long int j);
        -
        Description
        + long long int llabs(long long int j); + +

        Description

        The abs, labs, and llabs functions compute the absolute value of an integer j. If the result cannot be represented, the behavior is undefined.297) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The abs, labs, and llabs, functions return the absolute value. @@ -17283,23 +18062,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        297) The absolute value of the most negative number cannot be represented in two's complement.

        7.22.6.2 The div, ldiv, and lldiv functions
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <stdlib.h>
                   div_t div(int numer, int denom);
                   ldiv_t ldiv(long int numer, long int denom);
        -          lldiv_t lldiv(long long int numer, long long int denom);
        -
        Description
        + lldiv_t lldiv(long long int numer, long long int denom); + +

        Description

        The div, ldiv, and lldiv, functions compute numer / denom and numer % denom in a single operation. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The div, ldiv, and lldiv functions return a structure of type div_t, ldiv_t, and lldiv_t, respectively, comprising both the quotient and the remainder. The structures @@ -17318,18 +18098,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. if encodings have state dependency, and zero otherwise.298) Changing the LC_CTYPE category causes the conversion state of these functions to be indeterminate. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        298) If the locale employs special bytes to change the shift state, these bytes do not produce separate wide character codes, but are grouped with an adjacent multibyte character.

        7.22.7.1 The mblen function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <stdlib.h>
        -          int mblen(const char *s, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + int mblen(const char *s, size_t n); + +

        Description

        If s is not a null pointer, the mblen function determines the number of bytes contained in the multibyte character pointed to by s. Except that the conversion state of the @@ -17338,12 +18119,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

                  mbtowc((wchar_t *)0, (const char *)0, 0);
        -         mbtowc((wchar_t *)0, s, n);
        + mbtowc((wchar_t *)0, s, n); + +

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the mblen function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If s is a null pointer, the mblen function returns a nonzero or zero value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do not have state-dependent encodings. If s is @@ -17354,14 +18136,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        Forward references: the mbtowc function (7.22.7.2).

        7.22.7.2 The mbtowc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdlib.h>
                  int mbtowc(wchar_t * restrict pwc,
                       const char * restrict s,
        -              size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        If s is not a null pointer, the mbtowc function inspects at most n bytes beginning with the byte pointed to by s to determine the number of bytes needed to complete the next @@ -17372,7 +18155,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. character, the function is left in the initial conversion state.

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the mbtowc function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If s is a null pointer, the mbtowc function returns a nonzero or zero value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do not have state-dependent encodings. If s is @@ -17386,12 +18169,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.22.7.3 The wctomb function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdlib.h>
        -        int wctomb(char *s, wchar_t wc);
        -
        Description
        + int wctomb(char *s, wchar_t wc); + +

        Description

        The wctomb function determines the number of bytes needed to represent the multibyte character corresponding to the wide character given by wc (including any shift @@ -17402,7 +18186,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversion state.

        The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the wctomb function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If s is a null pointer, the wctomb function returns a nonzero or zero value, if multibyte character encodings, respectively, do or do not have state-dependent encodings. If s is @@ -17418,14 +18202,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the current locale.

        7.22.8.1 The mbstowcs function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdlib.h>
                 size_t mbstowcs(wchar_t * restrict pwcs,
                      const char * restrict s,
        -             size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The mbstowcs function converts a sequence of multibyte characters that begins in the initial shift state from the array pointed to by s into a sequence of corresponding wide @@ -17438,25 +18223,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        No more than n elements will be modified in the array pointed to by pwcs. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If an invalid multibyte character is encountered, the mbstowcs function returns (size_t)(-1). Otherwise, the mbstowcs function returns the number of array elements modified, not including a terminating null wide character, if any.299) -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        299) The array will not be null-terminated if the value returned is n.

        7.22.8.2 The wcstombs function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <stdlib.h>
                   size_t wcstombs(char * restrict s,
                        const wchar_t * restrict pwcs,
        -               size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The wcstombs function converts a sequence of wide characters from the array pointed to by pwcs into a sequence of corresponding multibyte characters that begins in the @@ -17467,7 +18253,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        No more than n bytes will be modified in the array pointed to by s. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If a wide character is encountered that does not correspond to a valid multibyte character, the wcstombs function returns (size_t)(-1). Otherwise, the wcstombs function @@ -17502,26 +18288,27 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. unsigned char (and therefore every possible object representation is valid and has a different value). -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        300) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.11).

        7.23.2 Copying functions

        7.23.2.1 The memcpy function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <string.h>
                   void *memcpy(void * restrict s1,
                        const void * restrict s2,
        -               size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The memcpy function copies n characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The memcpy function returns the value of s1. @@ -17531,47 +18318,50 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.23.2.2 The memmove function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         void *memmove(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + void *memmove(void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n); + +

        Description

        The memmove function copies n characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. Copying takes place as if the n characters from the object pointed to by s2 are first copied into a temporary array of n characters that does not overlap the objects pointed to by s1 and s2, and then the n characters from the temporary array are copied into the object pointed to by s1. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The memmove function returns the value of s1.

        7.23.2.3 The strcpy function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
                  char *strcpy(char * restrict s1,
        -              const char * restrict s2);
        -
        Description
        + const char * restrict s2); + +

        Description

        The strcpy function copies the string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null character) into the array pointed to by s1. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strcpy function returns the value of s1.

        7.23.2.4 The strncpy function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
                  char *strncpy(char * restrict s1,
                       const char * restrict s2,
        -              size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The strncpy function copies not more than n characters (characters that follow a null character are not copied) from the array pointed to by s2 to the array pointed to by @@ -17581,11 +18371,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the array pointed to by s2 is a string that is shorter than n characters, null characters are appended to the copy in the array pointed to by s1, until n characters in all have been written. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strncpy function returns the value of s1. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        301) Thus, if there is no null character in the first n characters of the array pointed to by s2, the result will not be null-terminated. @@ -17593,31 +18383,33 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.23.3 Concatenation functions

        7.23.3.1 The strcat function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <string.h>
                   char *strcat(char * restrict s1,
        -               const char * restrict s2);
        -
        Description
        + const char * restrict s2); + +

        Description

        The strcat function appends a copy of the string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null character) to the end of the string pointed to by s1. The initial character of s2 overwrites the null character at the end of s1. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strcat function returns the value of s1.

        7.23.3.2 The strncat function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                   #include <string.h>
                   char *strncat(char * restrict s1,
                        const char * restrict s2,
        -               size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The strncat function appends not more than n characters (a null character and characters that follow it are not appended) from the array pointed to by s2 to the end of @@ -17626,12 +18418,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strncat function returns the value of s1.

        Forward references: the strlen function (7.23.6.3). -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        302) Thus, the maximum number of characters that can end up in the array pointed to by s1 is strlen(s1)+n+1. @@ -17644,38 +18436,40 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. compared.

        7.23.4.1 The memcmp function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         int memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + int memcmp(const void *s1, const void *s2, size_t n); + +

        Description

        The memcmp function compares the first n characters of the object pointed to by s1 to the first n characters of the object pointed to by s2.303) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The memcmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the object pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the object pointed to by s2. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        303) The contents of ''holes'' used as padding for purposes of alignment within structure objects are indeterminate. Strings shorter than their allocated space and unions may also cause problems in comparison.

        7.23.4.2 The strcmp function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         int strcmp(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + int strcmp(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strcmp function compares the string pointed to by s1 to the string pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strcmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the string pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the string @@ -17684,47 +18478,50 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pointed to by s2.

        7.23.4.3 The strcoll function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        int strcoll(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + int strcoll(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strcoll function compares the string pointed to by s1 to the string pointed to by s2, both interpreted as appropriate to the LC_COLLATE category of the current locale. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strcoll function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the string pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the string pointed to by s2 when both are interpreted as appropriate to the current locale.

        7.23.4.4 The strncmp function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        int strncmp(const char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + int strncmp(const char *s1, const char *s2, size_t n); + +

        Description

        The strncmp function compares not more than n characters (characters that follow a null character are not compared) from the array pointed to by s1 to the array pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strncmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the possibly null-terminated array pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the possibly null-terminated array pointed to by s2.

        7.23.4.5 The strxfrm function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
                 size_t strxfrm(char * restrict s1,
                      const char * restrict s2,
        -             size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + size_t n); + +

        Description

        The strxfrm function transforms the string pointed to by s2 and places the resulting string into the array pointed to by s1. The transformation is such that if the strcmp @@ -17735,7 +18532,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pointed to by s1, including the terminating null character. If n is zero, s1 is permitted to be a null pointer. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strxfrm function returns the length of the transformed string (not including the terminating null character). If the value returned is n or more, the contents of the array @@ -17744,130 +18541,139 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE The value of the following expression is the size of the array needed to hold the transformation of the string pointed to by s.

        -         1 + strxfrm(NULL, s, 0)
        + 1 + strxfrm(NULL, s, 0) +

        7.23.5 Search functions

        7.23.5.1 The memchr function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         void *memchr(const void *s, int c, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + void *memchr(const void *s, int c, size_t n); + +

        Description

        The memchr function locates the first occurrence of c (converted to an unsigned char) in the initial n characters (each interpreted as unsigned char) of the object pointed to by s. The implementation shall behave as if it reads the characters sequentially and stops as soon as a matching character is found. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The memchr function returns a pointer to the located character, or a null pointer if the character does not occur in the object.

        7.23.5.2 The strchr function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         char *strchr(const char *s, int c);
        -
        Description
        + char *strchr(const char *s, int c); + +

        Description

        The strchr function locates the first occurrence of c (converted to a char) in the string pointed to by s. The terminating null character is considered to be part of the string. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strchr function returns a pointer to the located character, or a null pointer if the character does not occur in the string.

        7.23.5.3 The strcspn function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        size_t strcspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + size_t strcspn(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strcspn function computes the length of the maximum initial segment of the string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of characters not from the string pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strcspn function returns the length of the segment.

        7.23.5.4 The strpbrk function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        char *strpbrk(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + char *strpbrk(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strpbrk function locates the first occurrence in the string pointed to by s1 of any character from the string pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strpbrk function returns a pointer to the character, or a null pointer if no character from s2 occurs in s1.

        7.23.5.5 The strrchr function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        char *strrchr(const char *s, int c);
        -
        Description
        + char *strrchr(const char *s, int c); + +

        Description

        The strrchr function locates the last occurrence of c (converted to a char) in the string pointed to by s. The terminating null character is considered to be part of the string. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strrchr function returns a pointer to the character, or a null pointer if c does not occur in the string.

        7.23.5.6 The strspn function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         size_t strspn(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + size_t strspn(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strspn function computes the length of the maximum initial segment of the string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of characters from the string pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strspn function returns the length of the segment.

        7.23.5.7 The strstr function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         char *strstr(const char *s1, const char *s2);
        -
        Description
        + char *strstr(const char *s1, const char *s2); + +

        Description

        The strstr function locates the first occurrence in the string pointed to by s1 of the sequence of characters (excluding the terminating null character) in the string pointed to by s2. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strstr function returns a pointer to the located string, or a null pointer if the string is not found. If s2 points to a string with zero length, the function returns s1.

        7.23.5.8 The strtok function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
                  char *strtok(char * restrict s1,
        -              const char * restrict s2);
        -
        Description
        + const char * restrict s2); + +

        Description

        A sequence of calls to the strtok function breaks the string pointed to by s1 into a sequence of tokens, each of which is delimited by a character from the string pointed to @@ -17893,7 +18699,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The strtok function is not required to avoid data races. The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the strtok function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strtok function returns a pointer to the first character of a token, or a null pointer if there is no token. @@ -17906,33 +18712,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. t = strtok(str, "?"); // t points to the token "a" t = strtok(NULL, ","); // t points to the token "??b" t = strtok(NULL, "#,"); // t points to the token "c" - t = strtok(NULL, "?"); // t is a null pointer + t = strtok(NULL, "?"); // t is a null pointer +

        7.23.6 Miscellaneous functions

        7.23.6.1 The memset function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <string.h>
        -        void *memset(void *s, int c, size_t n);
        -
        Description
        + void *memset(void *s, int c, size_t n); + +

        Description

        The memset function copies the value of c (converted to an unsigned char) into each of the first n characters of the object pointed to by s. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The memset function returns the value of s.

        7.23.6.2 The strerror function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         char *strerror(int errnum);
        -
        Description
        + char *strerror(int errnum); + +

        Description

        The strerror function maps the number in errnum to a message string. Typically, the values for errnum come from errno, but strerror shall map any value of type @@ -17940,22 +18749,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The strerror function is not required to avoid data races. The implementation shall behave as if no library function calls the strerror function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strerror function returns a pointer to the string, the contents of which are locale- specific. The array pointed to shall not be modified by the program, but may be overwritten by a subsequent call to the strerror function.

        7.23.6.3 The strlen function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <string.h>
        -         size_t strlen(const char *s);
        -
        Description
        + size_t strlen(const char *s); + +

        Description

        The strlen function computes the length of the string pointed to by s. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The strlen function returns the number of characters that precede the terminating null character. @@ -18012,7 +18822,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. log clog log pow cpow pow sqrt csqrt sqrt - fabs cabs fabs + fabs cabs fabs + If at least one argument for a generic parameter is complex, then use of the macro invokes a complex function; otherwise, use of the macro invokes a real function.

        @@ -18029,7 +18840,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. exp2 ilogb lround tgamma expm1 ldexp nearbyint trunc fdim lgamma nextafter - floor llrint nexttoward + floor llrint nexttoward + If all arguments for generic parameters are real, then use of the macro invokes a real function; otherwise, use of the macro results in undefined behavior. @@ -18039,7 +18851,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function. These type-generic macros are:

                 carg                     conj                     creal
        -        cimag                    cproj
        + cimag cproj + Use of the macro with any real or complex argument invokes a complex function.

        EXAMPLE With the declarations @@ -18051,7 +18864,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. long double ld; float complex fc; double complex dc; - long double complex ldc; + long double complex ldc; + functions invoked by use of type-generic macros are shown in the following table:

        @@ -18076,9 +18890,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      cimag(ld)                           cimagl(ld)
                      fabs(fc)                            cabsf(fc)
                      carg(dc)                            carg(dc), the function
        -             cproj(ldc)                          cprojl(ldc)
        + cproj(ldc) cprojl(ldc) + -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        304) Like other function-like macros in Standard libraries, each type-generic macro can be suppressed to make available the corresponding ordinary function. @@ -18098,78 +18913,98 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The macros are

        -         ONCE_FLAG_INIT
        + ONCE_FLAG_INIT + which expands to a value that can be used to initialize an object of type once_flag; and
        -         TSS_DTOR_ITERATIONS
        + TSS_DTOR_ITERATIONS + which expands to an integer constant expression representing the maximum number of times that destructors will be called when a thread terminates.

        The types are

        -         cnd_t
        + cnd_t + which is a complete object type that holds an identifier for a condition variable;
        -         thrd_t
        + thrd_t + which is a complete object type that holds an identifier for a thread;
        -         tss_t
        + tss_t + which is a complete object type that holds an identifier for a thread-specific storage pointer;
        -         mtx_t
        + mtx_t + which is a complete object type that holds an identifier for a mutex;
        -         tss_dtor_t
        + tss_dtor_t + which is the function pointer type void (*)(void*), used for a destructor for a thread-specific storage pointer;
        -         thrd_start_t
        + thrd_start_t + which is the function pointer type int (*)(void*) that is passed to thrd_create to create a new thread;
        -         once_flag
        + once_flag + which is a complete object type that holds a flag for use by call_once; and
        -        xtime
        + xtime + which is a structure type that holds a time specified in seconds and nanoseconds. The structure shall contain at least the following members, in any order. -

                 time_t sec;
        -        long nsec;
        + long nsec; + +

        The enumeration constants are

        -        mtx_plain
        + mtx_plain + which is passed to mtx_init to create a mutex object that supports neither timeout nor test and return;
        -        mtx_recursive
        + mtx_recursive + which is passed to mtx_init to create a mutex object that supports recursive locking;
        -        mtx_timed
        + mtx_timed + which is passed to mtx_init to create a mutex object that supports timeout;
        -        mtx_try
        + mtx_try + which is passed to mtx_init to create a mutex object that supports test and return;
        -        thrd_timeout
        + thrd_timeout + which is returned by a timed wait function to indicate that the time specified in the call was reached without acquiring the requested resource;
        -        thrd_success
        + thrd_success + which is returned by a function to indicate that the requested operation succeeded;
        -        thrd_busy
        + thrd_busy + which is returned by a function to indicate that the requested operation failed because a resource requested by a test and return function is already in use;
        -        thrd_error
        + thrd_error + which is returned by a function to indicate that the requested operation failed; and
        -        thrd_nomem
        + thrd_nomem + which is returned by a function to indicate that the requested operation failed because it was unable to allocate memory. @@ -18177,100 +19012,106 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.25.2 Initialization functions

        7.25.2.1 The call_once function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void call_once(once_flag *flag, void (*func)(void));
        -
        Description
        + void call_once(once_flag *flag, void (*func)(void)); + +

        Description

        The call_once function uses the once_flag pointed to by flag to ensure that func is called exactly once, the first time the call_once function is called with that value of flag. Completion of an effective call to the call_once function synchronizes with all subsequent calls to the call_once function with the same value of flag. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The call_once function returns no value.

        7.25.3 Condition variable functions

        7.25.3.1 The cnd_broadcast function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int cnd_broadcast(cnd_t *cond);
        -
        Description
        + int cnd_broadcast(cnd_t *cond); + +

        Description

        The cnd_broadcast function unblocks all of the threads that are blocked on the condition variable pointed to by cond at the time of the call. If no threads are blocked on the condition variable pointed to by cond at the time of the call, the function does nothing. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_broadcast function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.3.2 The cnd_destroy function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void cnd_destroy(cnd_t *cond);
        -
        Description
        + void cnd_destroy(cnd_t *cond); + +

        Description

        The cnd_destroy function releases all resources used by the condition variable pointed to by cond. The cnd_destroy function requires that no threads be blocked waiting for the condition variable pointed to by cond. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_destroy function returns no value.

        7.25.3.3 The cnd_init function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int cnd_init(cnd_t *cond);
        -
        Description
        + int cnd_init(cnd_t *cond); + +

        Description

        The cnd_init function creates a condition variable. If it succeeds it sets the variable pointed to by cond to a value that uniquely identifies the newly created condition variable. A thread that calls cnd_wait on a newly created condition variable will block. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_init function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_nomem if no memory could be allocated for the newly created condition, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.3.4 The cnd_signal function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int cnd_signal(cnd_t *cond);
        -
        Description
        + int cnd_signal(cnd_t *cond); + +

        Description

        The cnd_signal function unblocks one of the threads that are blocked on the condition variable pointed to by cond at the time of the call. If no threads are blocked on the condition variable at the time of the call, the function does nothing and return success. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_signal function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.3.5 The cnd_timedwait function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
                 int cnd_timedwait(cnd_t *cond, mtx_t *mtx,
        -             const xtime *xt);
        -
        Description
        + const xtime *xt); + +

        Description

        The cnd_timedwait function atomically unlocks the mutex pointed to by mtx and endeavors to block until the condition variable pointed to by cond is signaled by a call to @@ -18278,19 +19119,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. object pointed to by xt. When the calling thread becomes unblocked it locks the variable pointed to by mtx before it returns. The cnd_timedwait function requires that the mutex pointed to by mtx be locked by the calling thread. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_timedwait function returns thrd_success upon success, or thrd_timeout if the time specified in the call was reached without acquiring the requested resource, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.3.6 The cnd_wait function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int cnd_wait(cnd_t *cond, mtx_t *mtx);
        -
        Description
        + int cnd_wait(cnd_t *cond, mtx_t *mtx); + +

        Description

        The cnd_wait function atomically unlocks the mutex pointed to by mtx and endeavors to block until the condition variable pointed to by cond is signaled by a call to @@ -18298,7 +19140,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. locks the mutex pointed to by mtx before it returns. If the mutex pointed to by mtx is not locked by the calling thread, the cnd_wait function will act as if the abort function is called. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The cnd_wait function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored. @@ -18306,27 +19148,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.25.4 Mutex functions

        7.25.4.1 The mtx_destroy function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void mtx_destroy(mtx_t *mtx);
        -
        Description
        + void mtx_destroy(mtx_t *mtx); + +

        Description

        The mtx_destroy function releases any resources used by the mutex pointed to by mtx. No threads can be blocked waiting for the mutex pointed to by mtx. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_destroy function returns no value.

        7.25.4.2 The mtx_init function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int mtx_init(mtx_t *mtx, int type);
        -
        Description
        + int mtx_init(mtx_t *mtx, int type); + +

        Description

        The mtx_init function creates a mutex object with properties indicated by type, which must have one of the six values: @@ -18339,23 +19183,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        If the mtx_init function succeeds, it sets the mutex pointed to by mtx to a value that uniquely identifies the newly created mutex. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_init function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.4.3 The mtx_lock function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int mtx_lock(mtx_t *mtx);
        -
        Description
        + int mtx_lock(mtx_t *mtx); + +

        Description

        The mtx_lock function blocks until it locks the mutex pointed to by mtx. If the mutex is non-recursive, it shall not be locked by the calling thread. Prior calls to mtx_unlock on the same mutex shall synchronize with this operation. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_lock function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_busy if the resource requested is already in use, or thrd_error if the request could not be @@ -18363,18 +19208,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.25.4.4 The mtx_timedlock function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int mtx_timedlock(mtx_t *mtx, const xtime *xt);
        -
        Description
        + int mtx_timedlock(mtx_t *mtx, const xtime *xt); + +

        Description

        The mtx_timedlock function endeavors to block until it locks the mutex pointed to by mtx or until the time specified by the xtime object xt has passed. The specified mutex shall support timeout. If the operation succeeds, prior calls to mtx_unlock on the same mutex shall synchronize with this operation. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_timedlock function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_busy if the resource requested is already in use, or thrd_timeout if the time specified was @@ -18382,35 +19228,37 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. not be honored.

        7.25.4.5 The mtx_trylock function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int mtx_trylock(mtx_t *mtx);
        -
        Description
        + int mtx_trylock(mtx_t *mtx); + +

        Description

        The mtx_trylock function endeavors to lock the mutex pointed to by mtx. The specified mutex shall support either test and return or timeout. If the mutex is already locked, the function returns without blocking. If the operation succeeds, prior calls to mtx_unlock on the same mutex shall synchronize with this operation. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_trylock function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_busy if the resource requested is already in use, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.4.6 The mtx_unlock function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int mtx_unlock(mtx_t *mtx);
        -
        Description
        + int mtx_unlock(mtx_t *mtx); + +

        Description

        The mtx_unlock function unlocks the mutex pointed to by mtx. The mutex pointed to by mtx shall be locked by the calling thread. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mtx_unlock function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored. @@ -18418,13 +19266,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.25.5 Thread functions

        7.25.5.1 The thrd_create function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
                 int thrd_create(thrd_t *thr, thrd_start_t func,
        -             void *arg);
        -
        Description
        + void *arg); + +

        Description

        The thrd_create function creates a new thread executing func(arg). If the thrd_create function succeeds, it sets the object pointed to by thr to the identifier of @@ -18432,78 +19281,83 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the original thread has exited and either been detached or joined to another thread.) The completion of the thrd_create function synchronizes with the beginning of the execution of the new thread. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_create function returns thrd_success on success, or thrd_nomem if no memory could be allocated for the thread requested, or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.5.2 The thrd_current function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        thrd_t thrd_current(void);
        -
        Description
        + thrd_t thrd_current(void); + +

        Description

        The thrd_current function identifies the thread that called it. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_current function returns the identifier of the thread that called it.

        7.25.5.3 The thrd_detach function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int thrd_detach(thrd_t thr);
        -
        Description
        + int thrd_detach(thrd_t thr); + +

        Description

        The thrd_detach function tells the operating system to dispose of any resources allocated to the thread identified by thr when that thread terminates. The thread identified by thr shall not have been previously detached or joined with another thread. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_detach function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.5.4 The thrd_equal function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int thrd_equal(thrd_t thr0, thrd_t thr1);
        -
        Description
        + int thrd_equal(thrd_t thr0, thrd_t thr1); + +

        Description

        The thrd_equal function will determine whether the thread identified by thr0 refers to the thread identified by thr1. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_equal function returns zero if the thread thr0 and the thread thr1 refer to different threads. Otherwise the thrd_equal function returns a nonzero value.

        7.25.5.5 The thrd_exit function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void thrd_exit(int res);
        -
        Description
        + void thrd_exit(int res); + +

        Description

        The thrd_exit function terminates execution of the calling thread and sets its result code to res. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_exit function returns no value.

        7.25.5.6 The thrd_join function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int thrd_join(thrd_t thr, int *res);
        -
        Description
        + int thrd_join(thrd_t thr, int *res); + +

        Description

        The thrd_join function joins the thread identified by thr with the current thread by blocking until the other thread has terminated. If the parameter res is not a null pointer, @@ -18511,53 +19365,56 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. it stores the thread's result code in the integer pointed to by res. The termination of the other thread synchronizes with the completion of the thrd_join function. The thread identified by thr shall not have been previously detached or joined with another thread. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_join function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored.

        7.25.5.7 The thrd_sleep function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        void thrd_sleep(const xtime *xt);
        -
        Description
        + void thrd_sleep(const xtime *xt); + +

        Description

        The thrd_sleep function suspends execution of the calling thread until after the time specified by the xtime object pointed to by xt. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_sleep function returns no value.

        7.25.5.8 The thrd_yield function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        void thrd_yield(void);
        -
        Description
        + void thrd_yield(void); + +

        Description

        The thrd_yield function endeavors to permit other threads to run, even if the current thread would ordinarily continue to run. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The thrd_yield function returns no value.

        7.25.6 Thread-specific storage functions

        7.25.6.1 The tss_create function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <threads.h>
        -        int tss_create(tss_t *key, tss_dtor_t dtor);
        -
        Description
        + int tss_create(tss_t *key, tss_dtor_t dtor); + +

        Description

        The tss_create function creates a thread-specific storage pointer with destructor dtor, which may be null. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the tss_create function is successful, it sets the thread-specific storage pointed to by key to a value that uniquely identifies the newly created pointer and returns @@ -18565,46 +19422,49 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pointed to by key is set to an undefined value.

        7.25.6.2 The tss_delete function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void tss_delete(tss_t key);
        -
        Description
        + void tss_delete(tss_t key); + +

        Description

        The tss_delete function releases any resources used by the thread-specific storage identified by key. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The tss_delete function returns no value.

        7.25.6.3 The tss_get function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         void *tss_get(tss_t key);
        -
        Description
        + void *tss_get(tss_t key); + +

        Description

        The tss_get function returns the value for the current thread held in the thread-specific storage identified by key. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The tss_get function returns the value for the current thread if successful, or zero if unsuccessful.

        7.25.6.4 The tss_set function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int tss_set(tss_t key, void *val);
        -
        Description
        + int tss_set(tss_t key, void *val); + +

        Description

        The tss_set function sets the value for the current thread held in the thread-specific storage identified by key to val. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The tss_set function returns thrd_success on success or thrd_error if the request could not be honored. @@ -18612,16 +19472,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.25.7 Time functions

        7.25.7.1 The xtime_get function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <threads.h>
        -         int xtime_get(xtime *xt, int base);
        -
        Description
        + int xtime_get(xtime *xt, int base); + +

        Description

        The xtime_get function sets the xtime object pointed to by xt to hold the current time based on the time base base. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the xtime_get function is successful it returns the nonzero value base, which must be TIME_UTC; otherwise, it returns zero.306) @@ -18631,7 +19492,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        306) Although an xtime object describes times with nanosecond resolution, the actual resolution in an xtime object is system dependent. @@ -18649,19 +19510,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The macros defined are NULL (described in 7.19); and

        -         CLOCKS_PER_SEC
        + CLOCKS_PER_SEC + which expands to an expression with type clock_t (described below) that is the number per second of the value returned by the clock function.

        The types declared are size_t (described in 7.19);

        -         clock_t
        + clock_t + and
        -         time_t
        + time_t + which are arithmetic types capable of representing times; and
        -         struct tm
        + struct tm + which holds the components of a calendar time, called the broken-down time.

        The range and precision of times representable in clock_t and time_t are @@ -18677,7 +19542,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int tm_year; // years since 1900 int tm_wday; // days since Sunday -- [0, 6] int tm_yday; // days since January 1 -- [0, 365] - int tm_isdst; // Daylight Saving Time flag + int tm_isdst; // Daylight Saving Time flag + @@ -18685,22 +19551,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The value of tm_isdst is positive if Daylight Saving Time is in effect, zero if Daylight Saving Time is not in effect, and negative if the information is not available. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        307) The range [0, 60] for tm_sec allows for a positive leap second.

        7.26.2 Time manipulation functions

        7.26.2.1 The clock function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <time.h>
        -         clock_t clock(void);
        -
        Description
        + clock_t clock(void); + +

        Description

        The clock function determines the processor time used. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The clock function returns the implementation's best approximation to the processor time used by the program since the beginning of an implementation-defined era related @@ -18709,22 +19576,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the processor time used is not available or its value cannot be represented, the function returns the value (clock_t)(-1).308) -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        308) In order to measure the time spent in a program, the clock function should be called at the start of the program and its return value subtracted from the value returned by subsequent calls.

        7.26.2.2 The difftime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <time.h>
        -         double difftime(time_t time1, time_t time0);
        -
        Description
        + double difftime(time_t time1, time_t time0); + +

        Description

        The difftime function computes the difference between two calendar times: time1 - time0. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The difftime function returns the difference expressed in seconds as a double. @@ -18734,12 +19602,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.26.2.3 The mktime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <time.h>
        -         time_t mktime(struct tm *timeptr);
        -
        Description
        + time_t mktime(struct tm *timeptr); + +

        Description

        The mktime function converts the broken-down time, expressed as local time, in the structure pointed to by timeptr into a calendar time value with the same encoding as @@ -18750,7 +19619,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. set appropriately, and the other components are set to represent the specified calendar time, but with their values forced to the ranges indicated above; the final value of tm_mday is not set until tm_mon and tm_year are determined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mktime function returns the specified calendar time encoded as a value of type time_t. If the calendar time cannot be represented, the function returns the value @@ -18765,7 +19634,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. "Thursday", "Friday", "Saturday", "-unknown-" }; struct tm time_str; - /* ... */ + /* ... */ + @@ -18781,26 +19651,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. time_str.tm_isdst = -1; if (mktime(&time_str) == (time_t)(-1)) time_str.tm_wday = 7; - printf("%s\n", wday[time_str.tm_wday]); + printf("%s\n", wday[time_str.tm_wday]); + -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        309) Thus, a positive or zero value for tm_isdst causes the mktime function to presume initially that Daylight Saving Time, respectively, is or is not in effect for the specified time. A negative value causes it to attempt to determine whether Daylight Saving Time is in effect for the specified time.

        7.26.2.4 The time function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <time.h>
        -        time_t time(time_t *timer);
        -
        Description
        + time_t time(time_t *timer); + +

        Description

        The time function determines the current calendar time. The encoding of the value is unspecified. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The time function returns the implementation's best approximation to the current calendar time. The value (time_t)(-1) is returned if the calendar time is not @@ -18817,18 +19689,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. implementation shall behave as if no other library functions call these functions.

        7.26.3.1 The asctime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <time.h>
        -        char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr);
        -
        Description
        + char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr); + +

        Description

        The asctime function converts the broken-down time in the structure pointed to by timeptr into a string in the form

        -        Sun Sep 16 01:03:52 1973\n\0
        + Sun Sep 16 01:03:52 1973\n\0 + using the equivalent of the following algorithm. char *asctime(const struct tm *timeptr) { @@ -18847,75 +19721,80 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. timeptr->tm_mday, timeptr->tm_hour, timeptr->tm_min, timeptr->tm_sec, 1900 + timeptr->tm_year); - return result; + return result; + }

        If any of the fields of the broken-down time contain values that are outside their normal ranges,310) the behavior of the asctime function is undefined. Likewise, if the calculated year exceeds four digits or is less than the year 1000, the behavior is undefined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The asctime function returns a pointer to the string. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        310) See 7.26.1.

        7.26.3.2 The ctime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <time.h>
        -         char *ctime(const time_t *timer);
        -
        Description
        + char *ctime(const time_t *timer); + +

        Description

        The ctime function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer to local time in the form of a string. It is equivalent to

        -         asctime(localtime(timer))
        + asctime(localtime(timer)) + -
        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The ctime function returns the pointer returned by the asctime function with that broken-down time as argument.

        Forward references: the localtime function (7.26.3.4).

        7.26.3.3 The gmtime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <time.h>
        -        struct tm *gmtime(const time_t *timer);
        -
        Description
        + struct tm *gmtime(const time_t *timer); + +

        Description

        The gmtime function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer into a broken- down time, expressed as UTC. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The gmtime function returns a pointer to the broken-down time, or a null pointer if the specified time cannot be converted to UTC.

        7.26.3.4 The localtime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <time.h>
        -        struct tm *localtime(const time_t *timer);
        -
        Description
        + struct tm *localtime(const time_t *timer); + +

        Description

        The localtime function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer into a broken-down time, expressed as local time. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The localtime function returns a pointer to the broken-down time, or a null pointer if the specified time cannot be converted to local time.

        7.26.3.5 The strftime function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

        @@ -18923,8 +19802,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 size_t strftime(char * restrict s,
                      size_t maxsize,
                      const char * restrict format,
        -             const struct tm * restrict timeptr);
        -
        Description
        + const struct tm * restrict timeptr); + +

        Description

        The strftime function places characters into the array pointed to by s as controlled by the string pointed to by format. The format shall be a multibyte character sequence, @@ -18947,24 +19827,30 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. %B is replaced by the locale's full month name. [tm_mon] %c is replaced by the locale's appropriate date and time representation. [all specified

        -      in 7.26.1]
        + in 7.26.1] + %C is replaced by the year divided by 100 and truncated to an integer, as a decimal
        -      number (00-99). [tm_year]
        + number (00-99). [tm_year] + %d is replaced by the day of the month as a decimal number (01-31). [tm_mday] %D is equivalent to ''%m/%d/%y''. [tm_mon, tm_mday, tm_year] %e is replaced by the day of the month as a decimal number (1-31); a single digit is
        -      preceded by a space. [tm_mday]
        + preceded by a space. [tm_mday] + %F is equivalent to ''%Y-%m-%d'' (the ISO 8601 date format). [tm_year, tm_mon,
        -      tm_mday]
        + tm_mday] + %g is replaced by the last 2 digits of the week-based year (see below) as a decimal
        -      number (00-99). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday]
        + number (00-99). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday] + %G is replaced by the week-based year (see below) as a decimal number (e.g., 1997).
        -      [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday]
        + [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday] + %h is equivalent to ''%b''. [tm_mon] %H is replaced by the hour (24-hour clock) as a decimal number (00-23). [tm_hour] %I is replaced by the hour (12-hour clock) as a decimal number (01-12). [tm_hour] @@ -18975,42 +19861,52 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. %p is replaced by the locale's equivalent of the AM/PM designations associated with a
        -       12-hour clock. [tm_hour]
        + 12-hour clock. [tm_hour] + %r is replaced by the locale's 12-hour clock time. [tm_hour, tm_min, tm_sec] %R is equivalent to ''%H:%M''. [tm_hour, tm_min] %S is replaced by the second as a decimal number (00-60). [tm_sec] %t is replaced by a horizontal-tab character. %T is equivalent to ''%H:%M:%S'' (the ISO 8601 time format). [tm_hour, tm_min,
        -       tm_sec]
        + tm_sec] + %u is replaced by the ISO 8601 weekday as a decimal number (1-7), where Monday
        -       is 1. [tm_wday]
        + is 1. [tm_wday] + %U is replaced by the week number of the year (the first Sunday as the first day of week
        -       1) as a decimal number (00-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday]
        + 1) as a decimal number (00-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday] + %V is replaced by the ISO 8601 week number (see below) as a decimal number
        -       (01-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday]
        + (01-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday] + %w is replaced by the weekday as a decimal number (0-6), where Sunday is 0.
        -       [tm_wday]
        + [tm_wday] + %W is replaced by the week number of the year (the first Monday as the first day of
        -       week 1) as a decimal number (00-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday]
        + week 1) as a decimal number (00-53). [tm_year, tm_wday, tm_yday] + %x is replaced by the locale's appropriate date representation. [all specified in 7.26.1] %X is replaced by the locale's appropriate time representation. [all specified in 7.26.1] %y is replaced by the last 2 digits of the year as a decimal number (00-99).
        -       [tm_year]
        + [tm_year] + %Y is replaced by the year as a decimal number (e.g., 1997). [tm_year] %z is replaced by the offset from UTC in the ISO 8601 format ''-0430'' (meaning 4
                hours 30 minutes behind UTC, west of Greenwich), or by no characters if no time
        -       zone is determinable. [tm_isdst]
        + zone is determinable. [tm_isdst] + %Z is replaced by the locale's time zone name or abbreviation, or by no characters if no
        -       time zone is determinable. [tm_isdst]
        + time zone is determinable. [tm_isdst] + %% is replaced by %.

        Some conversion specifiers can be modified by the inclusion of an E or O modifier @@ -19019,47 +19915,58 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. %Ec is replaced by the locale's alternative date and time representation. %EC is replaced by the name of the base year (period) in the locale's alternative

        -     representation.
        + representation. + %Ex is replaced by the locale's alternative date representation. %EX is replaced by the locale's alternative time representation. %Ey is replaced by the offset from %EC (year only) in the locale's alternative
        -     representation.
        + representation. + %EY is replaced by the locale's full alternative year representation. %Od is replaced by the day of the month, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols
              (filled as needed with leading zeros, or with leading spaces if there is no alternative
        -     symbol for zero).
        + symbol for zero). + %Oe is replaced by the day of the month, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols
        -     (filled as needed with leading spaces).
        + (filled as needed with leading spaces). + %OH is replaced by the hour (24-hour clock), using the locale's alternative numeric
        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + %OI is replaced by the hour (12-hour clock), using the locale's alternative numeric
        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + %Om is replaced by the month, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols. %OM is replaced by the minutes, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols. %OS is replaced by the seconds, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols. %Ou is replaced by the ISO 8601 weekday as a number in the locale's alternative
        -     representation, where Monday is 1.
        + representation, where Monday is 1. + %OU is replaced by the week number, using the locale's alternative numeric symbols. %OV is replaced by the ISO 8601 week number, using the locale's alternative numeric
        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + %Ow is replaced by the weekday as a number, using the locale's alternative numeric
        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + %OW is replaced by the week number of the year, using the locale's alternative numeric
        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + %Oy is replaced by the last 2 digits of the year, using the locale's alternative numeric -

        -     symbols.
        + symbols. + +

        %g, %G, and %V give values according to the ISO 8601 week-based year. In this system, weeks begin on a Monday and week 1 of the year is the week that includes January 4th, which is also the week that includes the first Thursday of the year, and is also the first @@ -19085,7 +19992,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. %x equivalent to ''%m/%d/%y''. %X equivalent to %T. %Z implementation-defined. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the total number of resulting characters including the terminating null character is not more than maxsize, the strftime function returns the number of characters placed @@ -19101,11 +20008,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The types declared are mbstate_t (described in 7.29.1) and size_t (described in 7.19);

        -         char16_t
        + char16_t + which is an unsigned integer type used for 16-bit characters and is the same type as uint_least16_t (described in 7.20.1.2); and
        -         char32_t
        + char32_t + which is an unsigned integer type used for 32-bit characters and is the same type as uint_least32_t (also described in 7.20.1.2). @@ -19120,18 +20029,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. calls these functions with a null pointer for ps.
        7.27.1.1 The mbrtoc16 function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <uchar.h>
                  size_t mbrtoc16(char16_t * restrict pc16,
                       const char * restrict s, size_t n,
        -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
        -
        Description
        + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

        Description

        If s is a null pointer, the mbrtoc16 function is equivalent to the call:

        -                mbrtoc16(NULL, "", 1, ps)
        + mbrtoc16(NULL, "", 1, ps) + In this case, the values of the parameters pc16 and n are ignored.

        If s is not a null pointer, the mbrtoc16 function inspects at most n bytes beginning with @@ -19144,47 +20055,54 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. store successive wide characters without consuming any additional input until all the characters have been stored. If the corresponding wide character is the null wide character, the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mbrtoc16 function returns the first of the following that applies (given the current conversion state): 0 if the next n or fewer bytes complete the multibyte character that

        -                       corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored).
        + corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored). + between 1 and n inclusive if the next n or fewer bytes complete a valid multibyte
                             character (which is the value stored); the value returned is the number
        -                    of bytes that complete the multibyte character.
        + of bytes that complete the multibyte character. + (size_t)(-3) if the next character resulting from a previous call has been stored (no
        -              bytes from the input have been consumed by this call).
        + bytes from the input have been consumed by this call). + (size_t)(-2) if the next n bytes contribute to an incomplete (but potentially valid)
                       multibyte character, and all n bytes have been processed (no value is
        -              stored).311)
        + stored).311) + (size_t)(-1) if an encoding error occurs, in which case the next n or fewer bytes
                       do not contribute to a complete and valid multibyte character (no
                       value is stored); the value of the macro EILSEQ is stored in errno,
        -              and the conversion state is unspecified.
        + and the conversion state is unspecified. + -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        311) When n has at least the value of the MB_CUR_MAX macro, this case can only occur if s points at a sequence of redundant shift sequences (for implementations with state-dependent encodings).

        7.27.1.2 The c16rtomb function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <uchar.h>
                  size_t c16rtomb(char * restrict s, char16_t c16,
        -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
        -
        Description
        + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

        Description

        If s is a null pointer, the c16rtomb function is equivalent to the call

        -                 c16rtomb(buf, L'\0', ps)
        + c16rtomb(buf, L'\0', ps) + where buf is an internal buffer.

        If s is not a null pointer, the c16rtomb function determines the number of bytes needed @@ -19196,7 +20114,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array whose first element is pointed to by s. At most MB_CUR_MAX bytes are stored. If c16 is a null wide character, a null byte is stored, preceded by any shift sequence needed to restore the initial shift state; the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The c16rtomb function returns the number of bytes stored in the array object (including any shift sequences). When c16 is not a valid wide character, an encoding error occurs: @@ -19204,18 +20122,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. (size_t)(-1); the conversion state is unspecified.

        7.27.1.3 The mbrtoc32 function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <uchar.h>
                  size_t mbrtoc32(char32_t * restrict pc32,
                       const char * restrict s, size_t n,
        -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
        -
        Description
        + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

        Description

        If s is a null pointer, the mbrtoc32 function is equivalent to the call:

        -                 mbrtoc32(NULL, "", 1, ps)
        + mbrtoc32(NULL, "", 1, ps) + In this case, the values of the parameters pc32 and n are ignored.

        If s is not a null pointer, the mbrtoc32 function inspects at most n bytes beginning with @@ -19227,48 +20147,55 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. store successive wide characters without consuming any additional input until all the characters have been stored. If the corresponding wide character is the null wide character, the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The mbrtoc32 function returns the first of the following that applies (given the current conversion state): 0 if the next n or fewer bytes complete the multibyte character that

        -                      corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored).
        + corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored). + between 1 and n inclusive if the next n or fewer bytes complete a valid multibyte
                             character (which is the value stored); the value returned is the number
        -                    of bytes that complete the multibyte character.
        + of bytes that complete the multibyte character. + (size_t)(-3) if the next character resulting from a previous call has been stored (no
        -              bytes from the input have been consumed by this call).
        + bytes from the input have been consumed by this call). + (size_t)(-2) if the next n bytes contribute to an incomplete (but potentially valid)
                       multibyte character, and all n bytes have been processed (no value is
        -              stored).312)
        + stored).312) + (size_t)(-1) if an encoding error occurs, in which case the next n or fewer bytes
                       do not contribute to a complete and valid multibyte character (no
                       value is stored); the value of the macro EILSEQ is stored in errno,
        -              and the conversion state is unspecified.
        + and the conversion state is unspecified. + -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        312) When n has at least the value of the MB_CUR_MAX macro, this case can only occur if s points at a sequence of redundant shift sequences (for implementations with state-dependent encodings).

        7.27.1.4 The c32rtomb function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <uchar.h>
                  size_t c32rtomb(char * restrict s, char32_t c32,
        -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
        -
        Description
        + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

        Description

        If s is a null pointer, the c32rtomb function is equivalent to the call

        -                 c32rtomb(buf, L'\0', ps)
        + c32rtomb(buf, L'\0', ps) + where buf is an internal buffer.

        If s is not a null pointer, the c32rtomb function determines the number of bytes needed @@ -19277,7 +20204,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array whose first element is pointed to by s. At most MB_CUR_MAX bytes are stored. If c32 is a null wide character, a null byte is stored, preceded by any shift sequence needed to restore the initial shift state; the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The c32rtomb function returns the number of bytes stored in the array object (including any shift sequences). When c32 is not a valid wide character, an encoding error occurs: @@ -19298,24 +20225,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        The types declared are wchar_t and size_t (both described in 7.19);

        -           mbstate_t
        + mbstate_t + which is a complete object type other than an array type that can hold the conversion state information necessary to convert between sequences of multibyte characters and wide characters;
        -          wint_t
        + wint_t + which is an integer type unchanged by default argument promotions that can hold any value corresponding to members of the extended character set, as well as at least one value that does not correspond to any member of the extended character set (see WEOF below);314) and
        -          struct tm
        + struct tm + which is declared as an incomplete structure type (the contents are described in 7.26.1).

        The macros defined are NULL (described in 7.19); WCHAR_MIN and WCHAR_MAX (described in 7.20.3); and

        -          WEOF
        + WEOF + which expands to a constant expression of type wint_t whose value does not correspond to any member of the extended character set.315) It is accepted (and returned) by several functions in this subclause to indicate end-of-file, that is, no more input from a @@ -19340,7 +20271,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. subclause causes copying to take place between objects that overlap, the behavior is undefined. -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        313) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.12).

        314) wchar_t and wint_t can be the same integer type. @@ -19353,19 +20284,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The formatted wide character input/output functions shall behave as if there is a sequence point after the actions associated with each specifier.316) -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        316) The fwprintf functions perform writes to memory for the %n specifier.

        7.28.2.1 The fwprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int fwprintf(FILE * restrict stream,
        -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The fwprintf function writes output to the stream pointed to by stream, under control of the wide string pointed to by format that specifies how subsequent arguments @@ -19416,20 +20348,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The flag wide characters and their meanings are: - The result of the conversion is left-justified within the field. (It is right-justified if

        -          this flag is not specified.)
        + this flag is not specified.) + + The result of a signed conversion always begins with a plus or minus sign. (It
                   begins with a sign only when a negative value is converted if this flag is not
        -          specified.)318)
        + specified.)318) + space If the first wide character of a signed conversion is not a sign, or if a signed
                conversion results in no wide characters, a space is prefixed to the result. If the
        -       space and + flags both appear, the space flag is ignored.
        + space and + flags both appear, the space flag is ignored. + # The result is converted to an ''alternative form''. For o conversion, it increases
                   the precision, if and only if necessary, to force the first digit of the result to be a
                   zero (if the value and precision are both 0, a single 0 is printed). For x (or X)
        -          conversion, a nonzero result has 0x (or 0X) prefixed to it. For a, A, e, E, f, F, g,
        + conversion, a nonzero result has 0x (or 0X) prefixed to it. For a, A, e, E, f, F, g, + @@ -19438,15 +20374,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. contains a decimal-point wide character, even if no digits follow it. (Normally, a decimal-point wide character appears in the result of these conversions only if a digit follows it.) For g and G conversions, trailing zeros are not removed from the - result. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined. + result. For other conversions, the behavior is undefined. + 0 For d, i, o, u, x, X, a, A, e, E, f, F, g, and G conversions, leading zeros -

                    (following any indication of sign or base) are used to pad to the field width rather
                    than performing space padding, except when converting an infinity or NaN. If the
                    0 and - flags both appear, the 0 flag is ignored. For d, i, o, u, x, and X
                    conversions, if a precision is specified, the 0 flag is ignored. For other
        -           conversions, the behavior is undefined.
        + conversions, the behavior is undefined. + +

        The length modifiers and their meanings are: hh Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a

        @@ -19454,14 +20392,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                         been promoted according to the integer promotions, but its value shall be
                         converted to signed char or unsigned char before printing); or that
                         a following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a signed char
        -                argument.
        + argument. + h Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                         short int or unsigned short int argument (the argument will
                         have been promoted according to the integer promotions, but its value shall
                         be converted to short int or unsigned short int before printing);
                         or that a following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a short
        -                int argument.
        + int argument. + l (ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                         long int or unsigned long int argument; that a following n
        @@ -19469,30 +20409,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                         following c conversion specifier applies to a wint_t argument; that a
                         following s conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a wchar_t
                         argument; or has no effect on a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion
        -                specifier.
        + specifier. + ll (ell-ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                       long long int or unsigned long long int argument; or that a
                       following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a long long int
        -              argument.
        + argument. + j Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to
                         an intmax_t or uintmax_t argument; or that a following n conversion
        -                specifier applies to a pointer to an intmax_t argument.
        + specifier applies to a pointer to an intmax_t argument. + z Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                       size_t or the corresponding signed integer type argument; or that a
                       following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a signed integer type
        -              corresponding to size_t argument.
        + corresponding to size_t argument. + t Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, or X conversion specifier applies to a
                       ptrdiff_t or the corresponding unsigned integer type argument; or that a
                       following n conversion specifier applies to a pointer to a ptrdiff_t
        -              argument.
        + argument. + L Specifies that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier
        -              applies to a long double argument.
        + applies to a long double argument. + If a length modifier appears with any conversion specifier other than as specified above, the behavior is undefined.

        @@ -19502,7 +20448,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. precision specifies the minimum number of digits to appear; if the value being converted can be represented in fewer digits, it is expanded with leading zeros. The default precision is 1. The result of converting a zero - value with a precision of zero is no wide characters. + value with a precision of zero is no wide characters. + o,u,x,X The unsigned int argument is converted to unsigned octal (o), unsigned

                  decimal (u), or unsigned hexadecimal notation (x or X) in the style dddd; the
        @@ -19510,7 +20457,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  conversion. The precision specifies the minimum number of digits to appear;
                  if the value being converted can be represented in fewer digits, it is expanded
                  with leading zeros. The default precision is 1. The result of converting a
        -         zero value with a precision of zero is no wide characters.
        + zero value with a precision of zero is no wide characters. + f,F A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted to
        @@ -19526,7 +20474,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      [-]nan or [-]nan(n-wchar-sequence) -- which style, and the meaning of
                      any n-wchar-sequence, is implementation-defined. The F conversion
                      specifier produces INF, INFINITY, or NAN instead of inf, infinity, or
        -              nan, respectively.319)
        + nan, respectively.319) + e,E A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in the
                       style [-]d.ddd e(+-)dd, where there is one digit (which is nonzero if the
        @@ -19539,7 +20488,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       and only as many more digits as necessary to represent the exponent. If the
                       value is zero, the exponent is zero.
                       A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style
        -              of an f or F conversion specifier.
        + of an f or F conversion specifier. + g,G A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in
                       style f or e (or in style F or E in the case of a G conversion specifier),
        @@ -19553,14 +20503,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       fractional portion of the result and the decimal-point wide character is
                       removed if there is no fractional portion remaining.
                       A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style
        -              of an f or F conversion specifier.
        + of an f or F conversion specifier. + a,A A double argument representing a floating-point number is converted in the
                       style [-]0xh.hhhh p(+-)d, where there is one hexadecimal digit (which is
                       nonzero if the argument is a normalized floating-point number and is
                       otherwise unspecified) before the decimal-point wide character320) and the
                       number of hexadecimal digits after it is equal to the precision; if the precision
        -              is missing and FLT_RADIX is a power of 2, then the precision is sufficient
        + is missing and FLT_RADIX is a power of 2, then the precision is sufficient + @@ -19576,12 +20528,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. represent the decimal exponent of 2. If the value is zero, the exponent is zero. A double argument representing an infinity or NaN is converted in the style - of an f or F conversion specifier. + of an f or F conversion specifier. + c If no l length modifier is present, the int argument is converted to a wide
                       character as if by calling btowc and the resulting wide character is written.
                       If an l length modifier is present, the wint_t argument is converted to
        -              wchar_t and written.
        + wchar_t and written. + s If no l length modifier is present, the argument shall be a pointer to the initial
                       element of a character array containing a multibyte character sequence
        @@ -19598,24 +20552,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       written up to (but not including) a terminating null wide character. If the
                       precision is specified, no more than that many wide characters are written. If
                       the precision is not specified or is greater than the size of the array, the array
        -              shall contain a null wide character.
        + shall contain a null wide character. + p The argument shall be a pointer to void. The value of the pointer is
        -              converted to a sequence of printing wide characters, in an implementation-
        + converted to a sequence of printing wide characters, in an implementation- +
        -                defined manner.
        + defined manner. + n The argument shall be a pointer to signed integer into which is written the
                         number of wide characters written to the output stream so far by this call to
                         fwprintf. No argument is converted, but one is consumed. If the
                         conversion specification includes any flags, a field width, or a precision, the
        -                behavior is undefined.
        + behavior is undefined. + % A % wide character is written. No argument is converted. The complete -

        -                conversion specification shall be %%.
        + conversion specification shall be %%. + +

        If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is undefined.322) If any argument is not the correct type for the corresponding conversion specification, the behavior is undefined. @@ -19626,7 +20585,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        For a and A conversions, if FLT_RADIX is a power of 2, the value is correctly rounded to a hexadecimal floating number with the given precision. -

        Recommended practice
        +

        Recommended practice

        For a and A conversions, if FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2 and the result is not exactly representable in the given precision, the result should be one of the two adjacent numbers @@ -19641,13 +20600,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. adjacent decimal strings L < U, both having DECIMAL_DIG significant digits; the value of the resultant decimal string D should satisfy L <= D <= U, with the extra stipulation that the error should have a correct sign for the current rounding direction. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fwprintf function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred. -

        Environmental limits
        +

        Environmental limits

        The number of wide characters that can be produced by any single conversion shall be at least 4095. @@ -19663,12 +20622,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int day, hour, min; fwprintf(stdout, L"%ls, %ls %d, %.2d:%.2d\n", weekday, month, day, hour, min); - fwprintf(stdout, L"pi = %.5f\n", 4 * atan(1.0)); + fwprintf(stdout, L"pi = %.5f\n", 4 * atan(1.0)); +

        Forward references: the btowc function (7.28.6.1.1), the mbrtowc function (7.28.6.3.2). -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        317) Note that 0 is taken as a flag, not as the beginning of a field width.

        318) The results of all floating conversions of a negative zero, and of negative values that round to zero, @@ -19693,14 +20653,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.2.2 The fwscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int fwscanf(FILE * restrict stream,
        -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The fwscanf function reads input from the stream pointed to by stream, under control of the wide string pointed to by format that specifies the admissible input @@ -19769,35 +20730,43 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The length modifiers and their meanings are: hh Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies

        -              to an argument with type pointer to signed char or unsigned char.
        + to an argument with type pointer to signed char or unsigned char. + h Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                       to an argument with type pointer to short int or unsigned short
        -              int.
        + int. + l (ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                       to an argument with type pointer to long int or unsigned long
                       int; that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier applies to
                       an argument with type pointer to double; or that a following c, s, or [
        -              conversion specifier applies to an argument with type pointer to wchar_t.
        + conversion specifier applies to an argument with type pointer to wchar_t. + ll (ell-ell) Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                       to an argument with type pointer to long long int or unsigned
        -              long long int.
        + long long int. + j Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
        -              to an argument with type pointer to intmax_t or uintmax_t.
        + to an argument with type pointer to intmax_t or uintmax_t. + z Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                       to an argument with type pointer to size_t or the corresponding signed
        -              integer type.
        + integer type. + t Specifies that a following d, i, o, u, x, X, or n conversion specifier applies
                       to an argument with type pointer to ptrdiff_t or the corresponding
        -              unsigned integer type.
        + unsigned integer type. + L Specifies that a following a, A, e, E, f, F, g, or G conversion specifier
        -              applies to an argument with type pointer to long double.
        + applies to an argument with type pointer to long double. + If a length modifier appears with any conversion specifier other than as specified above, the behavior is undefined.

        @@ -19806,32 +20775,38 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                      expected for the subject sequence of the wcstol function with the value 10
                      for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
        -             signed integer.
        + signed integer. + i Matches an optionally signed integer, whose format is the same as expected
                      for the subject sequence of the wcstol function with the value 0 for the
                      base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to signed
        -           integer.
        + integer. + o Matches an optionally signed octal integer, whose format is the same as
                    expected for the subject sequence of the wcstoul function with the value 8
                    for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
        -           unsigned integer.
        + unsigned integer. + u Matches an optionally signed decimal integer, whose format is the same as
                    expected for the subject sequence of the wcstoul function with the value 10
                    for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
        -           unsigned integer.
        + unsigned integer. + x Matches an optionally signed hexadecimal integer, whose format is the same
                    as expected for the subject sequence of the wcstoul function with the value
                    16 for the base argument. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
        -           unsigned integer.
        + unsigned integer. + a,e,f,g Matches an optionally signed floating-point number, infinity, or NaN, whose
                  format is the same as expected for the subject sequence of the wcstod
        -         function. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to floating.
        + function. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to floating. + c Matches a sequence of wide characters of exactly the number specified by the
                    field width (1 if no field width is present in the directive).
        @@ -19843,7 +20818,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    accept the sequence. No null character is added.
                    If an l length modifier is present, the corresponding argument shall be a
                    pointer to the initial element of an array of wchar_t large enough to accept
        -           the sequence. No null wide character is added.
        + the sequence. No null wide character is added. + s Matches a sequence of non-white-space wide characters.
        @@ -19857,7 +20833,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    If an l length modifier is present, the corresponding argument shall be a
                    pointer to the initial element of an array of wchar_t large enough to accept
                      the sequence and the terminating null wide character, which will be added
        -             automatically.
        + automatically. + [ Matches a nonempty sequence of wide characters from a set of expected
                      characters (the scanset).
        @@ -19883,7 +20860,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      the specification; otherwise the first following right bracket wide character is
                      the one that ends the specification. If a - wide character is in the scanlist and
                      is not the first, nor the second where the first wide character is a ^, nor the
        -             last character, the behavior is implementation-defined.
        + last character, the behavior is implementation-defined. + p Matches an implementation-defined set of sequences, which should be the
                      same as the set of sequences that may be produced by the %p conversion of
        @@ -19891,7 +20869,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      pointer to void. The input item is converted to a pointer value in an
                      implementation-defined manner. If the input item is a value converted earlier
                      during the same program execution, the pointer that results shall compare
        -             equal to that value; otherwise the behavior of the %p conversion is undefined.
        + equal to that value; otherwise the behavior of the %p conversion is undefined. + n No input is consumed. The corresponding argument shall be a pointer to
        @@ -19901,11 +20880,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      completion of execution of the fwscanf function. No argument is
                         converted, but one is consumed. If the conversion specification includes an
                         assignment-suppressing wide character or a field width, the behavior is
        -                undefined.
        + undefined. + % Matches a single % wide character; no conversion or assignment occurs. The -

        -                complete conversion specification shall be %%.
        + complete conversion specification shall be %%. + +

        If a conversion specification is invalid, the behavior is undefined.326)

        The conversion specifiers A, E, F, G, and X are also valid and behave the same as, @@ -19914,7 +20895,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Trailing white space (including new-line wide characters) is left unread unless matched by a directive. The success of literal matches and suppressed assignments is not directly determinable other than via the %n directive. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fwscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the function returns the @@ -19927,10 +20908,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <wchar.h> /* ... */ int n, i; float x; wchar_t name[50]; - n = fwscanf(stdin, L"%d%f%ls", &i, &x, name); + n = fwscanf(stdin, L"%d%f%ls", &i, &x, name); + with the input line:

        -          25 54.32E-1 thompson
        + 25 54.32E-1 thompson + will assign to n the value 3, to i the value 25, to x the value 5.432, and to name the sequence thompson\0. @@ -19941,10 +20924,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <wchar.h> /* ... */ int i; float x; double y; - fwscanf(stdin, L"%2d%f%*d %lf", &i, &x, &y); + fwscanf(stdin, L"%2d%f%*d %lf", &i, &x, &y); + with input:
        -          56789 0123 56a72
        + 56789 0123 56a72 + will assign to i the value 56 and to x the value 789.0, will skip past 0123, and will assign to y the value 56.0. The next wide character read from the input stream will be a. @@ -19954,7 +20939,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. wcstol, wcstoll, wcstoul, and wcstoull functions (7.28.4.1.2), the wcrtomb function (7.28.6.3.3). -
        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        324) These white-space wide characters are not counted against a specified field width.

        325) fwscanf pushes back at most one input wide character onto the input stream. Therefore, some @@ -19964,39 +20949,41 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.2.3 The swprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int swprintf(wchar_t * restrict s,
                       size_t n,
        -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The swprintf function is equivalent to fwprintf, except that the argument s specifies an array of wide characters into which the generated output is to be written, rather than written to a stream. No more than n wide characters are written, including a terminating null wide character, which is always added (unless n is zero). -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The swprintf function returns the number of wide characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null wide character, or a negative value if an encoding error occurred or if n or more wide characters were requested to be written.

        7.28.2.4 The swscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int swscanf(const wchar_t * restrict s,
        -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The swscanf function is equivalent to fwscanf, except that the argument s specifies a wide string from which the input is to be obtained, rather than from a stream. Reaching the end of the wide string is equivalent to encountering end-of-file for the fwscanf function. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The swscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the swscanf function @@ -20005,7 +20992,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.2.5 The vfwprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdarg.h>
        @@ -20013,14 +21000,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                 #include <wchar.h>
                 int vfwprintf(FILE * restrict stream,
                      const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -             va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vfwprintf function is equivalent to fwprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfwprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vfwprintf function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred. @@ -20040,20 +21028,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. // print out remainder of message vfwprintf(stderr, format, args); va_end(args); - } + } + -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        327) As the functions vfwprintf, vswprintf, vfwscanf, vwprintf, vwscanf, and vswscanf invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

        7.28.2.6 The vfwscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdarg.h>
        @@ -20061,14 +21050,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int vfwscanf(FILE * restrict stream,
                       const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -              va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vfwscanf function is equivalent to fwscanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfwscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vfwscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vfwscanf function @@ -20076,7 +21066,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

        7.28.2.7 The vswprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdarg.h>
        @@ -20084,14 +21074,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  int vswprintf(wchar_t * restrict s,
                       size_t n,
                       const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -              va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vswprintf function is equivalent to swprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vswprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vswprintf function returns the number of wide characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null wide character, or a negative value if an encoding error @@ -20099,21 +21090,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.2.8 The vswscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdarg.h>
                 #include <wchar.h>
                 int vswscanf(const wchar_t * restrict s,
                      const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -             va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vswscanf function is equivalent to swscanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vswscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vswscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vswscanf function @@ -20121,40 +21113,42 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

        7.28.2.9 The vwprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                 #include <stdarg.h>
                 #include <wchar.h>
                 int vwprintf(const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -             va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vwprintf function is equivalent to wprintf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vwprintf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vwprintf function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred.

        7.28.2.10 The vwscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdarg.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int vwscanf(const wchar_t * restrict format,
        -              va_list arg);
        -
        Description
        + va_list arg); + +

        Description

        The vwscanf function is equivalent to wscanf, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vwscanf function does not invoke the va_end macro.327) -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The vwscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the vwscanf function @@ -20162,32 +21156,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

        7.28.2.11 The wprintf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         int wprintf(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + int wprintf(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The wprintf function is equivalent to fwprintf with the argument stdout interposed before the arguments to wprintf. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The wprintf function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output or encoding error occurred.

        7.28.2.12 The wscanf function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         int wscanf(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
        -
        Description
        + int wscanf(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + +

        Description

        The wscanf function is equivalent to fwscanf with the argument stdin interposed before the arguments to wscanf. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The wscanf function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before the first conversion (if any) has completed. Otherwise, the wscanf function @@ -20197,19 +21193,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.3 Wide character input/output functions

        7.28.3.1 The fgetwc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t fgetwc(FILE *stream);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t fgetwc(FILE *stream); + +

        Description

        If the end-of-file indicator for the input stream pointed to by stream is not set and a next wide character is present, the fgetwc function obtains that wide character as a wchar_t converted to a wint_t and advances the associated file position indicator for the stream (if defined). -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        If the end-of-file indicator for the stream is set, or if the stream is at end-of-file, the end- of-file indicator for the stream is set and the fgetwc function returns WEOF. Otherwise, @@ -20218,20 +21215,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. function returns WEOF. If an encoding error occurs (including too few bytes), the value of the macro EILSEQ is stored in errno and the fgetwc function returns WEOF.328) -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        328) An end-of-file and a read error can be distinguished by use of the feof and ferror functions. Also, errno will be set to EILSEQ by input/output functions only if an encoding error occurs.

        7.28.3.2 The fgetws function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  wchar_t *fgetws(wchar_t * restrict s,
        -              int n, FILE * restrict stream);
        -
        Description
        + int n, FILE * restrict stream); + +

        Description

        The fgetws function reads at most one less than the number of wide characters specified by n from the stream pointed to by stream into the array pointed to by s. No @@ -20241,7 +21239,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. additional wide characters are read after a new-line wide character (which is retained) or after end-of-file. A null wide character is written immediately after the last wide character read into the array. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fgetws function returns s if successful. If end-of-file is encountered and no characters have been read into the array, the contents of the array remain unchanged and a @@ -20249,139 +21247,147 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. contents are indeterminate and a null pointer is returned.

        7.28.3.3 The fputwc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t fputwc(wchar_t c, FILE *stream);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t fputwc(wchar_t c, FILE *stream); + +

        Description

        The fputwc function writes the wide character specified by c to the output stream pointed to by stream, at the position indicated by the associated file position indicator for the stream (if defined), and advances the indicator appropriately. If the file cannot support positioning requests, or if the stream was opened with append mode, the character is appended to the output stream. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fputwc function returns the wide character written. If a write error occurs, the error indicator for the stream is set and fputwc returns WEOF. If an encoding error occurs, the value of the macro EILSEQ is stored in errno and fputwc returns WEOF.

        7.28.3.4 The fputws function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
                  int fputws(const wchar_t * restrict s,
        -              FILE * restrict stream);
        -
        Description
        + FILE * restrict stream); + +

        Description

        The fputws function writes the wide string pointed to by s to the stream pointed to by stream. The terminating null wide character is not written. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fputws function returns EOF if a write or encoding error occurs; otherwise, it returns a nonnegative value.

        7.28.3.5 The fwide function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         int fwide(FILE *stream, int mode);
        -
        Description
        + int fwide(FILE *stream, int mode); + +

        Description

        The fwide function determines the orientation of the stream pointed to by stream. If mode is greater than zero, the function first attempts to make the stream wide oriented. If mode is less than zero, the function first attempts to make the stream byte oriented.329) Otherwise, mode is zero and the function does not alter the orientation of the stream. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The fwide function returns a value greater than zero if, after the call, the stream has wide orientation, a value less than zero if the stream has byte orientation, or zero if the stream has no orientation. -

        footnotes
        +

        Footnotes

        329) If the orientation of the stream has already been determined, fwide does not change it.

        7.28.3.6 The getwc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t getwc(FILE *stream);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t getwc(FILE *stream); + +

        Description

        The getwc function is equivalent to fgetwc, except that if it is implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so the argument should never be an expression with side effects. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The getwc function returns the next wide character from the input stream pointed to by stream, or WEOF.

        7.28.3.7 The getwchar function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t getwchar(void);
        + wint_t getwchar(void); + -
        Description
        +

        Description

        The getwchar function is equivalent to getwc with the argument stdin. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The getwchar function returns the next wide character from the input stream pointed to by stdin, or WEOF.

        7.28.3.8 The putwc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t putwc(wchar_t c, FILE *stream);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t putwc(wchar_t c, FILE *stream); + +

        Description

        The putwc function is equivalent to fputwc, except that if it is implemented as a macro, it may evaluate stream more than once, so that argument should never be an expression with side effects. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The putwc function returns the wide character written, or WEOF.

        7.28.3.9 The putwchar function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t putwchar(wchar_t c);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t putwchar(wchar_t c); + +

        Description

        The putwchar function is equivalent to putwc with the second argument stdout. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The putwchar function returns the character written, or WEOF.

        7.28.3.10 The ungetwc function
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <stdio.h>
                  #include <wchar.h>
        -         wint_t ungetwc(wint_t c, FILE *stream);
        -
        Description
        + wint_t ungetwc(wint_t c, FILE *stream); + +

        Description

        The ungetwc function pushes the wide character specified by c back onto the input stream pointed to by stream. Pushed-back wide characters will be returned by @@ -20406,7 +21412,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. back. For a text or binary stream, the value of its file position indicator after a successful call to the ungetwc function is unspecified until all pushed-back wide characters are read or discarded. -

        Returns
        +

        Returns

        The ungetwc function returns the wide character pushed back, or WEOF if the operation fails. @@ -20430,7 +21436,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

        7.28.4.1 Wide string numeric conversion functions
        7.28.4.1.1 The wcstod, wcstof, and wcstold functions
        -
        Synopsis
        +

        Synopsis

                  #include <wchar.h>
        @@ -20439,8 +21445,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  float wcstof(const wchar_t * restrict nptr,
                       wchar_t ** restrict endptr);
                  long double wcstold(const wchar_t * restrict nptr,
        -              wchar_t ** restrict endptr);
        -
        Description
        + wchar_t ** restrict endptr); + +

        Description

        The wcstod, wcstof, and wcstold functions convert the initial portion of the wide string pointed to by nptr to double, float, and long double representation, @@ -20468,7 +21475,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. digit nondigit n-wchar-sequence digit - n-wchar-sequence nondigit + n-wchar-sequence nondigit +

      The subject sequence is defined as the longest initial subsequence of the input wide string, starting with the first non-white-space wide character, that is of the expected form. @@ -20502,7 +21510,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the object pointed to by endptr, provided that endptr is not a null pointer. -
      Recommended practice
      +

      Recommended practice

      If the subject sequence has the hexadecimal form, FLT_RADIX is not a power of 2, and the result is not exactly representable, the result should be one of the two numbers in the @@ -20523,7 +21531,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. correctly rounding L and U according to the current rounding direction, with the extra stipulation that the error with respect to D should have a correct sign for the current rounding direction.332) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The functions return the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value overflows and default rounding is in effect (7.12.1), @@ -20538,7 +21546,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      330) It is unspecified whether a minus-signed sequence is converted to a negative number directly or by negating the value resulting from converting the corresponding unsigned sequence (see F.5); the two methods may yield different results if rounding is toward positive or negative infinity. In either case, @@ -20552,7 +21560,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.4.1.2 The wcstol, wcstoll, wcstoul, and wcstoull functions
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      @@ -20571,8 +21579,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               unsigned long long int wcstoull(
                    const wchar_t * restrict nptr,
                    wchar_t ** restrict endptr,
      -             int base);
      -
      Description
      + int base); + +

      Description

      The wcstol, wcstoll, wcstoul, and wcstoull functions convert the initial portion of the wide string pointed to by nptr to long int, long long int, @@ -20617,7 +21626,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the subject sequence is empty or does not have the expected form, no conversion is performed; the value of nptr is stored in the object pointed to by endptr, provided that endptr is not a null pointer. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcstol, wcstoll, wcstoul, and wcstoull functions return the converted value, if any. If no conversion could be performed, zero is returned. If the correct value @@ -20628,30 +21637,32 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.4.2 Wide string copying functions
      7.28.4.2.1 The wcscpy function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                wchar_t *wcscpy(wchar_t * restrict s1,
      -              const wchar_t * restrict s2);
      -
      Description
      + const wchar_t * restrict s2); + +

      Description

      The wcscpy function copies the wide string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null wide character) into the array pointed to by s1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcscpy function returns the value of s1.

      7.28.4.2.2 The wcsncpy function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <wchar.h>
                 wchar_t *wcsncpy(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                      const wchar_t * restrict s2,
      -               size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wcsncpy function copies not more than n wide characters (those that follow a null wide character are not copied) from the array pointed to by s2 to the array pointed to by @@ -20660,28 +21671,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the array pointed to by s2 is a wide string that is shorter than n wide characters, null wide characters are appended to the copy in the array pointed to by s1, until n wide characters in all have been written. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsncpy function returns the value of s1. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      333) Thus, if there is no null wide character in the first n wide characters of the array pointed to by s2, the result will not be null-terminated.

      7.28.4.2.3 The wmemcpy function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <wchar.h>
                 wchar_t *wmemcpy(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                      const wchar_t * restrict s2,
      -               size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wmemcpy function copies n wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 to the object pointed to by s1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wmemcpy function returns the value of s1. @@ -20691,50 +21703,53 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.4.2.4 The wmemmove function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                wchar_t *wmemmove(wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2,
      -              size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wmemmove function copies n wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 to the object pointed to by s1. Copying takes place as if the n wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 are first copied into a temporary array of n wide characters that does not overlap the objects pointed to by s1 or s2, and then the n wide characters from the temporary array are copied into the object pointed to by s1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wmemmove function returns the value of s1.

      7.28.4.3 Wide string concatenation functions
      7.28.4.3.1 The wcscat function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                wchar_t *wcscat(wchar_t * restrict s1,
      -              const wchar_t * restrict s2);
      -
      Description
      + const wchar_t * restrict s2); + +

      Description

      The wcscat function appends a copy of the wide string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null wide character) to the end of the wide string pointed to by s1. The initial wide character of s2 overwrites the null wide character at the end of s1. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcscat function returns the value of s1.

      7.28.4.3.2 The wcsncat function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                wchar_t *wcsncat(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                     const wchar_t * restrict s2,
      -              size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wcsncat function appends not more than n wide characters (a null wide character and those that follow it are not appended) from the array pointed to by s2 to the end of @@ -20742,11 +21757,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the wide string pointed to by s1. The initial wide character of s2 overwrites the null wide character at the end of s1. A terminating null wide character is always appended to the result.334) -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsncat function returns the value of s1. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      334) Thus, the maximum number of wide characters that can end up in the array pointed to by s1 is wcslen(s1)+n+1. @@ -20758,33 +21773,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. by wchar_t.

      7.28.4.4.1 The wcscmp function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
      -         int wcscmp(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + int wcscmp(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcscmp function compares the wide string pointed to by s1 to the wide string pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcscmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the wide string pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the wide string pointed to by s2.

      7.28.4.4.2 The wcscoll function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
      -         int wcscoll(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + int wcscoll(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcscoll function compares the wide string pointed to by s1 to the wide string pointed to by s2, both interpreted as appropriate to the LC_COLLATE category of the current locale. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcscoll function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the wide string pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the @@ -20795,32 +21812,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. locale.

      7.28.4.4.3 The wcsncmp function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                int wcsncmp(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2,
      -              size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wcsncmp function compares not more than n wide characters (those that follow a null wide character are not compared) from the array pointed to by s1 to the array pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsncmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the possibly null-terminated array pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the possibly null-terminated array pointed to by s2.

      7.28.4.4.4 The wcsxfrm function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                size_t wcsxfrm(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                     const wchar_t * restrict s2,
      -              size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wcsxfrm function transforms the wide string pointed to by s2 and places the resulting wide string into the array pointed to by s1. The transformation is such that if @@ -20829,7 +21848,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. applied to the same two original wide strings. No more than n wide characters are placed into the resulting array pointed to by s1, including the terminating null wide character. If n is zero, s1 is permitted to be a null pointer. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsxfrm function returns the length of the transformed wide string (not including the terminating null wide character). If the value returned is n or greater, the contents of @@ -20839,21 +21858,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. transformation of the wide string pointed to by s:

      -        1 + wcsxfrm(NULL, s, 0)
      + 1 + wcsxfrm(NULL, s, 0) +
      7.28.4.4.5 The wmemcmp function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
               int wmemcmp(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2,
      -             size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wmemcmp function compares the first n wide characters of the object pointed to by s1 to the first n wide characters of the object pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wmemcmp function returns an integer greater than, equal to, or less than zero, accordingly as the object pointed to by s1 is greater than, equal to, or less than the object @@ -20862,108 +21883,115 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.4.5 Wide string search functions
      7.28.4.5.1 The wcschr function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        wchar_t *wcschr(const wchar_t *s, wchar_t c);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t *wcschr(const wchar_t *s, wchar_t c); + +

      Description

      The wcschr function locates the first occurrence of c in the wide string pointed to by s. The terminating null wide character is considered to be part of the wide string. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcschr function returns a pointer to the located wide character, or a null pointer if the wide character does not occur in the wide string.

      7.28.4.5.2 The wcscspn function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        size_t wcscspn(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + size_t wcscspn(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcscspn function computes the length of the maximum initial segment of the wide string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of wide characters not from the wide string pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcscspn function returns the length of the segment.

      7.28.4.5.3 The wcspbrk function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
      -         wchar_t *wcspbrk(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t *wcspbrk(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcspbrk function locates the first occurrence in the wide string pointed to by s1 of any wide character from the wide string pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcspbrk function returns a pointer to the wide character in s1, or a null pointer if no wide character from s2 occurs in s1.

      7.28.4.5.4 The wcsrchr function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
      -         wchar_t *wcsrchr(const wchar_t *s, wchar_t c);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t *wcsrchr(const wchar_t *s, wchar_t c); + +

      Description

      The wcsrchr function locates the last occurrence of c in the wide string pointed to by s. The terminating null wide character is considered to be part of the wide string. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsrchr function returns a pointer to the wide character, or a null pointer if c does not occur in the wide string.

      7.28.4.5.5 The wcsspn function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
      -         size_t wcsspn(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + size_t wcsspn(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcsspn function computes the length of the maximum initial segment of the wide string pointed to by s1 which consists entirely of wide characters from the wide string pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsspn function returns the length of the segment.

      7.28.4.5.6 The wcsstr function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        wchar_t *wcsstr(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t *wcsstr(const wchar_t *s1, const wchar_t *s2); + +

      Description

      The wcsstr function locates the first occurrence in the wide string pointed to by s1 of the sequence of wide characters (excluding the terminating null wide character) in the wide string pointed to by s2. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcsstr function returns a pointer to the located wide string, or a null pointer if the wide string is not found. If s2 points to a wide string with zero length, the function returns s1.

      7.28.4.5.7 The wcstok function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
               wchar_t *wcstok(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                    const wchar_t * restrict s2,
      -             wchar_t ** restrict ptr);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t ** restrict ptr); + +

      Description

      A sequence of calls to the wcstok function breaks the wide string pointed to by s1 into a sequence of tokens, each of which is delimited by a wide character from the wide string @@ -20994,7 +22022,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. by ptr so that subsequent calls, with a null pointer for s1 and the unmodified pointer value for ptr, shall start searching just past the element overwritten by a null wide character (if any). -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcstok function returns a pointer to the first wide character of a token, or a null pointer if there is no token. @@ -21009,21 +22037,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. t = wcstok(NULL, L",", &ptr1); // t points to the token L"??b" t = wcstok(str2, L" \t", &ptr2); // t is a null pointer t = wcstok(NULL, L"#,", &ptr1); // t points to the token L"c" - t = wcstok(NULL, L"?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer + t = wcstok(NULL, L"?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer +

      7.28.4.5.8 The wmemchr function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                wchar_t *wmemchr(const wchar_t *s, wchar_t c,
      -              size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wmemchr function locates the first occurrence of c in the initial n wide characters of the object pointed to by s. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wmemchr function returns a pointer to the located wide character, or a null pointer if the wide character does not occur in the object. @@ -21032,37 +22062,39 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.4.6 Miscellaneous functions
      7.28.4.6.1 The wcslen function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        size_t wcslen(const wchar_t *s);
      -
      Description
      + size_t wcslen(const wchar_t *s); + +

      Description

      The wcslen function computes the length of the wide string pointed to by s. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcslen function returns the number of wide characters that precede the terminating null wide character.

      7.28.4.6.2 The wmemset function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        wchar_t *wmemset(wchar_t *s, wchar_t c, size_t n);
      -
      Description
      + wchar_t *wmemset(wchar_t *s, wchar_t c, size_t n); + +

      Description

      The wmemset function copies the value of c into each of the first n wide characters of the object pointed to by s. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wmemset function returns the value of s.

      7.28.5 Wide character time conversion functions

      7.28.5.1 The wcsftime function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <time.h>
      @@ -21070,8 +22102,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               size_t wcsftime(wchar_t * restrict s,
                    size_t maxsize,
                    const wchar_t * restrict format,
      -             const struct tm * restrict timeptr);
      -
      Description
      + const struct tm * restrict timeptr); + +

      Description

      The wcsftime function is equivalent to the strftime function, except that:

        @@ -21083,7 +22116,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. corresponding sequences of wide characters.
      • The return value indicates the number of wide characters.
      -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If the total number of resulting wide characters including the terminating null wide character is not more than maxsize, the wcsftime function returns the number of @@ -21122,7 +22155,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      335) Thus, a particular mbstate_t object can be used, for example, with both the mbrtowc and mbsrtowcs functions as long as they are used to step sequentially through the same multibyte character string. @@ -21131,33 +22164,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.6.1 Single-byte/wide character conversion functions
      7.28.6.1.1 The btowc function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>                                                                        *
      -        wint_t btowc(int c);
      -
      Description
      + wint_t btowc(int c); + +

      Description

      The btowc function determines whether c constitutes a valid single-byte character in the initial shift state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The btowc function returns WEOF if c has the value EOF or if (unsigned char)c does not constitute a valid single-byte character in the initial shift state. Otherwise, it returns the wide character representation of that character.

      7.28.6.1.2 The wctob function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>                                                                        *
      -        int wctob(wint_t c);
      -
      Description
      + int wctob(wint_t c); + +

      Description

      The wctob function determines whether c corresponds to a member of the extended character set whose multibyte character representation is a single byte when in the initial shift state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wctob function returns EOF if c does not correspond to a multibyte character with length one in the initial shift state. Otherwise, it returns the single-byte representation of @@ -21166,17 +22201,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.6.2 Conversion state functions
      7.28.6.2.1 The mbsinit function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
      -        int mbsinit(const mbstate_t *ps);
      -
      Description
      + int mbsinit(const mbstate_t *ps); + +

      Description

      If ps is not a null pointer, the mbsinit function determines whether the referenced mbstate_t object describes an initial conversion state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The mbsinit function returns nonzero if ps is a null pointer or if the referenced object describes an initial conversion state; otherwise, it returns zero. @@ -21196,21 +22232,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. encoding is state-dependent.

      7.28.6.3.1 The mbrlen function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                size_t mbrlen(const char * restrict s,
                     size_t n,
      -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      -
      Description
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

      Description

      The mbrlen function is equivalent to the call:

      -         mbrtowc(NULL, s, n, ps != NULL ? ps : &internal)
      + mbrtowc(NULL, s, n, ps != NULL ? ps : &internal) + where internal is the mbstate_t object for the mbrlen function, except that the expression designated by ps is evaluated only once. -
      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The mbrlen function returns a value between zero and n, inclusive, (size_t)(-2), or (size_t)(-1). @@ -21218,19 +22256,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.6.3.2 The mbrtowc function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                size_t mbrtowc(wchar_t * restrict pwc,
                     const char * restrict s,
                     size_t n,
      -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      -
      Description
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

      Description

      If s is a null pointer, the mbrtowc function is equivalent to the call:

      -                 mbrtowc(NULL, "", 1, ps)
      + mbrtowc(NULL, "", 1, ps) + In this case, the values of the parameters pwc and n are ignored.

      If s is not a null pointer, the mbrtowc function inspects at most n bytes beginning with @@ -21240,47 +22280,53 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. corresponding wide character and then, if pwc is not a null pointer, stores that value in the object pointed to by pwc. If the corresponding wide character is the null wide character, the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The mbrtowc function returns the first of the following that applies (given the current conversion state): 0 if the next n or fewer bytes complete the multibyte character that

      -                       corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored).
      + corresponds to the null wide character (which is the value stored). + between 1 and n inclusive if the next n or fewer bytes complete a valid multibyte
                           character (which is the value stored); the value returned is the number
      -                    of bytes that complete the multibyte character.
      + of bytes that complete the multibyte character. + (size_t)(-2) if the next n bytes contribute to an incomplete (but potentially valid)
                     multibyte character, and all n bytes have been processed (no value is
      -              stored).336)
      + stored).336) + (size_t)(-1) if an encoding error occurs, in which case the next n or fewer bytes
                     do not contribute to a complete and valid multibyte character (no
                     value is stored); the value of the macro EILSEQ is stored in errno,
      -              and the conversion state is unspecified.
      + and the conversion state is unspecified. + -
      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      336) When n has at least the value of the MB_CUR_MAX macro, this case can only occur if s points at a sequence of redundant shift sequences (for implementations with state-dependent encodings).

      7.28.6.3.3 The wcrtomb function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                size_t wcrtomb(char * restrict s,
                     wchar_t wc,
      -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      -
      Description
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

      Description

      If s is a null pointer, the wcrtomb function is equivalent to the call

      -                 wcrtomb(buf, L'\0', ps)
      + wcrtomb(buf, L'\0', ps) + where buf is an internal buffer.

      If s is not a null pointer, the wcrtomb function determines the number of bytes needed @@ -21289,7 +22335,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. array whose first element is pointed to by s. At most MB_CUR_MAX bytes are stored. If wc is a null wide character, a null byte is stored, preceded by any shift sequence needed to restore the initial shift state; the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      The wcrtomb function returns the number of bytes stored in the array object (including any shift sequences). When wc is not a valid wide character, an encoding error occurs: @@ -21314,15 +22360,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.28.6.4.1 The mbsrtowcs function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                 #include <wchar.h>
                 size_t mbsrtowcs(wchar_t * restrict dst,
                      const char ** restrict src,
                      size_t len,
      -               mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      -
      Description
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

      Description

      The mbsrtowcs function converts a sequence of multibyte characters that begins in the conversion state described by the object pointed to by ps, from the array indirectly @@ -21339,7 +22386,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. just past the last multibyte character converted (if any). If conversion stopped due to reaching a terminating null character and if dst is not a null pointer, the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If the input conversion encounters a sequence of bytes that do not form a valid multibyte character, an encoding error occurs: the mbsrtowcs function stores the value of the @@ -21352,20 +22399,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      337) Thus, the value of len is ignored if dst is a null pointer.

      7.28.6.4.2 The wcsrtombs function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wchar.h>
                size_t wcsrtombs(char * restrict dst,
                     const wchar_t ** restrict src,
                     size_t len,
      -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      -
      Description
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + +

      Description

      The wcsrtombs function converts a sequence of wide characters from the array indirectly pointed to by src into a sequence of corresponding multibyte characters that @@ -21383,7 +22431,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. address just past the last wide character converted (if any). If conversion stopped due to reaching a terminating null wide character, the resulting state described is the initial conversion state. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If conversion stops because a wide character is reached that does not correspond to a valid multibyte character, an encoding error occurs: the wcsrtombs function stores the @@ -21396,7 +22444,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      338) If conversion stops because a terminating null wide character has been reached, the bytes stored include those necessary to reach the initial shift state immediately before the null byte. @@ -21410,14 +22458,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The types declared are

      -          wint_t
      + wint_t + described in 7.28.1;
      -          wctrans_t
      + wctrans_t + which is a scalar type that can hold values which represent locale-specific character mappings; and
      -          wctype_t
      + wctype_t + which is a scalar type that can hold values which represent locale-specific character classifications.

      @@ -21443,7 +22494,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      339) See ''future library directions'' (7.30.13). @@ -21469,7 +22520,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. both printing and white-space wide characters.340)

      Forward references: the wctob function (7.28.6.1.2). -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      340) For example, if the expression isalpha(wctob(wc)) evaluates to true, then the call iswalpha(wc) also returns true. But, if the expression isgraph(wctob(wc)) evaluates to true (which cannot occur for wc == L' ' of course), then either iswgraph(wc) or iswprint(wc) @@ -21477,23 +22528,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.29.2.1.1 The iswalnum function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswalnum(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswalnum(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswalnum function tests for any wide character for which iswalpha or iswdigit is true.

      7.29.2.1.2 The iswalpha function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswalpha(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswalpha(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswalpha function tests for any wide character for which iswupper or iswlower is true, or any wide character that is one of a locale-specific set of alphabetic @@ -21502,18 +22555,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. wide characters for which none of iswcntrl, iswdigit, iswpunct, or iswspace is true.341) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      341) The functions iswlower and iswupper test true or false separately for each of these additional wide characters; all four combinations are possible.

      7.29.2.1.3 The iswblank function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswblank(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswblank(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswblank function tests for any wide character that is a standard blank wide character or is one of a locale-specific set of wide characters for which iswspace is true @@ -21522,117 +22576,126 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. locale, iswblank returns true only for the standard blank characters.

      7.29.2.1.4 The iswcntrl function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswcntrl(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswcntrl(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswcntrl function tests for any control wide character.

      7.29.2.1.5 The iswdigit function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswdigit(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswdigit(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswdigit function tests for any wide character that corresponds to a decimal-digit character (as defined in 5.2.1).

      7.29.2.1.6 The iswgraph function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswgraph(wint_t wc);
      + int iswgraph(wint_t wc); + -
      Description
      +

      Description

      The iswgraph function tests for any wide character for which iswprint is true and iswspace is false.342) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      342) Note that the behavior of the iswgraph and iswpunct functions may differ from their corresponding functions in 7.4.1 with respect to printing, white-space, single-byte execution characters other than ' '.

      7.29.2.1.7 The iswlower function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswlower(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswlower(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswlower function tests for any wide character that corresponds to a lowercase letter or is one of a locale-specific set of wide characters for which none of iswcntrl, iswdigit, iswpunct, or iswspace is true.

      7.29.2.1.8 The iswprint function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswprint(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswprint(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswprint function tests for any printing wide character.

      7.29.2.1.9 The iswpunct function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswpunct(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswpunct(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswpunct function tests for any printing wide character that is one of a locale- specific set of punctuation wide characters for which neither iswspace nor iswalnum is true.342)

      7.29.2.1.10 The iswspace function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         int iswspace(wint_t wc);
      + int iswspace(wint_t wc); + -
      Description
      +

      Description

      The iswspace function tests for any wide character that corresponds to a locale-specific set of white-space wide characters for which none of iswalnum, iswgraph, or iswpunct is true.

      7.29.2.1.11 The iswupper function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wctype.h>
      -        int iswupper(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswupper(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswupper function tests for any wide character that corresponds to an uppercase letter or is one of a locale-specific set of wide characters for which none of iswcntrl, iswdigit, iswpunct, or iswspace is true.

      7.29.2.1.12 The iswxdigit function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wctype.h>
      -        int iswxdigit(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswxdigit(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The iswxdigit function tests for any wide character that corresponds to a hexadecimal-digit character (as defined in 6.4.4.1). @@ -21644,12 +22707,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. subclause (7.29.2.1).

      7.29.2.2.1 The iswctype function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wctype.h>
      -        int iswctype(wint_t wc, wctype_t desc);
      -
      Description
      + int iswctype(wint_t wc, wctype_t desc); + +

      Description

      The iswctype function determines whether the wide character wc has the property described by desc. The current setting of the LC_CTYPE category shall be the same as @@ -21670,8 +22734,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. iswctype(wc, wctype("punct")) // iswpunct(wc) iswctype(wc, wctype("space")) // iswspace(wc) iswctype(wc, wctype("upper")) // iswupper(wc) - iswctype(wc, wctype("xdigit")) // iswxdigit(wc) -

      Returns
      + iswctype(wc, wctype("xdigit")) // iswxdigit(wc) + +

      Returns

      The iswctype function returns nonzero (true) if and only if the value of the wide character wc has the property described by desc. If desc is zero, the iswctype @@ -21679,19 +22744,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Forward references: the wctype function (7.29.2.2.2).

      7.29.2.2.2 The wctype function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         wctype_t wctype(const char *property);
      -
      Description
      + wctype_t wctype(const char *property); + +

      Description

      The wctype function constructs a value with type wctype_t that describes a class of wide characters identified by the string argument property.

      The strings listed in the description of the iswctype function shall be valid in all locales as property arguments to the wctype function. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If property identifies a valid class of wide characters according to the LC_CTYPE category of the current locale, the wctype function returns a nonzero value that is valid @@ -21705,15 +22771,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.29.3.1 Wide character case mapping functions
      7.29.3.1.1 The towlower function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wctype.h>
      -        wint_t towlower(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + wint_t towlower(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The towlower function converts an uppercase letter to a corresponding lowercase letter. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If the argument is a wide character for which iswupper is true and there are one or more corresponding wide characters, as specified by the current locale, for which @@ -21722,15 +22789,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. returned unchanged.

      7.29.3.1.2 The towupper function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

               #include <wctype.h>
      -        wint_t towupper(wint_t wc);
      -
      Description
      + wint_t towupper(wint_t wc); + +

      Description

      The towupper function converts a lowercase letter to a corresponding uppercase letter. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If the argument is a wide character for which iswlower is true and there are one or more corresponding wide characters, as specified by the current locale, for which @@ -21746,12 +22814,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      7.29.3.2.1 The towctrans function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         wint_t towctrans(wint_t wc, wctrans_t desc);
      -
      Description
      + wint_t towctrans(wint_t wc, wctrans_t desc); + +

      Description

      The towctrans function maps the wide character wc using the mapping described by desc. The current setting of the LC_CTYPE category shall be the same as during the call @@ -21761,26 +22830,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. mapping function (7.29.3.1) in the comment that follows the expression:

                towctrans(wc, wctrans("tolower"))                     // towlower(wc)
      -         towctrans(wc, wctrans("toupper"))                     // towupper(wc)
      -
      Returns
      + towctrans(wc, wctrans("toupper")) // towupper(wc) + +

      Returns

      The towctrans function returns the mapped value of wc using the mapping described by desc. If desc is zero, the towctrans function returns the value of wc.

      7.29.3.2.2 The wctrans function
      -
      Synopsis
      +

      Synopsis

                #include <wctype.h>
      -         wctrans_t wctrans(const char *property);
      -
      Description
      + wctrans_t wctrans(const char *property); + +

      Description

      The wctrans function constructs a value with type wctrans_t that describes a mapping between wide characters identified by the string argument property.

      The strings listed in the description of the towctrans function shall be valid in all locales as property arguments to the wctrans function. -

      Returns
      +

      Returns

      If property identifies a valid mapping of wide characters according to the LC_CTYPE category of the current locale, the wctrans function returns a nonzero value that is valid @@ -21798,7 +22869,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

              cerf               cexpm1              clog2
              cerfc              clog10              clgamma
      -       cexp2              clog1p              ctgamma
      + cexp2 clog1p ctgamma + and the same names suffixed with f or l may be added to the declarations in the <complex.h> header. @@ -21874,10 +22946,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Annex A

      -

                                                   (informative)
      -                             Language syntax summary
      + Language syntax summary + +

      NOTE The notation is described in 6.1. @@ -21890,7 +22963,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. identifier constant string-literal - punctuator + punctuator + (6.4) preprocessing-token:

      @@ -21900,7 +22974,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      character-constant
                      string-literal
                      punctuator
      -               each non-white-space character that cannot be one of the above
      + each non-white-space character that cannot be one of the above +

      A.1.2 Keywords

      (6.4.1) keyword: one of @@ -21919,39 +22994,46 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. enum static _Noreturn extern struct _Static_assert float switch _Thread_local - for typedef + for typedef +

      A.1.3 Identifiers

      (6.4.2.1) identifier:
                       identifier-nondigit
                       identifier identifier-nondigit
      -                identifier digit
      + identifier digit + (6.4.2.1) identifier-nondigit:
                       nondigit
                       universal-character-name
      -                other implementation-defined characters
      + other implementation-defined characters + (6.4.2.1) nondigit: one of
                      _ a b          c    d   e    f   g   h    i   j   k   l   m
                           n o       p    q   r    s   t   u    v   w   x   y   z
                           A B       C    D   E    F   G   H    I   J   K   L   M
      -                    N O       P    Q   R    S   T   U    V   W   X   Y   Z
      + N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z + (6.4.2.1) digit: one of
      -                0 1 2         3    4   5    6   7   8    9
      + 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 +

      A.1.4 Universal character names

      (6.4.3) universal-character-name:
                      \u hex-quad
      -               \U hex-quad hex-quad
      + \U hex-quad hex-quad + (6.4.3) hex-quad:
                      hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit
      -                            hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit
      + hexadecimal-digit hexadecimal-digit +

      A.1.5 Constants

      (6.4.4) constant: @@ -21959,158 +23041,194 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. integer-constant floating-constant enumeration-constant - character-constant + character-constant + (6.4.4.1) integer-constant:
                       decimal-constant integer-suffixopt
                       octal-constant integer-suffixopt
      -                hexadecimal-constant integer-suffixopt
      + hexadecimal-constant integer-suffixopt + (6.4.4.1) decimal-constant:
                      nonzero-digit
      -               decimal-constant digit
      + decimal-constant digit + (6.4.4.1) octal-constant:
                       0
      -                octal-constant octal-digit
      + octal-constant octal-digit + (6.4.4.1) hexadecimal-constant:
                      hexadecimal-prefix hexadecimal-digit
      -               hexadecimal-constant hexadecimal-digit
      + hexadecimal-constant hexadecimal-digit + (6.4.4.1) hexadecimal-prefix: one of
      -               0x 0X
      + 0x 0X + (6.4.4.1) nonzero-digit: one of
      -               1 2 3 4 5              6      7   8   9
      + 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 + (6.4.4.1) octal-digit: one of
      -                0 1 2 3           4   5      6   7
      + 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 + (6.4.4.1) hexadecimal-digit: one of
                      0 1 2 3 4 5                6    7    8   9
                      a b c d e f
      -               A B C D E F
      + A B C D E F + (6.4.4.1) integer-suffix:
                       unsigned-suffix long-suffixopt
                       unsigned-suffix long-long-suffix
                       long-suffix unsigned-suffixopt
      -                long-long-suffix unsigned-suffixopt
      + long-long-suffix unsigned-suffixopt + (6.4.4.1) unsigned-suffix: one of
      -                u U
      + u U + (6.4.4.1) long-suffix: one of
      -                l L
      + l L + (6.4.4.1) long-long-suffix: one of
      -                ll LL
      + ll LL + (6.4.4.2) floating-constant:
                       decimal-floating-constant
      -                hexadecimal-floating-constant
      + hexadecimal-floating-constant + (6.4.4.2) decimal-floating-constant:
                      fractional-constant exponent-partopt floating-suffixopt
      -               digit-sequence exponent-part floating-suffixopt
      + digit-sequence exponent-part floating-suffixopt + (6.4.4.2) hexadecimal-floating-constant:
                      hexadecimal-prefix hexadecimal-fractional-constant
                                    binary-exponent-part floating-suffixopt
                      hexadecimal-prefix hexadecimal-digit-sequence
      -                             binary-exponent-part floating-suffixopt
      + binary-exponent-part floating-suffixopt + (6.4.4.2) fractional-constant:
                       digit-sequenceopt . digit-sequence
      -                digit-sequence .
      + digit-sequence . + (6.4.4.2) exponent-part:
                      e signopt digit-sequence
      -               E signopt digit-sequence
      + E signopt digit-sequence + (6.4.4.2) sign: one of
      -                + -
      + + - + (6.4.4.2) digit-sequence:
                       digit
      -                digit-sequence digit
      + digit-sequence digit + (6.4.4.2) hexadecimal-fractional-constant:
                      hexadecimal-digit-sequenceopt .
                                     hexadecimal-digit-sequence
      -               hexadecimal-digit-sequence .
      + hexadecimal-digit-sequence . + (6.4.4.2) binary-exponent-part:
                       p signopt digit-sequence
      -                P signopt digit-sequence
      + P signopt digit-sequence + (6.4.4.2) hexadecimal-digit-sequence:
                      hexadecimal-digit
      -               hexadecimal-digit-sequence hexadecimal-digit
      + hexadecimal-digit-sequence hexadecimal-digit + (6.4.4.2) floating-suffix: one of
      -                f l F L
      + f l F L + (6.4.4.3) enumeration-constant:
      -               identifier
      + identifier + (6.4.4.4) character-constant:
                      ' c-char-sequence '
                      L' c-char-sequence '
                      u' c-char-sequence '
      -               U' c-char-sequence '
      + U' c-char-sequence ' + (6.4.4.4) c-char-sequence:
                       c-char
      -                c-char-sequence c-char
      + c-char-sequence c-char + (6.4.4.4) c-char:
                       any member of the source character set except
                                    the single-quote ', backslash \, or new-line character
      -                escape-sequence
      + escape-sequence + (6.4.4.4) escape-sequence:
                      simple-escape-sequence
                      octal-escape-sequence
                      hexadecimal-escape-sequence
      -               universal-character-name
      + universal-character-name + (6.4.4.4) simple-escape-sequence: one of
                      \' \" \? \\
      -               \a \b \f \n \r \t                   \v
      + \a \b \f \n \r \t \v + (6.4.4.4) octal-escape-sequence:
                       \ octal-digit
                       \ octal-digit octal-digit
      -                \ octal-digit octal-digit octal-digit
      + \ octal-digit octal-digit octal-digit + (6.4.4.4) hexadecimal-escape-sequence:
                      \x hexadecimal-digit
      -               hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit
      + hexadecimal-escape-sequence hexadecimal-digit +

      A.1.6 String literals

      (6.4.5) string-literal:
      -                encoding-prefixopt " s-char-sequenceopt "
      + encoding-prefixopt " s-char-sequenceopt " + (6.4.5) encoding-prefix:
                      u8
                      u
                      U
      -               L
      + L + (6.4.5) s-char-sequence:
                       s-char
      -                s-char-sequence s-char
      + s-char-sequence s-char + (6.4.5) s-char:
                       any member of the source character set except
                                    the double-quote ", backslash \, or new-line character
      -                escape-sequence
      + escape-sequence +

      A.1.7 Punctuators

      (6.4.6) punctuator: one of @@ -22122,29 +23240,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. ? : ; ... = *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |= , # ## - <: :> <% %> %: %:%: + <: :> <% %> %: %:%: +

      A.1.8 Header names

      (6.4.7) header-name:
                      < h-char-sequence >
      -               " q-char-sequence "
      + " q-char-sequence " + (6.4.7) h-char-sequence:
                      h-char
      -               h-char-sequence h-char
      + h-char-sequence h-char + (6.4.7) h-char:
                      any member of the source character set except
      -                            the new-line character and >
      + the new-line character and > + (6.4.7) q-char-sequence:
                      q-char
      -               q-char-sequence q-char
      + q-char-sequence q-char + (6.4.7) q-char:
                      any member of the source character set except
      -                            the new-line character and "
      + the new-line character and " +

      A.1.9 Preprocessing numbers

      (6.4.8) pp-number: @@ -22158,7 +23282,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pp-number E sign pp-number p sign pp-number P sign - pp-number . + pp-number . +

      A.2 Phrase structure grammar

      @@ -22169,18 +23294,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. constant string-literal ( expression ) - generic-selection + generic-selection + (6.5.1.1) generic-selection:
      -               _Generic ( assignment-expression , generic-assoc-list )
      + _Generic ( assignment-expression , generic-assoc-list ) + (6.5.1.1) generic-assoc-list:
                      generic-association
      -               generic-assoc-list , generic-association
      + generic-assoc-list , generic-association + (6.5.1.1) generic-association:
                      type-name : assignment-expression
      -               default : assignment-expression
      + default : assignment-expression + (6.5.2) postfix-expression:
                      primary-expression
      @@ -22191,11 +23320,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      postfix-expression ++
                      postfix-expression --
                      ( type-name ) { initializer-list }
      -               ( type-name ) { initializer-list , }
      + ( type-name ) { initializer-list , } + (6.5.2) argument-expression-list:
                     assignment-expression
      -              argument-expression-list , assignment-expression
      + argument-expression-list , assignment-expression + (6.5.3) unary-expression:
      @@ -22205,103 +23336,125 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      unary-operator cast-expression
                      sizeof unary-expression
                      sizeof ( type-name )
      -               alignof ( type-name )
      + alignof ( type-name ) + (6.5.3) unary-operator: one of
      -               & * + - ~                !
      + & * + - ~ ! + (6.5.4) cast-expression:
                       unary-expression
      -                ( type-name ) cast-expression
      + ( type-name ) cast-expression + (6.5.5) multiplicative-expression:
                       cast-expression
                       multiplicative-expression * cast-expression
                       multiplicative-expression / cast-expression
      -                multiplicative-expression % cast-expression
      + multiplicative-expression % cast-expression + (6.5.6) additive-expression:
                       multiplicative-expression
                       additive-expression + multiplicative-expression
      -                additive-expression - multiplicative-expression
      + additive-expression - multiplicative-expression + (6.5.7) shift-expression:
                        additive-expression
                        shift-expression << additive-expression
      -                 shift-expression >> additive-expression
      + shift-expression >> additive-expression + (6.5.8) relational-expression:
                       shift-expression
                       relational-expression   <    shift-expression
                       relational-expression   >    shift-expression
                       relational-expression   <=   shift-expression
      -                relational-expression   >=   shift-expression
      + relational-expression >= shift-expression + (6.5.9) equality-expression:
                       relational-expression
                       equality-expression == relational-expression
      -                equality-expression != relational-expression
      + equality-expression != relational-expression + (6.5.10) AND-expression:
                     equality-expression
      -              AND-expression & equality-expression
      + AND-expression & equality-expression + (6.5.11) exclusive-OR-expression:
                      AND-expression
      -               exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression
      + exclusive-OR-expression ^ AND-expression + (6.5.12) inclusive-OR-expression:
                       exclusive-OR-expression
      -                inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression
      + inclusive-OR-expression | exclusive-OR-expression + (6.5.13) logical-AND-expression:
                      inclusive-OR-expression
      -               logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression
      + logical-AND-expression && inclusive-OR-expression + (6.5.14) logical-OR-expression:
                      logical-AND-expression
      -               logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression
      + logical-OR-expression || logical-AND-expression + (6.5.15) conditional-expression:
                      logical-OR-expression
      -               logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression
      + logical-OR-expression ? expression : conditional-expression + (6.5.16) assignment-expression:
                      conditional-expression
      -               unary-expression assignment-operator assignment-expression
      + unary-expression assignment-operator assignment-expression + (6.5.16) assignment-operator: one of
      -               = *= /= %= +=                -=    <<=    >>=      &=    ^=   |=
      + = *= /= %= += -= <<= >>= &= ^= |= + (6.5.17) expression:
                      assignment-expression
      -               expression , assignment-expression
      + expression , assignment-expression + (6.6) constant-expression:
      -               conditional-expression
      + conditional-expression +

      A.2.2 Declarations

      (6.7) declaration:
                       declaration-specifiers init-declarator-listopt ;
      -                static_assert-declaration
      + static_assert-declaration + (6.7) declaration-specifiers:
                       storage-class-specifier declaration-specifiersopt
                       type-specifier declaration-specifiersopt
                       type-qualifier declaration-specifiersopt
                       function-specifier declaration-specifiersopt
      -                alignment-specifier declaration-specifiersopt
      + alignment-specifier declaration-specifiersopt + (6.7) init-declarator-list:
                       init-declarator
      -                init-declarator-list , init-declarator
      + init-declarator-list , init-declarator + (6.7) init-declarator:
                       declarator
      -                declarator = initializer
      + declarator = initializer + (6.7.1) storage-class-specifier:
                      typedef
      @@ -22309,7 +23462,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      static
                      _Thread_local
                      auto
      -               register
      + register + (6.7.2) type-specifier:
                       void
      @@ -22326,70 +23480,86 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       atomic-type-specifier
                       struct-or-union-specifier
                       enum-specifier
      -                typedef-name
      + typedef-name + (6.7.2.1) struct-or-union-specifier:
                       struct-or-union identifieropt { struct-declaration-list }
      -                struct-or-union identifier
      + struct-or-union identifier + (6.7.2.1) struct-or-union:
                       struct
      -                union
      + union + (6.7.2.1) struct-declaration-list:
                       struct-declaration
      -                struct-declaration-list struct-declaration
      + struct-declaration-list struct-declaration + (6.7.2.1) struct-declaration:
                       specifier-qualifier-list struct-declarator-listopt ;
      -                static_assert-declaration
      + static_assert-declaration + (6.7.2.1) specifier-qualifier-list:
                       type-specifier specifier-qualifier-listopt
      -                type-qualifier specifier-qualifier-listopt
      + type-qualifier specifier-qualifier-listopt + (6.7.2.1) struct-declarator-list:
                       struct-declarator
      -                struct-declarator-list , struct-declarator
      + struct-declarator-list , struct-declarator + (6.7.2.1) struct-declarator:
                       declarator
      -                declaratoropt : constant-expression
      + declaratoropt : constant-expression + (6.7.2.2) enum-specifier:
                      enum identifieropt { enumerator-list }
                      enum identifieropt { enumerator-list , }
      -               enum identifier
      + enum identifier + (6.7.2.2) enumerator-list:
                      enumerator
      -               enumerator-list , enumerator
      + enumerator-list , enumerator + (6.7.2.2) enumerator:
                      enumeration-constant
      -               enumeration-constant = constant-expression
      + enumeration-constant = constant-expression + (6.7.2.4) atomic-type-specifier:
      -               _Atomic ( type-name )
      + _Atomic ( type-name ) + (6.7.3) type-qualifier:
                      const
                      restrict
                      volatile
      -               _Atomic
      + _Atomic + (6.7.4) function-specifier:
                       inline
      -                _Noreturn
      + _Noreturn + (6.7.5) alignment-specifier:
                      _Alignas ( type-name )
      -               _Alignas ( constant-expression )
      + _Alignas ( constant-expression ) + (6.7.6) declarator:
      -               pointeropt direct-declarator
      + pointeropt direct-declarator + (6.7.6) direct-declarator:
                       identifier
      @@ -22399,39 +23569,48 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       direct-declarator [ type-qualifier-list static assignment-expression ]
                       direct-declarator [ type-qualifier-listopt * ]
                       direct-declarator ( parameter-type-list )
      -                direct-declarator ( identifier-listopt )
      + direct-declarator ( identifier-listopt ) + (6.7.6) pointer:
                       * type-qualifier-listopt
      -                * type-qualifier-listopt pointer
      + * type-qualifier-listopt pointer + (6.7.6) type-qualifier-list:
                      type-qualifier
      -               type-qualifier-list type-qualifier
      + type-qualifier-list type-qualifier + (6.7.6) parameter-type-list:
                     parameter-list
      -              parameter-list , ...
      + parameter-list , ... + (6.7.6) parameter-list:
                     parameter-declaration
      -              parameter-list , parameter-declaration
      + parameter-list , parameter-declaration + (6.7.6) parameter-declaration:
                     declaration-specifiers declarator
      -              declaration-specifiers abstract-declaratoropt
      + declaration-specifiers abstract-declaratoropt + (6.7.6) identifier-list:
                       identifier
      -                identifier-list , identifier
      + identifier-list , identifier + (6.7.7) type-name:
      -               specifier-qualifier-list abstract-declaratoropt
      + specifier-qualifier-list abstract-declaratoropt + (6.7.7) abstract-declarator:
                      pointer
      -               pointeropt direct-abstract-declarator
      + pointeropt direct-abstract-declarator + (6.7.7) direct-abstract-declarator:
                       ( abstract-declarator )
      @@ -22442,34 +23621,42 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                       direct-abstract-declaratoropt [ type-qualifier-list static
                                      assignment-expression ]
                       direct-abstract-declaratoropt [ * ]
      -                direct-abstract-declaratoropt ( parameter-type-listopt )
      + direct-abstract-declaratoropt ( parameter-type-listopt ) + (6.7.8) typedef-name:
      -               identifier
      + identifier + (6.7.9) initializer:
                        assignment-expression
                        { initializer-list }
      -                 { initializer-list , }
      + { initializer-list , } + (6.7.9) initializer-list:
                        designationopt initializer
      -                 initializer-list , designationopt initializer
      + initializer-list , designationopt initializer + (6.7.9) designation:
      -               designator-list =
      + designator-list = + (6.7.9) designator-list:
                      designator
      -               designator-list designator
      + designator-list designator + (6.7.9) designator:
                      [ constant-expression ]
      -               . identifier
      + . identifier + (6.7.10) static_assert-declaration:
      -                _Static_assert ( constant-expression , string-literal ) ;
      + _Static_assert ( constant-expression , string-literal ) ; +

      A.2.3 Statements

      (6.8) statement: @@ -22479,98 +23666,120 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. expression-statement selection-statement iteration-statement - jump-statement + jump-statement + (6.8.1) labeled-statement:
                       identifier : statement
                       case constant-expression : statement
      -                default : statement
      + default : statement + (6.8.2) compound-statement:
      -              { block-item-listopt }
      + { block-item-listopt } + (6.8.2) block-item-list:
                       block-item
      -                block-item-list block-item
      + block-item-list block-item + (6.8.2) block-item:
                       declaration
      -                statement
      + statement + (6.8.3) expression-statement:
      -               expressionopt ;
      + expressionopt ; + (6.8.4) selection-statement:
                       if ( expression ) statement
                       if ( expression ) statement else statement
      -                switch ( expression ) statement
      + switch ( expression ) statement + (6.8.5) iteration-statement:
                        while ( expression ) statement
                        do statement while ( expression ) ;
                        for ( expressionopt ; expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement
      -                 for ( declaration expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement
      + for ( declaration expressionopt ; expressionopt ) statement + (6.8.6) jump-statement:
                      goto identifier ;
                      continue ;
                      break ;
      -               return expressionopt ;
      + return expressionopt ; +

      A.2.4 External definitions

      (6.9) translation-unit:
                       external-declaration
      -                translation-unit external-declaration
      + translation-unit external-declaration + (6.9) external-declaration:
                       function-definition
      -                declaration
      + declaration + (6.9.1) function-definition:
      -                declaration-specifiers declarator declaration-listopt compound-statement
      + declaration-specifiers declarator declaration-listopt compound-statement + (6.9.1) declaration-list:
                      declaration
      -               declaration-list declaration
      + declaration-list declaration +

      A.3 Preprocessing directives

      (6.10) preprocessing-file:
      -               groupopt
      + groupopt + (6.10) group:
                        group-part
      -                 group group-part
      + group group-part + (6.10) group-part:
                      if-section
                      control-line
                      text-line
      -               # non-directive
      + # non-directive + (6.10) if-section:
      -                 if-group elif-groupsopt else-groupopt endif-line
      + if-group elif-groupsopt else-groupopt endif-line + (6.10) if-group:
                       # if     constant-expression new-line groupopt
                       # ifdef identifier new-line groupopt
      -                # ifndef identifier new-line groupopt
      + # ifndef identifier new-line groupopt + (6.10) elif-groups:
                       elif-group
      -                elif-groups elif-group
      + elif-groups elif-group + (6.10) elif-group:
      -                # elif       constant-expression new-line groupopt
      + # elif constant-expression new-line groupopt + (6.10) else-group:
      -                # else        new-line groupopt
      + # else new-line groupopt + (6.10) endif-line:
      -                # endif       new-line
      + # endif new-line + (6.10) control-line:
                      # include pp-tokens new-line
      @@ -22584,38 +23793,47 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                      # line    pp-tokens new-line
                      # error   pp-tokensopt new-line
                      # pragma pp-tokensopt new-line
      -               #         new-line
      + # new-line + (6.10) text-line:
      -                pp-tokensopt new-line
      + pp-tokensopt new-line + (6.10) non-directive:
      -               pp-tokens new-line
      + pp-tokens new-line + (6.10) lparen:
      -                  a ( character not immediately preceded by white-space
      + a ( character not immediately preceded by white-space + (6.10) replacement-list:
      -               pp-tokensopt
      + pp-tokensopt + (6.10) pp-tokens:
                      preprocessing-token
      -               pp-tokens preprocessing-token
      + pp-tokens preprocessing-token + (6.10) new-line:
      -               the new-line character
      + the new-line character +

      Annex B

                                     (informative)
      -                          Library summary
      + Library summary +

      B.1 Diagnostics

                NDEBUG
                static_assert
      -         void assert(scalar expression);
      + void assert(scalar expression); +

      B.2 Complex

      @@ -22694,7 +23912,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. long double complex cprojl(long double complex z); double creal(double complex z); float crealf(float complex z); - long double creall(long double complex z); + long double creall(long double complex z); +

      B.3 Character handling

      @@ -22711,13 +23930,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                int   isupper(int c);
                int   isxdigit(int c);
                int   tolower(int c);
      -         int   toupper(int c);
      + int toupper(int c); +

      B.4 Errors

                EDOM           EILSEQ            ERANGE           errno
                __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__
      -         errno_t
      + errno_t +

      B.5 Floating-point environment

      @@ -22739,7 +23960,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int fegetenv(fenv_t *envp); int feholdexcept(fenv_t *envp); int fesetenv(const fenv_t *envp); - int feupdateenv(const fenv_t *envp); + int feupdateenv(const fenv_t *envp); +

      B.6 Characteristics of floating types

      @@ -22756,7 +23978,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              DBL_DECIMAL_DIG         LDBL_MAX_EXP            DBL_TRUE_MIN
              LDBL_DECIMAL_DIG        FLT_MAX_10_EXP          LDBL_TRUE_MIN
              DECIMAL_DIG             DBL_MAX_10_EXP
      -       FLT_DIG                 LDBL_MAX_10_EXP
      + FLT_DIG LDBL_MAX_10_EXP +

      B.7 Format conversion of integer types

      @@ -22782,13 +24005,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. intmax_t wcstoimax(const wchar_t * restrict nptr, wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base); uintmax_t wcstoumax(const wchar_t * restrict nptr, - wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base); + wchar_t ** restrict endptr, int base); +

      B.8 Alternative spellings

                and            bitor             not_eq           xor
                and_eq         compl             or               xor_eq
      -         bitand         not               or_eq
      + bitand not or_eq +

      B.9 Sizes of integer types

      @@ -22796,14 +24021,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                SCHAR_MIN      MB_LEN_MAX        INT_MAX          LLONG_MIN
                SCHAR_MAX      SHRT_MIN          UINT_MAX         LLONG_MAX
                UCHAR_MAX      SHRT_MAX          LONG_MIN         ULLONG_MAX
      -         CHAR_MIN       USHRT_MAX         LONG_MAX
      + CHAR_MIN USHRT_MAX LONG_MAX +

      B.10 Localization

                struct lconv   LC_ALL            LC_CTYPE         LC_NUMERIC
                NULL           LC_COLLATE        LC_MONETARY      LC_TIME
                char *setlocale(int category, const char *locale);
      -         struct lconv *localeconv(void);
      + struct lconv *localeconv(void); +

      B.11 Mathematics

      @@ -23004,13 +24231,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int isless(real-floating x, real-floating y); int islessequal(real-floating x, real-floating y); int islessgreater(real-floating x, real-floating y); - int isunordered(real-floating x, real-floating y); + int isunordered(real-floating x, real-floating y); +

      B.12 Nonlocal jumps

              jmp_buf
              int setjmp(jmp_buf env);
      -       _Noreturn void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val);
      + _Noreturn void longjmp(jmp_buf env, int val); +

      B.13 Signal handling

      @@ -23019,12 +24248,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. SIG_DFL SIGABRT SIGINT SIG_ERR SIGFPE SIGSEGV void (*signal(int sig, void (*func)(int)))(int); - int raise(int sig); + int raise(int sig); +

      B.14 Alignment

                alignas
      -         __alignas_is_defined
      + __alignas_is_defined +

      B.15 Variable arguments

      @@ -23032,7 +24263,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                type va_arg(va_list ap, type);
                void va_copy(va_list dest, va_list src);
                void va_end(va_list ap);
      -         void va_start(va_list ap, parmN);
      + void va_start(va_list ap, parmN); +

      B.16 Atomics

      @@ -23100,14 +24332,16 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order); void atomic_flag_clear(volatile atomic_flag *object); void atomic_flag_clear_explicit( - volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order); + volatile atomic_flag *object, memory_order order); +

      B.17 Boolean type and values

                bool
                true
                false
      -         __bool_true_false_are_defined
      + __bool_true_false_are_defined +

      B.18 Common definitions

      @@ -23115,7 +24349,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                size_t          wchar_t
                offsetof(type, member-designator)
                __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__
      -         rsize_t
      + rsize_t +

      B.19 Integer types

      @@ -23134,7 +24369,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. INTN_MAX UINTMAX_MAX UINTMAX_C(value) UINTN_MAX PTRDIFF_MIN __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ - RSIZE_MAX + RSIZE_MAX +

      B.20 Input/output

      @@ -23256,7 +24492,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int vsscanf_s(const char * restrict s, const char * restrict format, va_list arg); - char *gets_s(char *s, rsize_t n); + char *gets_s(char *s, rsize_t n); +

      B.21 General utilities

      @@ -23355,7 +24592,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. const char * restrict src, rsize_t len); errno_t wcstombs_s(size_t * restrict retval, char * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax, - const wchar_t * restrict src, rsize_t len); + const wchar_t * restrict src, rsize_t len); +

      B.22 String handling

      @@ -23421,7 +24659,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. errno_t strerror_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize, errno_t errnum); size_t strerrorlen_s(errno_t errnum); - size_t strnlen_s(const char *s, size_t maxsize); + size_t strnlen_s(const char *s, size_t maxsize); +

      B.23 Type-generic math

      @@ -23439,7 +24678,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                tanh         floor             logb             cimag
                exp          fma               lrint            conj
                log          fmax              lround           cproj
      -         pow          fmin              nearbyint        creal
      + pow fmin nearbyint creal +

      B.24 Threads

      @@ -23481,7 +24721,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. void tss_delete(tss_t key); void *tss_get(tss_t key); int tss_set(tss_t key, void *val); - int xtime_get(xtime *xt, int base); + int xtime_get(xtime *xt, int base); +

      B.25 Date and time

      @@ -23510,7 +24751,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. struct tm *gmtime_s(const time_t * restrict timer, struct tm * restrict result); struct tm *localtime_s(const time_t * restrict timer, - struct tm * restrict result); + struct tm * restrict result); +

      B.26 Unicode utilities

      @@ -23524,7 +24766,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     const char * restrict s, size_t n,
                     mbstate_t * restrict ps);
                size_t c32rtomb(char * restrict s, char32_t c32,
      -              mbstate_t * restrict ps);
      + mbstate_t * restrict ps); +

      B.27 Extended multibyte/wide character utilities

      @@ -23707,7 +24950,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. errno_t wcsrtombs_s(size_t * restrict retval, char * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax, const wchar_t ** restrict src, rsize_t len, - mbstate_t * restrict ps); + mbstate_t * restrict ps); +

      B.28 Wide character classification and mapping utilities

      @@ -23730,13 +24974,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. wint_t towlower(wint_t wc); wint_t towupper(wint_t wc); wint_t towctrans(wint_t wc, wctrans_t desc); - wctrans_t wctrans(const char *property); + wctrans_t wctrans(const char *property); +

      Annex C

      -

                                            (informative)
      -                                   Sequence points
      + Sequence points + +

      The following are the sequence points described in 5.1.2.3:

      • Between the evaluations of the function designator and actual arguments in a function @@ -23763,10 +25009,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Annex D

      -

                                            (normative)
      -                Universal character names for identifiers
      + Universal character names for identifiers + +

      This clause lists the hexadecimal code values that are valid in universal character names in identifiers. @@ -23797,15 +25044,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Annex E

      -

                                           (informative)
      -                             Implementation limits
      + Implementation limits + +

      The contents of the header <limits.h> are given below, in alphabetical order. The minimum magnitudes shown shall be replaced by implementation-defined magnitudes with the same sign. The values shall all be constant expressions suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives. The components are described further in 5.2.4.2.1. -

                #define    CHAR_BIT                               8
                #define    CHAR_MAX          UCHAR_MAX or SCHAR_MAX
      @@ -23825,7 +25072,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                #define    USHRT_MAX                          65535
                #define    UINT_MAX                           65535
                #define    ULONG_MAX                     4294967295
      -         #define    ULLONG_MAX          18446744073709551615
      + #define ULLONG_MAX 18446744073709551615 + +

      The contents of the header <float.h> are given below. All integer values, except FLT_ROUNDS, shall be constant expressions suitable for use in #if preprocessing directives; all floating values shall be constant expressions. The components are @@ -23833,15 +25082,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      The values given in the following list shall be replaced by implementation-defined expressions: -

                #define FLT_EVAL_METHOD
      -         #define FLT_ROUNDS
      + #define FLT_ROUNDS + +

      The values given in the following list shall be replaced by implementation-defined constant expressions that are greater or equal in magnitude (absolute value) to those shown, with the same sign: -

               #define    DLB_DECIMAL_DIG                                10
               #define    DBL_DIG                                        10
      @@ -23865,14 +25114,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               #define    LDBL_MAX_10_EXP                              +37
               #define    LDBL_MAX_EXP
               #define    LDBL_MIN_10_EXP                              -37
      -        #define    LDBL_MIN_EXP
      + #define LDBL_MIN_EXP + +

      The values given in the following list shall be replaced by implementation-defined constant expressions with values that are greater than or equal to those shown: -

               #define DBL_MAX                                      1E+37
               #define FLT_MAX                                      1E+37
      -        #define LDBL_MAX                                     1E+37
      + #define LDBL_MAX 1E+37 + +

      The values given in the following list shall be replaced by implementation-defined constant expressions with (positive) values that are less than or equal to those shown: @@ -23882,12 +25134,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #define FLT_EPSILON 1E-5 #define FLT_MIN 1E-37 #define LDBL_EPSILON 1E-9 - #define LDBL_MIN 1E-37 + #define LDBL_MIN 1E-37 +

      Annex F

                                                  (normative)
      -                       IEC 60559 floating-point arithmetic
      + IEC 60559 floating-point arithmetic +

      F.1 Introduction

      @@ -23905,7 +25159,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. negative and positive infinity are representable in IEC 60559 formats, all real numbers lie within the range of representable values. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      343) Implementations that do not define __STDC_IEC_559__ are not required to conform to these specifications. @@ -23926,11 +25180,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      Recommended practice
      +

      Recommended practice

      The long double type should match an IEC 60559 extended format. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      344) ''Extended'' is IEC 60559's double-extended data format. Extended refers to both the common 80-bit and quadruple 128-bit IEC 60559 formats. @@ -23944,7 +25198,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the term NaN to denote quiet NaNs. The NAN and INFINITY macros and the nan functions in <math.h> provide designations for IEC 60559 NaNs and infinities. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      346) Since NaNs created by IEC 60559 operations are always quiet, quiet NaNs (along with infinities) are sufficient for closure of the arithmetic. @@ -24041,7 +25295,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversion of a non-integral floating value raises the ''inexact'' floating-point exception is unspecified.347) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      347) ANSI/IEEE 854, but not IEC 60559 (ANSI/IEEE 754), directly specifies that floating-to-integer conversions raise the ''inexact'' floating-point exception for non-integer in-range values. In those cases where it matters, library functions can be used to effect such conversions with or without raising @@ -24069,7 +25323,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. implementation cannot convert a minus-signed sequence by negating the converted unsigned sequence. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      348) If the minimum-width IEC 60559 extended format (64 bits of precision) is supported, DECIMAL_DIG shall be at least 21. If IEC 60559 double (53 bits of precision) is the widest IEC 60559 format supported, then DECIMAL_DIG shall be at least 17. (By contrast, LDBL_DIG and @@ -24081,7 +25335,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. type, the expression is converted as if by assignment349) to the return type of the function and the resulting value is returned to the caller. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      349) Assignment removes any extra range and precision. @@ -24090,7 +25344,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. A contracted expression is correctly rounded (once) and treats infinities, NaNs, signed zeros, subnormals, and the rounding directions in a manner consistent with the basic arithmetic operations covered by IEC 60559. -

      Recommended practice
      +

      Recommended practice

      A contracted expression should raise floating-point exceptions in a manner generally consistent with the basic arithmetic operations. * @@ -24102,7 +25356,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. IEC 60559 dynamic rounding precision and trap enablement modes, if the implementation supports them.350) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      350) This specification does not require dynamic rounding precision nor trap enablement modes. @@ -24119,7 +25373,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      351) If the state for the FENV_ACCESS pragma is ''off'', the implementation is free to assume the floating- point control modes will be the default ones and the floating-point status flags will not be tested, which allows certain optimizations (see F.9). @@ -24133,13 +25387,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    • The rounding precision mode (if supported) is set so that results are not shortened.
    • Trapping or stopping (if supported) is disabled on all floating-point exceptions.
    -
    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    The implementation should produce a diagnostic message for each translation-time floating-point exception, other than ''inexact'';352) the implementation should then proceed with the translation of the program. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    352) As floating constants are converted to appropriate internal representations at translation time, their conversion is subject to default rounding modes and raises no execution-time floating-point exceptions (even where the state of the FENV_ACCESS pragma is ''on''). Library functions, for example @@ -24171,7 +25425,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

               #include <fenv.h>
               #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS ON
    @@ -24182,20 +25435,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     float y = 0.0/0.0;                        //   raises an exception
                     double z = 0.0/0.0;                       //   raises an exception
                     /* ... */
    -          }
    + } + +

    For the static initialization, the division is done at translation time, raising no (execution-time) floating- point exceptions. On the other hand, for the three automatic initializations the invalid division occurs at execution time. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    353) Where the state for the FENV_ACCESS pragma is ''on'', results of inexact expressions like 1.0/3.0 are affected by rounding modes set at execution time, and expressions such as 0.0/0.0 and 1.0/0.0 generate execution-time floating-point exceptions. The programmer can achieve the efficiency of translation-time evaluation through static initialization, such as

    -          const static double one_third = 1.0/3.0;
    + const static double one_third = 1.0/3.0; +

    F.8.5 Initialization

    @@ -24207,7 +25463,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. translation time.

    EXAMPLE -

               #include <fenv.h>
               #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS ON
    @@ -24220,7 +25475,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                     float y = 1.1e75f;                       //   may raise exceptions
                     long double z = 1.1e75;                  //   does not raise exceptions
                     /* ... */
    -          }
    + } + +

    The static initialization of v raises no (execution-time) floating-point exceptions because its computation is done at translation time. The automatic initialization of u and w require an execution-time conversion to float of the wider value 1.1e75, which raises floating-point exceptions. The automatic initializations @@ -24235,12 +25492,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. their internal representations occur at translation time in all cases. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    354) Use of float_t and double_t variables increases the likelihood of translation-time computation. For example, the automatic initialization

    -          double_t x = 1.1e75;
    + double_t x = 1.1e75; + could be done at translation time, regardless of the expression evaluation method. @@ -24279,7 +25537,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. /* ... */ for (i = 0; i < n; i++) x + 1; /* ... */ - } + } + x + 1 might raise floating-point exceptions, so cannot be removed. And since the loop body might not execute (maybe 0 >= n), x + 1 cannot be moved out of the loop. (Of course these optimizations are valid if the implementation can rule out the nettlesome @@ -24292,7 +25551,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the preceding loop could be treated as
    -          if (0 < n) x + 1;
    + if (0 < n) x + 1; +

    F.9.2 Expression transformations

    @@ -24300,41 +25560,51 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

                             generally do not yield numerically equivalent expressions, if the
                             constants are exact then such transformations can be made on
    -                        IEC 60559 machines and others that round perfectly.
    + IEC 60559 machines and others that round perfectly. + 1 x x and x/1 -> x The expressions 1 x x, x/1, and x are equivalent (on IEC 60559
    -                   machines, among others).355)
    + machines, among others).355) + x/x -> 1.0 The expressions x/x and 1.0 are not equivalent if x can be zero,
    -                        infinite, or NaN.
    + infinite, or NaN. + x - y <-> x + (-y) The expressions x - y, x + (-y), and (-y) + x are equivalent (on
    -                        IEC 60559 machines, among others).
    + IEC 60559 machines, among others). + x - y <-> -(y - x) The expressions x - y and -(y - x) are not equivalent because 1 - 1
    -                        is +0 but -(1 - 1) is -0 (in the default rounding direction).356)
    + is +0 but -(1 - 1) is -0 (in the default rounding direction).356) + x - x -> 0.0 The expressions x - x and 0.0 are not equivalent if x is a NaN or
    -                        infinite.
    + infinite. + 0 x x -> 0.0 The expressions 0 x x and 0.0 are not equivalent if x is a NaN,
    -                        infinite, or -0.
    + infinite, or -0. + x+0-> x The expressions x + 0 and x are not equivalent if x is -0, because
    -                        (-0) + (+0) yields +0 (in the default rounding direction), not -0.
    + (-0) + (+0) yields +0 (in the default rounding direction), not -0. + x-0-> x (+0) - (+0) yields -0 when rounding is downward (toward -(inf)), but
                             +0 otherwise, and (-0) - (+0) always yields -0; so, if the state of the
                             FENV_ACCESS pragma is ''off'', promising default rounding, then
    -                        the implementation can replace x - 0 by x, even if x might be zero.
    + the implementation can replace x - 0 by x, even if x might be zero. + -x <-> 0 - x The expressions -x and 0 - x are not equivalent if x is +0, because
                             -(+0) yields -0, but 0 - (+0) yields +0 (unless rounding is
    -                        downward).
    + downward). + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    355) Strict support for signaling NaNs -- not required by this specification -- would invalidate these and other transformations that remove arithmetic operators. @@ -24342,11 +25612,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Examples include:

    -    1/(1/ (+-) (inf)) is (+-) (inf)
    + 1/(1/ (+-) (inf)) is (+-) (inf) + and
    -    conj(csqrt(z)) is csqrt(conj(z)),
    + conj(csqrt(z)) is csqrt(conj(z)), + for complex z.
    @@ -24361,7 +25633,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. transformation, which would be desirable if extra code were required to cause the ''invalid'' floating-point exception for unordered cases, could be performed provided the state of the FENV_ACCESS pragma - is ''off''. + is ''off''. + The sense of relational operators shall be maintained. This includes handling unordered cases as expressed by the source code.

    @@ -24371,35 +25644,40 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. if (a < b) f(); else - g(); + g(); + is not equivalent to

               // calls f and raises ''invalid'' if a and b are unordered
               if (a >= b)
                       g();
               else
    -                  f();
    + f(); + nor to
               // calls f without raising ''invalid'' if a and b are unordered
               if (isgreaterequal(a,b))
                       g();
               else
    -                  f();
    + f(); + nor, unless the state of the FENV_ACCESS pragma is ''off'', to
               // calls g without raising ''invalid'' if a and b are unordered
               if (isless(a,b))
                       f();
               else
    -                  g();
    + g(); + but is equivalent to
              if (!(a < b))
                    g();
              else
    -               f();
    + f(); +

    F.9.4 Constant arithmetic

    @@ -24413,7 +25691,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. precision modes shall assure further that the result of the operation raises no floating- point exception when converted to the semantic type of the operation. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    357) 0 - 0 yields -0 instead of +0 just when the rounding direction is downward. @@ -24466,13 +25744,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. For families of functions, the specifications apply to all of the functions even though only the principal function is shown. Unless otherwise specified, where the symbol ''(+-)'' occurs in both an argument and the result, the result has the same sign as the argument. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    If a function with one or more NaN arguments returns a NaN result, the result should be the same as one of the NaN arguments (after possible type conversion), except perhaps for the sign. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    358) IEC 60559 allows different definitions of underflow. They all result in the same values, but differ on when the floating-point exception is raised. @@ -24526,7 +25804,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

  • atan2((+-)(inf), +(inf)) returns (+-)pi /4. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    360) atan2(0, 0) does not raise the ''invalid'' floating-point exception, nor does atan2( y , 0) raise the ''divide-by-zero'' floating-point exception. @@ -24651,7 +25929,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. { *exp = (value == 0) ? 0 : (int)(1 + logb(value)); return scalbn(value, -(*exp)); - } + } +

    F.10.3.5 The ilogb functions

    @@ -24739,7 +26018,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. return copysign( isinf(value) ? 0.0 : value - (*iptr), value); - } + } +

    F.10.3.13 The scalbn and scalbln functions

    @@ -24863,7 +26143,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The returned value is independent of the current rounding direction mode.

    The double version of ceil behaves as though implemented by -

             #include <math.h>
             #include <fenv.h>
    @@ -24876,7 +26155,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                  result = rint(x); // or nearbyint instead of rint
                  fesetround(save_round);
                  return result;
    -        }
    + } + +

    The ceil functions may, but are not required to, raise the ''inexact'' floating-point exception for finite non-integer arguments, as this implementation does. @@ -24944,7 +26225,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. } feupdateenv(&save_env); return result; - } + } + The round functions may, but are not required to, raise the ''inexact'' floating-point exception for finite non-integer numeric arguments, as this implementation does. @@ -24995,7 +26277,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. result = remainder(fabs(x), (y = fabs(y))); if (signbit(result)) result += y; return copysign(result, x); - } + } +

    F.10.7.2 The remainder functions

    @@ -25063,9 +26346,10 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The body of the fmax function might be361)

             { return (isgreaterequal(x, y) ||
    -             isnan(y)) ? x : y; }
    + isnan(y)) ? x : y; } + -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    361) Ideally, fmax would be sensitive to the sign of zero, for example fmax(-0.0, +0.0) would return +0; however, implementation in software might be impractical. @@ -25109,7 +26393,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Annex G

                                            (normative)
    -                IEC 60559-compatible complex arithmetic
    + IEC 60559-compatible complex arithmetic +

    G.1 Introduction

    @@ -25117,7 +26402,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. IEC 60559 real floating-point arithmetic. An implementation that defines * __STDC_IEC_559_COMPLEX__ shall conform to the specifications in this annex.362) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    362) Implementations that do not define __STDC_IEC_559_COMPLEX__ are not required to conform to these specifications. @@ -25168,7 +26453,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. When a value of real type is converted to an imaginary type, the result is a positive imaginary zero. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    363) See 6.3.1.2. @@ -25200,7 +26485,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    G.5.1 Multiplicative operators

    -
    Semantics
    +

    Semantics

    If one operand has real type and the other operand has imaginary type, then the result has imaginary type. If both operands have imaginary type, then the result has real type. (If @@ -25209,31 +26494,39 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the operands are not both complex, then the result and floating-point exception behavior of the * operator is defined by the usual mathematical formula:

    -        *                  u                   iv                 u + iv
    + * u iv u + iv +
    -        x                  xu                i(xv)            (xu) + i(xv)
    + x xu i(xv) (xu) + i(xv) +
    -        iy               i(yu)                -yv            (-yv) + i(yu)
    + iy i(yu) -yv (-yv) + i(yu) + -

    -        x + iy       (xu) + i(yu)        (-yv) + i(xv)
    + x + iy (xu) + i(yu) (-yv) + i(xv) + +

    If the second operand is not complex, then the result and floating-point exception behavior of the / operator is defined by the usual mathematical formula:

    -        /                   u                       iv
    + / u iv +
    -        x                  x/u                 i(-x/v)
    + x x/u i(-x/v) +
    -        iy               i(y/u)                     y/v
    + iy i(y/u) y/v + -

    -        x + iy       (x/u) + i(y/u)        (y/v) + i(-x/v)
    + x + iy (x/u) + i(y/u) (y/v) + i(-x/v) + +

    The * and / operators satisfy the following infinity properties for all real, imaginary, and complex operands:364)

      @@ -25259,7 +26552,6 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. EXAMPLE 1 Multiplication of double _Complex operands could be implemented as follows. Note that the imaginary unit I has imaginary type (see G.6). -

                 #include <math.h>
                 #include <complex.h>
      @@ -25307,14 +26599,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                               }
                         }
                         return x + I * y;
      -         }
      + } + +

      This implementation achieves the required treatment of infinities at the cost of only one isnan test in ordinary (finite) cases. It is less than ideal in that undue overflow and underflow may occur.

      EXAMPLE 2 Division of two double _Complex operands could be implemented as follows. -

                #include <math.h>
                #include <complex.h>
      @@ -25358,20 +26651,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                               }
                         }
                         return x + I * y;
      -         }
      + } + +

      Scaling the denominator alleviates the main overflow and underflow problem, which is more serious than for multiplication. In the spirit of the multiplication example above, this code does not defend against overflow and underflow in the calculation of the numerator. Scaling with the scalbn function, instead of with division, provides better roundoff characteristics. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      364) These properties are already implied for those cases covered in the tables, but are required for all cases (at least where the state for CX_LIMITED_RANGE is ''off'').

      G.5.2 Additive operators

      -
      Semantics
      +

      Semantics

      If both operands have imaginary type, then the result has imaginary type. (If one operand has real type and the other operand has imaginary type, or if either operand has complex @@ -25380,29 +26675,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. In all cases the result and floating-point exception behavior of a + or - operator is defined by the usual mathematical formula:

      -        + or -              u                       iv                    u + iv
      + + or - u iv u + iv +
      -        x                 x(+-)u                     x (+-) iv              (x (+-) u) (+-) iv
      + x x(+-)u x (+-) iv (x (+-) u) (+-) iv +
      -        iy               (+-)u + iy                 i(y (+-) v)             (+-)u + i(y (+-) v)
      + iy (+-)u + iy i(y (+-) v) (+-)u + i(y (+-) v) +
      -        x + iy         (x (+-) u) + iy            x + i(y (+-) v)        (x (+-) u) + i(y (+-) v)
      + x + iy (x (+-) u) + iy x + i(y (+-) v) (x (+-) u) + i(y (+-) v) +

      G.6 Complex arithmetic

      The macros

      -         imaginary
      + imaginary + and
      -         _Imaginary_I
      + _Imaginary_I + are defined, respectively, as _Imaginary and a constant expression of type const float _Imaginary with the value of the imaginary unit. The macro
      -         I
      + I + is defined to be _Imaginary_I (not _Complex_I as stated in 7.3). Notwithstanding the provisions of 7.1.3, a program may undefine and then perhaps redefine the macro imaginary. @@ -25428,19 +26730,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Each of the functions cabs and carg is specified by a formula in terms of a real function (whose special cases are covered in annex F): -

                cabs(x + iy) = hypot(x, y)
      -         carg(x + iy) = atan2(y, x)
      + carg(x + iy) = atan2(y, x) + +

      Each of the functions casin, catan, ccos, csin, and ctan is specified implicitly by a formula in terms of other complex functions (whose special cases are specified below): -

                casin(z)        =   -i casinh(iz)
                catan(z)        =   -i catanh(iz)
                ccos(z)         =   ccosh(iz)
                csin(z)         =   -i csinh(iz)
      -         ctan(z)         =   -i ctanh(iz)
      + ctan(z) = -i ctanh(iz) + +

      For the other functions, the following subclauses specify behavior for special cases, including treatment of the ''invalid'' and ''divide-by-zero'' floating-point exceptions. For families of functions, the specifications apply to all of the functions even though only the @@ -25456,7 +26760,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      365) As noted in G.3, a complex value with at least one infinite part is regarded as an infinity even if its other part is a NaN. @@ -25677,7 +26981,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The cpow functions raise floating-point exceptions if appropriate for the calculation of the parts of the result, and may also raise spurious floating-point exceptions.366) -

      footnotes
      +

      Footnotes

      366) This allows cpow( z , c ) to be implemented as cexp(c clog( z )) without precluding implementations that treat special cases more carefully. @@ -25728,12 +27032,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. asin(iy) = i asinh(y) atan(iy) = i atanh(y) asinh(iy) = i asin(y) - atanh(iy) = i atan(y) + atanh(iy) = i atan(y) +

      Annex H

                                            (informative)
      -                     Language independent arithmetic
      + Language independent arithmetic +

      H.1 Introduction

      @@ -25765,7 +27071,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The parameters for the integer data types can be accessed by the following: maxint INT_MAX, LONG_MAX, LLONG_MAX, UINT_MAX, ULONG_MAX,

      -               ULLONG_MAX
      + ULLONG_MAX + minint INT_MIN, LONG_MIN, LLONG_MIN

      The parameter ''bounded'' is always true, and is not provided. The parameter ''minint'' @@ -25826,7 +27133,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. exponentF 1.f+logbf(x), 1.0+logb(x), 1.L+logbl(x) scaleF scalbnf(x, n), scalbn(x, n), scalbnl(x, n),

      -               scalblnf(x, li), scalbln(x, li), scalblnl(x, li)
      + scalblnf(x, li), scalbln(x, li), scalblnl(x, li) + intpartF modff(x, &y), modf(x, &y), modfl(x, &y) fractpartF modff(x, &y), modf(x, &y), modfl(x, &y) eqF x == y @@ -25857,11 +27165,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. cvtI' -> I (int)i, (long int)i, (long long int)i,
                      (unsigned int)i, (unsigned long int)i,
      -               (unsigned long long int)i
      + (unsigned long long int)i + cvtF -> I (int)x, (long int)x, (long long int)x,
                      (unsigned int)x, (unsigned long int)x,
      -               (unsigned long long int)x
      + (unsigned long long int)x + cvtI -> F (float)i, (double)i, (long double)i cvtF' -> F (float)x, (double)x, (long double)x

      @@ -25959,10 +27269,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

      Annex I

      -

                                            (informative)
      -                                Common warnings
      + Common warnings + +

      An implementation may generate warnings in many situations, none of which are specified as part of this International Standard. The following are a few of the more common situations. @@ -26003,10 +27314,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Annex J

    -

                                           (informative)
    -                                   Portability issues
    + Portability issues + +

    This annex collects some information about portability that appears in this International Standard. @@ -26998,7 +28310,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The asm keyword may be used to insert assembly language directly into the translator output (6.8). The most common implementation is via a statement of the form:

    -        asm ( character-string-literal );
    + asm ( character-string-literal ); +

    J.5.11 Multiple external definitions

    @@ -27047,7 +28360,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Annex K

                                            (normative)
    -                           Bounds-checking interfaces
    + Bounds-checking interfaces +

    K.1 Background

    @@ -27095,7 +28409,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. Subclause K.3 should be read as if it were merged into the parallel structure of named subclauses of clause 7. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    367) Implementations that do not define __STDC_LIB_EXT1__ are not required to conform to these specifications. @@ -27129,7 +28443,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    368) Future revisions of this International Standard may define meanings for other values of __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__. @@ -27186,7 +28500,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    370) Although runtime-constraints replace many cases of undefined behavior, undefined behavior still exists in this annex. Implementations are free to detect any case of undefined behavior and treat it as a runtime-constraint violation by calling the runtime-constraint handler. This license comes directly @@ -27199,10 +28513,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The type is

    -          errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int.371) -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    371) As a matter of programming style, errno_t may be used as the type of something that deals only with the values that might be found in errno. For example, a function which returns the value of errno might be declared as having the return type errno_t. @@ -27214,10 +28529,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The type is

    -          rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t.372) -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    372) See the description of the RSIZE_MAX macro in <stdint.h>. @@ -27227,11 +28543,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The macro is

    -          RSIZE_MAX
    + RSIZE_MAX + which expands to a value373) of type size_t. Functions that have parameters of type rsize_t consider it a runtime-constraint violation if the values of those parameters are greater than RSIZE_MAX. -
    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    Extremely large object sizes are frequently a sign that an object's size was calculated incorrectly. For example, negative numbers appear as very large positive numbers when @@ -27248,7 +28565,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. is no object size that is considered a runtime-constraint violation. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    373) The macro RSIZE_MAX need not expand to a constant expression. @@ -27258,38 +28575,43 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The macros are

    -        L_tmpnam_s
    + L_tmpnam_s + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the size needed for an array of char large enough to hold a temporary file name string generated by the tmpnam_s function;
    -        TMP_MAX_S
    + TMP_MAX_S + which expands to an integer constant expression that is the maximum number of unique file names that can be generated by the tmpnam_s function.

    The types are

    -        errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int; and
    -        rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t.
    K.3.5.1 Operations on files
    K.3.5.1.1 The tmpfile_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
    -        errno_t tmpfile_s(FILE * restrict * restrict streamptr);
    + errno_t tmpfile_s(FILE * restrict * restrict streamptr); + Runtime-constraints

    streamptr shall not be a null pointer.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, tmpfile_s does not attempt to create a file. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The tmpfile_s function creates a temporary binary file that is different from any other existing file and that will automatically be removed when it is closed or at program @@ -27302,28 +28624,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the file was created successfully, then the pointer to FILE pointed to by streamptr will be set to the pointer to the object controlling the opened file. Otherwise, the pointer to FILE pointed to by streamptr will be set to a null pointer. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice It should be possible to open at least TMP_MAX_S temporary files during the lifetime of the program (this limit may be shared with tmpnam_s) and there should be no limit on the number simultaneously open other than this limit and any limit on the number of open files (FOPEN_MAX). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The tmpfile_s function returns zero if it created the file. If it did not create the file or there was a runtime-constraint violation, tmpfile_s returns a nonzero value.

    K.3.5.1.2 The tmpnam_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdio.h>
    -         errno_t tmpnam_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize);
    + errno_t tmpnam_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize); + Runtime-constraints

    s shall not be a null pointer. maxsize shall be less than or equal to RSIZE_MAX. maxsize shall be greater than the length of the generated file name string. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The tmpnam_s function generates a string that is a valid file name and that is not the same as the name of an existing file.374) The function is potentially capable of generating @@ -27342,7 +28665,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The implementation shall behave as if no library function except tmpnam calls the tmpnam_s function.375) -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    After a program obtains a file name using the tmpnam_s function and before the program creates a file with that name, the possibility exists that someone else may create @@ -27350,7 +28673,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. should be used instead of tmpnam_s when possible. One situation that requires the use of the tmpnam_s function is when the program needs to create a temporary directory rather than a temporary file. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If no suitable string can be generated, or if there is a runtime-constraint violation, the tmpnam_s function writes a null character to s[0] (only if s is not null and maxsize @@ -27358,11 +28681,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Otherwise, the tmpnam_s function writes the string in the array pointed to by s and returns zero. -

    Environmental limits
    +

    Environmental limits

    The value of the macro TMP_MAX_S shall be at least 25. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    374) Files created using strings generated by the tmpnam_s function are temporary only in the sense that their names should not collide with those generated by conventional naming rules for the implementation. It is still necessary to use the remove function to remove such files when their use @@ -27378,14 +28701,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.5.2 File access functions
    K.3.5.2.1 The fopen_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
             errno_t fopen_s(FILE * restrict * restrict streamptr,
                  const char * restrict filename,
    -             const char * restrict mode);
    + const char * restrict mode); + Runtime-constraints

    None of streamptr, filename, or mode shall be a null pointer. @@ -27398,7 +28722,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The fopen_s function opens the file whose name is the string pointed to by filename, and associates a stream with it. @@ -27407,33 +28731,41 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. with the character 'w' or 'a' may be preceded by the character 'u', see below: uw truncate to zero length or create text file for writing, default

    -                permissions
    + permissions + uwx create text file for writing, default permissions ua append; open or create text file for writing at end-of-file, default
    -                permissions
    + permissions + uwb truncate to zero length or create binary file for writing, default
    -                permissions
    + permissions + uwbx create binary file for writing, default permissions uab append; open or create binary file for writing at end-of-file, default
    -                permissions
    + permissions + uw+ truncate to zero length or create text file for update, default
    -                permissions
    + permissions + uw+x create text file for update, default permissions ua+ append; open or create text file for update, writing at end-of-file,
    -                default permissions
    + default permissions + uw+b or uwb+ truncate to zero length or create binary file for update, default
    -                permissions
    + permissions + uw+bx or uwb+x create binary file for update, default permissions ua+b or uab+ append; open or create binary file for update, writing at end-of-file, -

    -                default permissions
    + default permissions + +

    Opening a file with exclusive mode ('x' as the last character in the mode argument) fails if the file already exists or cannot be created.

    @@ -27451,17 +28783,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. to FILE pointed to by streamptr will be set to a null pointer. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The fopen_s function returns zero if it opened the file. If it did not open the file or if there was a runtime-constraint violation, fopen_s returns a nonzero value. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    376) These are the same permissions that the file would have been created with by fopen.

    K.3.5.2.2 The freopen_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -27469,7 +28801,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
             errno_t freopen_s(FILE * restrict * restrict newstreamptr,
                  const char * restrict filename,
                  const char * restrict mode,
    -             FILE * restrict stream);
    + FILE * restrict stream); + Runtime-constraints

    None of newstreamptr, mode, and stream shall be a null pointer. @@ -27477,7 +28810,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, freopen_s neither attempts to close any file associated with stream nor attempts to open a file. Furthermore, if newstreamptr is not a null pointer, fopen_s sets *newstreamptr to the null pointer. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The freopen_s function opens the file whose name is the string pointed to by filename and associates the stream pointed to by stream with it. The mode @@ -27496,7 +28829,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If the file was opened successfully, then the pointer to FILE pointed to by newstreamptr will be set to the value of stream. Otherwise, the pointer to FILE pointed to by newstreamptr will be set to a null pointer. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The freopen_s function returns zero if it opened the file. If it did not open the file or there was a runtime-constraint violation, freopen_s returns a nonzero value. @@ -27509,13 +28842,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. unspecified values.

    K.3.5.3.1 The fprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
               #include <stdio.h>
               int fprintf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
    -               const char * restrict format, ...);
    + const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. The %n specifier377) (modified or @@ -27526,11 +28860,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation,378) the fprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent fprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The fprintf_s function is equivalent to the fprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The fprintf_s function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. @@ -27540,7 +28874,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    377) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n. @@ -27551,13 +28885,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.5.3.2 The fscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdio.h>
              int fscanf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
    -              const char * restrict format, ...);
    + const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in @@ -27566,7 +28901,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation,379) the fscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent fscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The fscanf_s function is equivalent to fscanf except that the c, s, and [ conversion specifiers apply to a pair of arguments (unless assignment suppression is indicated by a @@ -27578,7 +28913,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A matching failure occurs if the number of elements in a receiving object is insufficient to hold the converted input (including any trailing null character). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The fscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -27593,10 +28928,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ int n, i; float x; char name[50]; - n = fscanf_s(stdin, "%d%f%s", &i, &x, name, (rsize_t) 50); + n = fscanf_s(stdin, "%d%f%s", &i, &x, name, (rsize_t) 50); + with the input line:

    -          25 54.32E-1 thompson
    + 25 54.32E-1 thompson + will assign to n the value 3, to i the value 25, to x the value 5.432, and to name the sequence thompson\0. @@ -27607,15 +28944,17 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. #include <stdio.h> /* ... */ int n; char s[5]; - n = fscanf_s(stdin, "%s", s, sizeof s); + n = fscanf_s(stdin, "%s", s, sizeof s); + with the input line:
    -          hello
    + hello + will assign to n the value 0 since a matching failure occurred because the sequence hello\0 requires an array of six characters to store it. -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    379) Because an implementation may treat any undefined behavior as a runtime-constraint violation, an implementation may treat any unsupported specifiers in the string pointed to by format as a runtime- constraint violation. @@ -27633,12 +28972,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.5.3.3 The printf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
               #include <stdio.h>
    -          int printf_s(const char * restrict format, ...);
    + int printf_s(const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. The %n specifier381) (modified or not by flags, field @@ -27651,28 +28991,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The printf_s function is equivalent to the printf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The printf_s function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    381) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.4 The scanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
    -        int scanf_s(const char * restrict format, ...);
    + int scanf_s(const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order to store @@ -27681,11 +29022,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the scanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent scanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The scanf_s function is equivalent to fscanf_s with the argument stdin interposed before the arguments to scanf_s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The scanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -27693,13 +29034,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure.

    K.3.5.3.5 The snprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
             int snprintf_s(char * restrict s, rsize_t n,
    -             const char * restrict format, ...);
    + const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -27712,14 +29054,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the snprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The snprintf_s function is equivalent to the snprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The snprintf_s function, unlike sprintf_s, will truncate the result to fit within the array pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The snprintf_s function returns the number of characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating null character, or a @@ -27727,20 +29069,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. output has been completely written if and only if the returned value is nonnegative and less than n. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    382) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.6 The sprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
               #include <stdio.h>
               int sprintf_s(char * restrict s, rsize_t n,
    -               const char * restrict format, ...);
    + const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -27757,34 +29100,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the sprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The sprintf_s function is equivalent to the sprintf function except for the parameter n and the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The sprintf_s function, unlike snprintf_s, treats a result too big for the array pointed to by s as a runtime-constraint violation. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If no runtime-constraint violation occurred, the sprintf_s function returns the number of characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null character. If an encoding error occurred, sprintf_s returns a negative value. If any other runtime- constraint violation occurred, sprintf_s returns zero. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    383) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.7 The sscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
             int sscanf_s(const char * restrict s,
    -             const char * restrict format, ...);
    + const char * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order @@ -27793,13 +29137,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the sscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent sscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The sscanf_s function is equivalent to fscanf_s, except that input is obtained from a string (specified by the argument s) rather than from a stream. Reaching the end of the string is equivalent to encountering end-of-file for the fscanf_s function. If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the objects take on unspecified values. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The sscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -27808,7 +29152,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.5.3.8 The vfprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -27816,7 +29160,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               #include <stdio.h>
               int vfprintf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
                    const char * restrict format,
    -               va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. The %n specifier384) (modified or @@ -27827,23 +29172,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vfprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent vfprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vfprintf_s function is equivalent to the vfprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vfprintf_s function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    384) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.9 The vfscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -27851,7 +29196,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               #include <stdio.h>
               int vfscanf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
                    const char * restrict format,
    -               va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + @@ -27865,34 +29211,35 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vfscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vfscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -
    Description
    +

    Description

    The vfscanf_s function is equivalent to fscanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfscanf_s function does not invoke the va_end macro.385) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vfscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the vfscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    385) As the functions vfprintf_s, vfscanf_s, vprintf_s, vscanf_s, vsnprintf_s, vsprintf_s, and vsscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

    K.3.5.3.10 The vprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
               #include <stdarg.h>
               #include <stdio.h>
               int vprintf_s(const char * restrict format,
    -               va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. The %n specifier386) (modified or not by flags, field @@ -27904,30 +29251,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vprintf_s function is equivalent to the vprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vprintf_s function returns the number of characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    386) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.11 The vscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdarg.h>
              #include <stdio.h>
              int vscanf_s(const char * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order to store @@ -27936,13 +29284,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vscanf_s function is equivalent to scanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vscanf_s function does not invoke the va_end macro.387) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -27954,14 +29302,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    387) As the functions vfprintf_s, vfscanf_s, vprintf_s, vscanf_s, vsnprintf_s, vsprintf_s, and vsscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

    K.3.5.3.12 The vsnprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -27969,7 +29317,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               #include <stdio.h>
               int vsnprintf_s(char * restrict s, rsize_t n,
                    const char * restrict format,
    -               va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -27981,14 +29330,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the vsnprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vsnprintf_s function is equivalent to the vsnprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The vsnprintf_s function, unlike vsprintf_s, will truncate the result to fit within the array pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vsnprintf_s function returns the number of characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating null character, or a @@ -28001,14 +29350,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    388) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.13 The vsprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28016,7 +29365,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               #include <stdio.h>
               int vsprintf_s(char * restrict s, rsize_t n,
                    const char * restrict format,
    -               va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -28029,14 +29379,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the vsprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vsprintf_s function is equivalent to the vsprintf function except for the parameter n and the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The vsprintf_s function, unlike vsnprintf_s, treats a result too big for the array pointed to by s as a runtime-constraint violation. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If no runtime-constraint violation occurred, the vsprintf_s function returns the number of characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null character. If @@ -28048,14 +29398,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    389) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the characters %n to appear in sequence in the string pointed at by format when those characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was %%n.

    K.3.5.3.14 The vsscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28063,7 +29413,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
             #include <stdio.h>
             int vsscanf_s(const char * restrict s,
                  const char * restrict format,
    -             va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order @@ -28072,20 +29423,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vsscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vsscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vsscanf_s function is equivalent to sscanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vsscanf_s function does not invoke the va_end macro.390) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vsscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the vscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    390) As the functions vfprintf_s, vfscanf_s, vprintf_s, vscanf_s, vsnprintf_s, vsprintf_s, and vsscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate. @@ -28094,12 +29445,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.5.4 Character input/output functions
    K.3.5.4.1 The gets_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <stdio.h>
    -        char *gets_s(char *s, rsize_t n);
    + char *gets_s(char *s, rsize_t n); + @@ -28114,7 +29466,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, s[0] is set to the null character, and characters are read and discarded from stdin until a new-line character is read, or end-of-file or a read error occurs. -
    Description
    +

    Description

    The gets_s function reads at most one less than the number of characters specified by n from the stream pointed to by stdin, into the array pointed to by s. No additional @@ -28125,14 +29477,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If end-of-file is encountered and no characters have been read into the array, or if a read error occurs during the operation, then s[0] is set to the null character, and the other elements of s take unspecified values. -

    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice

    The fgets function allows properly-written programs to safely process input lines too long to store in the result array. In general this requires that callers of fgets pay attention to the presence or absence of a new-line character in the result array. Consider using fgets (along with any needed processing based on new-line characters) instead of gets_s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The gets_s function returns s if successful. If there was a runtime-constraint violation, or if end-of-file is encountered and no characters have been read into the array, or if a @@ -28143,7 +29495,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    391) The gets_s function, unlike the historical gets function, makes it a runtime-constraint violation for a line of input to overflow the buffer to store it. Unlike the fgets function, gets_s maintains a one-to-one relationship between input lines and successful calls to gets_s. Programs that use gets @@ -28156,31 +29508,36 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The types are

    -         errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int; and
    -         rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t; and
    -         constraint_handler_t
    + constraint_handler_t + which has the following definition
              typedef void (*constraint_handler_t)(
                   const char * restrict msg,
                   void * restrict ptr,
    -              errno_t error);
    + errno_t error); +
    K.3.6.1 Runtime-constraint handling
    K.3.6.1.1 The set_constraint_handler_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdlib.h>
              constraint_handler_t set_constraint_handler_s(
    -              constraint_handler_t handler);
    -
    Description
    + constraint_handler_t handler); + +

    Description

    The set_constraint_handler_s function sets the runtime-constraint handler to be handler. The runtime-constraint handler is the function to be called when a library @@ -28204,18 +29561,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If the handler argument to set_constraint_handler_s is a null pointer, the implementation default handler becomes the current constraint handler. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The set_constraint_handler_s function returns a pointer to the previously registered handler.392) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    392) If the previous handler was registered by calling set_constraint_handler_s with a null pointer argument, a pointer to the implementation default handler is returned (not NULL).

    K.3.6.1.2 The abort_handler_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28223,8 +29580,9 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              void abort_handler_s(
                   const char * restrict msg,
                   void * restrict ptr,
    -              errno_t error);
    -
    Description
    + errno_t error); + +

    Description

    A pointer to the abort_handler_s function shall be a suitable argument to the set_constraint_handler_s function. @@ -28232,7 +29590,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. The abort_handler_s function writes a message on the standard error stream in an implementation-defined format. The message shall include the string pointed to by msg. The abort_handler_s function then calls the abort function.393) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The abort_handler_s function does not return to its caller. @@ -28241,12 +29599,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    393) Many implementations invoke a debugger when the abort function is called.

    K.3.6.1.3 The ignore_handler_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28254,18 +29612,19 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              void ignore_handler_s(
                   const char * restrict msg,
                   void * restrict ptr,
    -              errno_t error);
    -
    Description
    + errno_t error); + +

    Description

    A pointer to the ignore_handler_s function shall be a suitable argument to the set_constraint_handler_s function.

    The ignore_handler_s function simply returns to its caller.394) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ignore_handler_s function returns no value. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    394) If the runtime-constraint handler is set to the ignore_handler_s function, any library function in which a runtime-constraint violation occurs will return to its caller. The caller can determine whether a runtime-constraint violation occurred based on the library function's specification (usually, the @@ -28275,14 +29634,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.6.2 Communication with the environment
    K.3.6.2.1 The getenv_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdlib.h>
              errno_t getenv_s(size_t * restrict len,
                         char * restrict value, rsize_t maxsize,
    -                    const char * restrict name);
    + const char * restrict name); + Runtime-constraints

    name shall not be a null pointer. maxsize shall neither equal zero nor be greater than @@ -28290,7 +29650,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the integer pointed to by len is set to 0 (if len is not null), and the environment list is not searched. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The getenv_s function searches an environment list, provided by the host environment, for a string that matches the string pointed to by name. @@ -28309,7 +29669,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The set of environment names and the method for altering the environment list are implementation-defined. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The getenv_s function returns zero if the specified name is found and the associated string was successfully stored in value. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -28346,17 +29706,18 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. comparison function, and also between any call to the comparison function and any movement of the objects passed as arguments to that call. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    395) That is, if the value passed is p, then the following expressions are always valid and nonzero:

               ((char *)p - (char *)base) % size == 0
               (char *)p >= (char *)base
    -          (char *)p < (char *)base + nmemb * size
    + (char *)p < (char *)base + nmemb * size +
    K.3.6.3.1 The bsearch_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28365,7 +29726,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
                    rsize_t nmemb, rsize_t size,
                    int (*compar)(const void *k, const void *y,
                                    void *context),
    -               void *context);
    + void *context); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither nmemb nor size shall be greater than RSIZE_MAX. If nmemb is not equal to @@ -28373,7 +29735,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the bsearch_s function does not search the array. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The bsearch_s function searches an array of nmemb objects, the initial element of which is pointed to by base, for an element that matches the object pointed to by key. @@ -28393,13 +29755,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The bsearch_s function returns a pointer to a matching element of the array, or a null pointer if no match is found or there is a runtime-constraint violation. If two elements compare as equal, which element is matched is unspecified. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    396) In practice, this means that the entire array has been sorted according to the comparison function.

    397) The context argument is for the use of the comparison function in performing its duties. For @@ -28407,7 +29769,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.6.3.2 The qsort_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28415,14 +29777,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t qsort_s(void *base, rsize_t nmemb, rsize_t size,
                   int (*compar)(const void *x, const void *y,
                                   void *context),
    -              void *context);
    + void *context); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither nmemb nor size shall be greater than RSIZE_MAX. If nmemb is not equal to zero, then neither base nor compar shall be a null pointer.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the qsort_s function does not sort the array. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The qsort_s function sorts an array of nmemb objects, the initial element of which is pointed to by base. The size of each object is specified by size. @@ -28437,7 +29800,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If two elements compare as equal, their relative order in the resulting sorted array is unspecified. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The qsort_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -28447,7 +29810,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    398) The context argument is for the use of the comparison function in performing its duties. For example, it might specify a collating sequence used by the comparison function. @@ -28463,13 +29826,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. encodings have state dependency, and zero otherwise.399) Changing the LC_CTYPE category causes the conversion state of these functions to be indeterminate. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    399) If the locale employs special bytes to change the shift state, these bytes do not produce separate wide character codes, but are grouped with an adjacent multibyte character.

    K.3.6.4.1 The wctomb_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28477,7 +29840,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t wctomb_s(int * restrict status,
                   char * restrict s,
                   rsize_t smax,
    -              wchar_t wc);
    + wchar_t wc); + Runtime-constraints

    Let n denote the number of bytes needed to represent the multibyte character @@ -28489,7 +29853,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, wctomb_s does not modify the int pointed to by status, and if s is not a null pointer, no more than smax elements in the array pointed to by s will be accessed. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wctomb_s function determines n and stores the multibyte character representation of wc in the array whose first element is pointed to by s (if s is not a null pointer). The @@ -28514,7 +29878,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    In no case will the int pointed to by status be set to a value greater than the MB_CUR_MAX macro. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wctomb_s function returns zero if successful, and a nonzero value if there was a runtime-constraint violation or wc did not correspond to a valid multibyte character. @@ -28525,13 +29889,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. the current locale.

    K.3.6.5.1 The mbstowcs_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <stdlib.h>
              errno_t mbstowcs_s(size_t * restrict retval,
                   wchar_t * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax,
    -              const char * restrict src, rsize_t len);
    + const char * restrict src, rsize_t len); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither retval nor src shall be a null pointer. If dst is not a null pointer, then @@ -28544,7 +29909,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. retval is not a null pointer, then mbstowcs_s sets *retval to (size_t)(-1). If dst is not a null pointer and dstmax is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then mbstowcs_s sets dst[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The mbstowcs_s function converts a sequence of multibyte characters that begins in the initial shift state from the array pointed to by src into a sequence of corresponding @@ -28570,12 +29935,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the objects take on unspecified values. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The mbstowcs_s function returns zero if no runtime-constraint violation and no encoding error occurred. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    400) Thus, the value of len is ignored if dst is a null pointer.

    401) This allows an implementation to attempt converting the multibyte string before discovering a @@ -28583,13 +29948,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.6.5.2 The wcstombs_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #include <stdlib.h>
               errno_t wcstombs_s(size_t * restrict retval,
                    char * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax,
    -               const wchar_t * restrict src, rsize_t len);
    + const wchar_t * restrict src, rsize_t len); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither retval nor src shall be a null pointer. If dst is not a null pointer, then @@ -28608,7 +29974,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. retval is not a null pointer, then wcstombs_s sets *retval to (size_t)(-1). If dst is not a null pointer and dstmax is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then wcstombs_s sets dst[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcstombs_s function converts a sequence of wide characters from the array pointed to by src into a sequence of corresponding multibyte characters that begins in @@ -28644,12 +30010,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcstombs_s function returns zero if no runtime-constraint violation and no encoding error occurred. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    402) If conversion stops because a terminating null wide character has been reached, the bytes stored include those necessary to reach the initial shift state immediately before the null byte. However, if the conversion stops before a terminating null wide character has been reached, the result will be null @@ -28665,22 +30031,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The types are

    -        errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int; and
    -        rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t.
    K.3.7.1 Copying functions
    K.3.7.1.1 The memcpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <string.h>
             errno_t memcpy_s(void * restrict s1, rsize_t s1max,
    -             const void * restrict s2, rsize_t n);
    + const void * restrict s2, rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -28690,24 +30059,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the memcpy_s function stores zeros in the first s1max characters of the object pointed to by s1 if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The memcpy_s function copies n characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The memcpy_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned.

    K.3.7.1.2 The memmove_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
              errno_t memmove_s(void *s1, rsize_t s1max,
    -              const void *s2, rsize_t n);
    + const void *s2, rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -28716,27 +30086,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the memmove_s function stores zeros in the first s1max characters of the object pointed to by s1 if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The memmove_s function copies n characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. This copying takes place as if the n characters from the object pointed to by s2 are first copied into a temporary array of n characters that does not overlap the objects pointed to by s1 or s2, and then the n characters from the temporary array are copied into the object pointed to by s1. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The memmove_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned.

    K.3.7.1.3 The strcpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
              errno_t strcpy_s(char * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
    -              const char * restrict s2);
    + const char * restrict s2); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. s1max shall not be greater than RSIZE_MAX. @@ -28747,7 +30118,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then strcpy_s sets s1[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The strcpy_s function copies the string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null character) into the array pointed to by s1. @@ -28755,12 +30126,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null character (if any) written by strcpy_s in the array of s1max characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when strcpy_s returns.404) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strcpy_s function returns zero405) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    404) This allows an implementation to copy characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if any of those characters are null. Such an approach might write a character to every element of s1 before discovering that the first element should be set to the null character. @@ -28770,7 +30141,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.7.1.4 The strncpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28778,7 +30149,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t strncpy_s(char * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
                   const char * restrict s2,
    -              rsize_t n);
    + rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -28789,7 +30161,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then strncpy_s sets s1[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The strncpy_s function copies not more than n successive characters (characters that follow a null character are not copied) from the array pointed to by s2 to the array @@ -28802,7 +30174,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null character (if any) written by strncpy_s in the array of s1max characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when strncpy_s returns.406) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strncpy_s function returns zero407) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -28819,13 +30191,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int r1, r2, r3; r1 = strncpy_s(dst1, 6, src1, 100); r2 = strncpy_s(dst2, 5, src2, 7); - r3 = strncpy_s(dst3, 5, src2, 4); + r3 = strncpy_s(dst3, 5, src2, 4); + The first call will assign to r1 the value zero and to dst1 the sequence hello\0. The second call will assign to r2 a nonzero value and to dst2 the sequence \0. The third call will assign to r3 the value zero and to dst3 the sequence good\0. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    406) This allows an implementation to copy characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if any of those characters are null. Such an approach might write a character to every element of s1 before discovering that the first element should be set to the null character. @@ -28837,14 +30210,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.7.2 Concatenation functions
    K.3.7.2.1 The strcat_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
              errno_t strcat_s(char * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
    -              const char * restrict s2);
    + const char * restrict s2); + Runtime-constraints

    Let m denote the value s1max - strnlen_s(s1, s1max) upon entry to @@ -28862,7 +30236,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then strcat_s sets s1[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The strcat_s function appends a copy of the string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null character) to the end of the string pointed to by s1. The initial character @@ -28871,12 +30245,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null character (if any) written by strcat_s in the array of s1max characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when strcat_s returns.409) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strcat_s function returns zero410) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    408) Zero means that s1 was not null terminated upon entry to strcat_s.

    409) This allows an implementation to append characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if @@ -28888,7 +30262,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.7.2.2 The strncat_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28896,7 +30270,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t strncat_s(char * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
                   const char * restrict s2,
    -              rsize_t n);
    + rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Let m denote the value s1max - strnlen_s(s1, s1max) upon entry to @@ -28913,7 +30288,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then strncat_s sets s1[0] to the null character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The strncat_s function appends not more than n successive characters (characters that follow a null character are not copied) from the array pointed to by s2 to the end of @@ -28924,7 +30299,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null character (if any) written by strncat_s in the array of s1max characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when strncat_s returns.412) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strncat_s function returns zero413) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -28944,7 +30319,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. r1 = strncat_s(s1, 100, s5, 1000); r2 = strncat_s(s2, 6, "", 1); r3 = strncat_s(s3, 6, "X", 2); - r4 = strncat_s(s4, 7, "defghijklmn", 3); + r4 = strncat_s(s4, 7, "defghijklmn", 3); + After the first call r1 will have the value zero and s1 will contain the sequence goodbye\0. @@ -28955,7 +30331,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. After the fourth call r4 will have the value zero and s4 will contain the sequence abcdef\0. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    411) Zero means that s1 was not null terminated upon entry to strncat_s.

    412) This allows an implementation to append characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if @@ -28969,7 +30345,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.7.3 Search functions
    K.3.7.3.1 The strtok_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -28977,7 +30353,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              char *strtok_s(char * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t * restrict s1max,
                   const char * restrict s2,
    -              char ** restrict ptr);
    + char ** restrict ptr); + Runtime-constraints

    None of s1max, s2, or ptr shall be a null pointer. If s1 is a null pointer, then *ptr @@ -28988,7 +30365,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the strtok_s function does not indirect through the s1 or s2 pointers, and does not store a value in the object pointed to by ptr. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    A sequence of calls to the strtok_s function breaks the string pointed to by s1 into a sequence of tokens, each of which is delimited by a character from the string pointed to @@ -29021,7 +30398,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. to by ptr so that subsequent calls, with a null pointer for s1 and the unmodified pointer value for ptr, shall start searching just past the element overwritten by a null character (if any). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strtok_s function returns a pointer to the first character of a token, or a null pointer if there is no token or there is a runtime-constraint violation. @@ -29039,18 +30416,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. t = strtok_s(NULL, &max1, ",", &ptr1); // t points to the token "??b" t = strtok_s(str2, &max2, " \t", &ptr2); // t is a null pointer t = strtok_s(NULL, &max1, "#,", &ptr1); // t points to the token "c" - t = strtok_s(NULL, &max1, "?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer + t = strtok_s(NULL, &max1, "?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer +

    K.3.7.4 Miscellaneous functions
    K.3.7.4.1 The memset_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
    -         errno_t memset_s(void *s, rsize_t smax, int c, rsize_t n)
    + errno_t memset_s(void *s, rsize_t smax, int c, rsize_t n) + Runtime-constraints

    s shall not be a null pointer. Neither smax nor n shall be greater than RSIZE_MAX. n @@ -29060,7 +30439,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. greater than RSIZE_MAX, the memset_s function stores the value of c (converted to an unsigned char) into each of the first smax characters of the object pointed to by s. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The memset_s function copies the value of c (converted to an unsigned char) into each of the first n characters of the object pointed to by s. Unlike memset, any call to @@ -29068,19 +30447,20 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. machine as described in (5.1.2.3). That is, any call to the memset_s function shall assume that the memory indicated by s and n may be accessible in the future and thus must contain the values indicated by c. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The memset_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned.

    K.3.7.4.2 The strerror_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <string.h>
             errno_t strerror_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize,
    -             errno_t errnum);
    + errno_t errnum); + Runtime-constraints

    s shall not be a null pointer. maxsize shall not be greater than RSIZE_MAX. @@ -29088,7 +30468,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then the array (if any) pointed to by s is not modified. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The strerror_s function maps the number in errnum to a locale-specific message string. Typically, the values for errnum come from errno, but strerror_s shall @@ -29101,7 +30481,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. from the string to the array pointed to by s and then s[maxsize-1] is set to the null character. Then, if maxsize is greater than 3, then s[maxsize-2], s[maxsize-3], and s[maxsize-4] are set to the character period (.). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strerror_s function returns zero if the length of the desired string was less than maxsize and there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the strerror_s @@ -29109,32 +30489,34 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.7.4.3 The strerrorlen_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
    -         size_t strerrorlen_s(errno_t errnum);
    -
    Description
    + size_t strerrorlen_s(errno_t errnum); + +

    Description

    The strerrorlen_s function calculates the length of the (untruncated) locale-specific message string that the strerror_s function maps to errnum. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The strerrorlen_s function returns the number of characters (not including the null character) in the full message string.

    K.3.7.4.4 The strnlen_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <string.h>
    -         size_t strnlen_s(const char *s, size_t maxsize);
    -
    Description
    + size_t strnlen_s(const char *s, size_t maxsize); + +

    Description

    The strnlen_s function computes the length of the string pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If s is a null pointer,414) then the strnlen_s function returns zero.

    @@ -29148,7 +30530,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    414) Note that the strnlen_s function has no runtime-constraints. This lack of runtime-constraints along with the values returned for a null pointer or an unterminated string argument make strnlen_s useful in algorithms that gracefully handle such exceptional data. @@ -29160,10 +30542,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The types are

    -         errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int; and
    -         rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t.
    K.3.8.1 Components of time
    @@ -29171,7 +30555,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. A broken-down time is normalized if the values of the members of the tm structure are in their normal rages.415) -
    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    415) The normal ranges are defined in 7.26.1. @@ -29181,13 +30565,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. pointer to a static object, and other library functions are permitted to call them.

    K.3.8.2.1 The asctime_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <time.h>
              errno_t asctime_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize,
    -              const struct tm *timeptr);
    + const struct tm *timeptr); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor timeptr shall be a null pointer. maxsize shall not be less than 26 and @@ -29199,7 +30584,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, there is no attempt to convert the time, and s[0] is set to a null character if s is not a null pointer and maxsize is not zero and is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The asctime_s function converts the normalized broken-down time in the structure pointed to by timeptr into a 26 character (including the null character) string in the @@ -29208,7 +30593,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. form

    -         Sun Sep 16 01:03:52 1973\n\0
    + Sun Sep 16 01:03:52 1973\n\0 + The fields making up this string are (in order):
    1. The name of the day of the week represented by timeptr->tm_wday using the @@ -29235,24 +30621,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
    2. The character new line.
    3. The null character.
    -
    Recommended practice
    +

    Recommended practice The strftime function allows more flexible formatting and supports locale-specific behavior. If you do not require the exact form of the result string produced by the asctime_s function, consider using the strftime function instead. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The asctime_s function returns zero if the time was successfully converted and stored into the array pointed to by s. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

    K.3.8.2.2 The ctime_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <time.h>
             errno_t ctime_s(char *s, rsize_t maxsize,
    -             const time_t *timer);
    + const time_t *timer); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor timer shall be a null pointer. maxsize shall not be less than 26 and @@ -29260,64 +30647,67 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, s[0] is set to a null character if s is not a null pointer and maxsize is not equal zero and is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The ctime_s function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer to local time in the form of a string. It is equivalent to

    -        asctime_s(s, maxsize, localtime_s(timer))
    -
    Recommended practice
    + asctime_s(s, maxsize, localtime_s(timer)) + +

    Recommended practice The strftime function allows more flexible formatting and supports locale-specific behavior. If you do not require the exact form of the result string produced by the ctime_s function, consider using the strftime function instead. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The ctime_s function returns zero if the time was successfully converted and stored into the array pointed to by s. Otherwise, it returns a nonzero value.

    K.3.8.2.3 The gmtime_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <time.h>
             struct tm *gmtime_s(const time_t * restrict timer,
    -             struct tm * restrict result);
    + struct tm * restrict result); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither timer nor result shall be a null pointer.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, there is no attempt to convert the time. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The gmtime_s function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer into a broken- down time, expressed as UTC. The broken-down time is stored in the structure pointed to by result. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The gmtime_s function returns result, or a null pointer if the specified time cannot be converted to UTC or there is a runtime-constraint violation.

    K.3.8.2.4 The localtime_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
               #include <time.h>
               struct tm *localtime_s(const time_t * restrict timer,
    -               struct tm * restrict result);
    + struct tm * restrict result); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither timer nor result shall be a null pointer.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, there is no attempt to convert the time. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The localtime_s function converts the calendar time pointed to by timer into a broken-down time, expressed as local time. The broken-down time is stored in the structure pointed to by result. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The localtime_s function returns result, or a null pointer if the specified time cannot be converted to local time or there is a runtime-constraint violation. @@ -29328,10 +30718,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    The types are

    -          errno_t
    + errno_t + which is type int; and
    -          rsize_t
    + rsize_t + which is the type size_t.

    Unless explicitly stated otherwise, if the execution of a function described in this @@ -29342,13 +30734,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.1 Formatted wide character input/output functions
    K.3.9.1.1 The fwprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
              int fwprintf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. The %n specifier416) (modified or @@ -29359,30 +30752,31 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the fwprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent fwprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The fwprintf_s function is equivalent to the fwprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The fwprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    416) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.2 The fwscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdio.h>
              #include <wchar.h>
              int fwscanf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in @@ -29394,7 +30788,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the fwscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent fwscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The fwscanf_s function is equivalent to fwscanf except that the c, s, and [ conversion specifiers apply to a pair of arguments (unless assignment suppression is @@ -29406,14 +30800,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    A matching failure occurs if the number of elements in a receiving object is insufficient to hold the converted input (including any trailing null character). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The fwscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the fwscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    417) If the format is known at translation time, an implementation may issue a diagnostic for any argument used to store the result from a c, s, or [ conversion specifier if that argument is not followed by an argument of a type compatible with rsize_t. A limited amount of checking may be done if even if @@ -29427,14 +30821,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.1.3 The snwprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
              int snwprintf_s(wchar_t * restrict s,
                   rsize_t n,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -29448,14 +30843,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the snwprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The snwprintf_s function is equivalent to the swprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The snwprintf_s function, unlike swprintf_s, will truncate the result to fit within the array pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The snwprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating wide null @@ -29463,20 +30858,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. terminated output has been completely written if and only if the returned value is nonnegative and less than n. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    418) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.4 The swprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
              int swprintf_s(wchar_t * restrict s, rsize_t n,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -29492,14 +30888,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the swprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The swprintf_s function is equivalent to the swprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The swprintf_s function, unlike snwprintf_s, treats a result too big for the array pointed to by s as a runtime-constraint violation. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If no runtime-constraint violation occurred, the swprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null wide @@ -29507,20 +30903,21 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. be written, swprintf_s returns a negative value. If any other runtime-constraint violation occurred, swprintf_s returns zero. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    419) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.5 The swscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
              int swscanf_s(const wchar_t * restrict s,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order @@ -29529,13 +30926,13 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the swscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent swscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The swscanf_s function is equivalent to fwscanf_s, except that the argument s specifies a wide string from which the input is to be obtained, rather than from a stream. Reaching the end of the wide string is equivalent to encountering end-of-file for the fwscanf_s function. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The swscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -29544,7 +30941,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.1.6 The vfwprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29553,7 +30950,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              #include <wchar.h>
              int vfwprintf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
                   const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither stream nor format shall be a null pointer. The %n specifier420) (modified or @@ -29564,23 +30962,23 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vfwprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent vfwprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vfwprintf_s function is equivalent to the vfwprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vfwprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    420) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.7 The vfwscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29588,7 +30986,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              #include <stdio.h>
              #include <wchar.h>
              int vfwscanf_s(FILE * restrict stream,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict format, va_list arg);
    + const wchar_t * restrict format, va_list arg); + @@ -29601,26 +31000,26 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vfwscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vfwscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -
    Description
    +

    Description

    The vfwscanf_s function is equivalent to fwscanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vfwscanf_s function does not invoke the va_end macro.421) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vfwscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the vfwscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    421) As the functions vfwscanf_s, vwscanf_s, and vswscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

    K.3.9.1.8 The vsnwprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29629,7 +31028,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              int vsnwprintf_s(wchar_t * restrict s,
                   rsize_t n,
                   const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -29643,14 +31043,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s is not a null pointer and n is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then the vsnwprintf_s function sets s[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vsnwprintf_s function is equivalent to the vswprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The vsnwprintf_s function, unlike vswprintf_s, will truncate the result to fit within the array pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vsnwprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters that would have been written had n been sufficiently large, not counting the terminating null character, or @@ -29658,14 +31058,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. output has been completely written if and only if the returned value is nonnegative and less than n. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    422) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.9 The vswprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29674,7 +31074,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              int vswprintf_s(wchar_t * restrict s,
                   rsize_t n,
                   const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. n shall neither equal zero nor be greater @@ -29689,14 +31090,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vswprintf_s function is equivalent to the vswprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above.

    The vswprintf_s function, unlike vsnwprintf_s, treats a result too big for the array pointed to by s as a runtime-constraint violation. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If no runtime-constraint violation occurred, the vswprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters written in the array, not counting the terminating null wide @@ -29704,14 +31105,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. be written, vswprintf_s returns a negative value. If any other runtime-constraint violation occurred, vswprintf_s returns zero. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    423) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.10 The vswscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29719,7 +31120,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              #include <wchar.h>
              int vswscanf_s(const wchar_t * restrict s,
                   const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s nor format shall be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order @@ -29728,7 +31130,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vswscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vswscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vswscanf_s function is equivalent to swscanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and @@ -29739,27 +31141,28 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vswscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the vswscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    424) As the functions vfwscanf_s, vwscanf_s, and vswscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

    K.3.9.1.11 The vwprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdarg.h>
              #include <wchar.h>
              int vwprintf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. The %n specifier425) (modified or not by flags, field @@ -29769,11 +31172,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vwprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent vwprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vwprintf_s function is equivalent to the vwprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vwprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. @@ -29783,21 +31186,22 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    425) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.12 The vwscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <stdarg.h>
              #include <wchar.h>
              int vwscanf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format,
    -              va_list arg);
    + va_list arg); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order to store @@ -29806,31 +31210,32 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the vwscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent vwscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The vwscanf_s function is equivalent to wscanf_s, with the variable argument list replaced by arg, which shall have been initialized by the va_start macro (and possibly subsequent va_arg calls). The vwscanf_s function does not invoke the va_end macro.426) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The vwscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the vwscanf_s function returns the number of input items assigned, which can be fewer than provided for, or even zero, in the event of an early matching failure. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    426) As the functions vfwscanf_s, vwscanf_s, and vswscanf_s invoke the va_arg macro, the value of arg after the return is indeterminate.

    K.3.9.1.13 The wprintf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
    -         int wprintf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + int wprintf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. The %n specifier427) (modified or not by flags, field @@ -29842,28 +31247,29 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the wprintf_s function does not attempt to produce further output, and it is unspecified to what extent wprintf_s produced output before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wprintf_s function is equivalent to the wprintf function except for the explicit runtime-constraints listed above. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wprintf_s function returns the number of wide characters transmitted, or a negative value if an output error, encoding error, or runtime-constraint violation occurred. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    427) It is not a runtime-constraint violation for the wide characters %n to appear in sequence in the wide string pointed at by format when those wide characters are not a interpreted as a %n specifier. For example, if the entire format string was L"%%n".

    K.3.9.1.14 The wscanf_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <wchar.h>
    -        int wscanf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...);
    + int wscanf_s(const wchar_t * restrict format, ...); + Runtime-constraints

    format shall not be a null pointer. Any argument indirected though in order to store @@ -29872,11 +31278,11 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the wscanf_s function does not attempt to perform further input, and it is unspecified to what extent wscanf_s performed input before discovering the runtime-constraint violation. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wscanf_s function is equivalent to fwscanf_s with the argument stdin interposed before the arguments to wscanf_s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wscanf_s function returns the value of the macro EOF if an input failure occurs before any conversion or if there is a runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, the @@ -29889,14 +31295,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.1 Wide string copying functions
    K.3.9.2.1.1 The wcscpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
              #include <wchar.h>
              errno_t wcscpy_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
    -              const wchar_t * restrict s2);
    + const wchar_t * restrict s2); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. s1max shall not be greater than RSIZE_MAX. @@ -29906,7 +31313,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then wcscpy_s sets s1[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcscpy_s function copies the wide string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null wide character) into the array pointed to by s1. @@ -29914,7 +31321,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null wide character (if any) written by wcscpy_s in the array of s1max wide characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when wcscpy_s returns.428) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcscpy_s function returns zero429) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -29924,7 +31331,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    428) This allows an implementation to copy wide characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if any of those wide characters are null. Such an approach might write a wide character to every element of s1 before discovering that the first element should be set to the null wide character. @@ -29934,7 +31341,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.1.2 The wcsncpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -29942,7 +31349,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t wcsncpy_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
                   const wchar_t * restrict s2,
    -              rsize_t n);
    + rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -29953,7 +31361,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then wcsncpy_s sets s1[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcsncpy_s function copies not more than n successive wide characters (wide characters that follow a null wide character are not copied) from the array pointed to by @@ -29963,7 +31371,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null wide character (if any) written by wcsncpy_s in the array of s1max wide characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when wcsncpy_s returns.430) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcsncpy_s function returns zero431) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -29986,13 +31394,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. int r1, r2, r3; r1 = wcsncpy_s(dst1, 6, src1, 100); r2 = wcsncpy_s(dst2, 5, src2, 7); - r3 = wcsncpy_s(dst3, 5, src2, 4); + r3 = wcsncpy_s(dst3, 5, src2, 4); + The first call will assign to r1 the value zero and to dst1 the sequence of wide characters hello\0. The second call will assign to r2 a nonzero value and to dst2 the sequence of wide characters \0. The third call will assign to r3 the value zero and to dst3 the sequence of wide characters good\0. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    430) This allows an implementation to copy wide characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously checking if any of those wide characters are null. Such an approach might write a wide character to every element of s1 before discovering that the first element should be set to the null wide character. @@ -30002,7 +31411,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.1.3 The wmemcpy_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -30010,7 +31419,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              errno_t wmemcpy_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t s1max,
                   const wchar_t * restrict s2,
    -              rsize_t n);
    + rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -30020,24 +31430,25 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the wmemcpy_s function stores zeros in the first s1max wide characters of the object pointed to by s1 if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wmemcpy_s function copies n successive wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wmemcpy_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned.

    K.3.9.2.1.4 The wmemmove_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <wchar.h>
             errno_t wmemmove_s(wchar_t *s1, rsize_t s1max,
    -             const wchar_t *s2, rsize_t n);
    + const wchar_t *s2, rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither s1 nor s2 shall be a null pointer. Neither s1max nor n shall be greater than @@ -30046,14 +31457,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the wmemmove_s function stores zeros in the first s1max wide characters of the object pointed to by s1 if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is not greater than RSIZE_MAX. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wmemmove_s function copies n successive wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 into the object pointed to by s1. This copying takes place as if the n wide characters from the object pointed to by s2 are first copied into a temporary array of n wide characters that does not overlap the objects pointed to by s1 or s2, and then the n wide characters from the temporary array are copied into the object pointed to by s1. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wmemmove_s function returns zero if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -30061,14 +31472,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.2 Wide string concatenation functions
    K.3.9.2.2.1 The wcscat_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <wchar.h>
             errno_t wcscat_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                  rsize_t s1max,
    -             const wchar_t * restrict s2);
    + const wchar_t * restrict s2); + Runtime-constraints

    Let m denote the value s1max - wcsnlen_s(s1, s1max) upon entry to @@ -30082,7 +31494,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then wcscat_s sets s1[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcscat_s function appends a copy of the wide string pointed to by s2 (including the terminating null wide character) to the end of the wide string pointed to by s1. The @@ -30091,12 +31503,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null wide character (if any) written by wcscat_s in the array of s1max wide characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when wcscat_s returns.433) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcscat_s function returns zero434) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    432) Zero means that s1 was not null terminated upon entry to wcscat_s.

    433) This allows an implementation to append wide characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously @@ -30108,7 +31520,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.2.2 The wcsncat_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -30116,7 +31528,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
               errno_t wcsncat_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                    rsize_t s1max,
                    const wchar_t * restrict s2,
    -               rsize_t n);
    + rsize_t n); + Runtime-constraints

    Let m denote the value s1max - wcsnlen_s(s1, s1max) upon entry to @@ -30133,7 +31546,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. If there is a runtime-constraint violation, then if s1 is not a null pointer and s1max is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then wcsncat_s sets s1[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcsncat_s function appends not more than n successive wide characters (wide characters that follow a null wide character are not copied) from the array pointed to by @@ -30144,7 +31557,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. All elements following the terminating null wide character (if any) written by wcsncat_s in the array of s1max wide characters pointed to by s1 take unspecified values when wcsncat_s returns.436) -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcsncat_s function returns zero437) if there was no runtime-constraint violation. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -30165,7 +31578,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. r1 = wcsncat_s(s1, 100, s5, 1000); r2 = wcsncat_s(s2, 6, L"", 1); r3 = wcsncat_s(s3, 6, L"X", 2); - r4 = wcsncat_s(s4, 7, L"defghijklmn", 3); + r4 = wcsncat_s(s4, 7, L"defghijklmn", 3); + After the first call r1 will have the value zero and s1 will be the wide character sequence goodbye\0. After the second call r2 will have the value zero and s2 will be the wide character sequence hello\0. After the third call r3 will have a nonzero value and s3 will be the wide character sequence \0. @@ -30176,7 +31590,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    435) Zero means that s1 was not null terminated upon entry to wcsncat_s.

    436) This allows an implementation to append wide characters from s2 to s1 while simultaneously @@ -30190,7 +31604,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.2.3 Wide string search functions
    K.3.9.2.3.1 The wcstok_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
    @@ -30198,7 +31612,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.
              wchar_t *wcstok_s(wchar_t * restrict s1,
                   rsize_t * restrict s1max,
                   const wchar_t * restrict s2,
    -              wchar_t ** restrict ptr);
    + wchar_t ** restrict ptr); + Runtime-constraints

    None of s1max, s2, or ptr shall be a null pointer. If s1 is a null pointer, then *ptr @@ -30209,7 +31624,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If there is a runtime-constraint violation, the wcstok_s function does not indirect through the s1 or s2 pointers, and does not store a value in the object pointed to by ptr. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    A sequence of calls to the wcstok_s function breaks the wide string pointed to by s1 into a sequence of tokens, each of which is delimited by a wide character from the wide @@ -30243,7 +31658,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. to by ptr so that subsequent calls, with a null pointer for s1 and the unmodified pointer value for ptr, shall start searching just past the element overwritten by a null wide character (if any). -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcstok_s function returns a pointer to the first wide character of a token, or a null pointer if there is no token or there is a runtime-constraint violation. @@ -30261,22 +31676,24 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. t = wcstok_s(NULL, &max1, ",", &ptr1); // t points to the token "??b" t = wcstok_s(str2, &max2, " \t", &ptr2); // t is a null pointer t = wcstok_s(NULL, &max1, "#,", &ptr1); // t points to the token "c" - t = wcstok_s(NULL, &max1, "?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer + t = wcstok_s(NULL, &max1, "?", &ptr1); // t is a null pointer +

    K.3.9.2.4 Miscellaneous functions
    K.3.9.2.4.1 The wcsnlen_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #define __STDC_WANT_LIB_EXT1__ 1
             #include <wchar.h>
    -        size_t wcsnlen_s(const wchar_t *s, size_t maxsize);
    -
    Description
    + size_t wcsnlen_s(const wchar_t *s, size_t maxsize); + +

    Description

    The wcsnlen_s function computes the length of the wide string pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    If s is a null pointer,438) then the wcsnlen_s function returns zero.

    @@ -30286,7 +31703,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. maxsize wide characters of s shall be accessed by wcsnlen_s. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    438) Note that the wcsnlen_s function has no runtime-constraints. This lack of runtime-constraints along with the values returned for a null pointer or an unterminated wide string argument make wcsnlen_s useful in algorithms that gracefully handle such exceptional data. @@ -30300,13 +31717,14 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversion state) to be a null pointer.

    K.3.9.3.1.1 The wcrtomb_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

              #include <wchar.h>
              errno_t wcrtomb_s(size_t * restrict retval,
                   char * restrict s, rsize_t smax,
    -              wchar_t wc, mbstate_t * restrict ps);
    + wchar_t wc, mbstate_t * restrict ps); + Runtime-constraints

    Neither retval nor ps shall be a null pointer. If s is not a null pointer, then smax @@ -30318,11 +31736,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. not a null pointer and smax is greater than zero and not greater than RSIZE_MAX, then wcrtomb_s sets s[0] to the null character. If retval is not a null pointer, then wcrtomb_s sets *retval to (size_t)(-1). -

    Description
    +

    Description

    If s is a null pointer, the wcrtomb_s function is equivalent to the call

    -                 wcrtomb_s(&retval, buf, sizeof buf, L'\0', ps)
    + wcrtomb_s(&retval, buf, sizeof buf, L'\0', ps) + where retval and buf are internal variables of the appropriate types, and the size of buf is greater than MB_CUR_MAX.

    @@ -30341,7 +31760,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. conversion state is unspecified. Otherwise, the wcrtomb_s function stores into *retval the number of bytes (including any shift sequences) stored in the array pointed to by s. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcrtomb_s function returns zero if no runtime-constraint violation and no encoding error occurred. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -30352,14 +31771,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. permit the ps parameter (the pointer to the conversion state) to be a null pointer.

    K.3.9.3.2.1 The mbsrtowcs_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

             #include <wchar.h>
             errno_t mbsrtowcs_s(size_t * restrict retval,
                  wchar_t * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax,
                  const char ** restrict src, rsize_t len,
    -             mbstate_t * restrict ps);
    + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + Runtime-constraints

    None of retval, src, *src, or ps shall be null pointers. If dst is not a null pointer, @@ -30373,7 +31793,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. retval is not a null pointer, then mbsrtowcs_s sets *retval to (size_t)(-1). If dst is not a null pointer and dstmax is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then mbsrtowcs_s sets dst[0] to the null wide character. -

    Description
    +

    Description

    The mbsrtowcs_s function converts a sequence of multibyte characters that begins in the conversion state described by the object pointed to by ps, from the array indirectly @@ -30407,12 +31827,12 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the objects take on unspecified values. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The mbsrtowcs_s function returns zero if no runtime-constraint violation and no encoding error occurred. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    439) Thus, the value of len is ignored if dst is a null pointer.

    440) This allows an implementation to attempt converting the multibyte string before discovering a @@ -30420,14 +31840,15 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    K.3.9.3.2.2 The wcsrtombs_s function
    -
    Synopsis
    +

    Synopsis

               #include <wchar.h>
               errno_t wcsrtombs_s(size_t * restrict retval,
                    char * restrict dst, rsize_t dstmax,
                    const wchar_t ** restrict src, rsize_t len,
    -               mbstate_t * restrict ps);
    + mbstate_t * restrict ps); + @@ -30446,7 +31867,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. retval is not a null pointer, then wcsrtombs_s sets *retval to (size_t)(-1). If dst is not a null pointer and dstmax is greater than zero and less than RSIZE_MAX, then wcsrtombs_s sets dst[0] to the null character. -
    Description
    +

    Description

    The wcsrtombs_s function converts a sequence of wide characters from the array indirectly pointed to by src into a sequence of corresponding multibyte characters that @@ -30489,7 +31910,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    If copying takes place between objects that overlap, the objects take on unspecified values. -

    Returns
    +

    Returns

    The wcsrtombs_s function returns zero if no runtime-constraint violation and no encoding error occurred. Otherwise, a nonzero value is returned. @@ -30499,7 +31920,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    441) If conversion stops because a terminating null wide character has been reached, the bytes stored include those necessary to reach the initial shift state immediately before the null byte. However, if the conversion stops before a terminating null wide character has been reached, the result will be null @@ -30512,7 +31933,8 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''.

    Annex L

                                                 (normative)
    -                                         Analyzability
    + Analyzability +

    L.1 Scope

    @@ -30521,7 +31943,7 @@ margin: deleted text is marked with ''*'', new or changed text with '' ''. An implementation that defines __STDC_ANALYZABLE__ shall conform to the specifications in this annex.443) -

    footnotes
    +

    Footnotes

    443) Implementations that do not define __STDC_ANALYZABLE__ are not required to conform to these specifications.